Honda

Jazz (2018) - Automobile Honda - Free user manual and instructions

Find the device manual for free Jazz (2018) Honda in PDF.

📄 617 pages English EN Download 💬 AI Question 10 questions ⚙️ Specs
Notice Honda Jazz (2018) - page 1
Pick your language and provide your email: we'll send you a specifically translated version.
Product Type Honda Jazz 2018 - 5-door hatchback, 5 seats
Dimensions (L x W x H) 3999 mm x 1694 mm x 1525 mm
Wheelbase 2530 mm
Kerb Weight Approx. 1100-1200 kg (depending on model and equipment)
Engine 1.3L i-VTEC petrol engine (output varies by market)
Fuel Type Unleaded premium petrol (95 RON or higher), up to E10 ethanol blend
Fuel Tank Capacity 40 L (8.8 Imp gal)
Transmission Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) or 6-speed Manual Transmission
Power System 12V electrical system with battery, alternator, and starter
Safety Systems Front, side, and curtain airbags; ABS; VSA; seat belt pretensioners; child restraint anchorages
Driver Assistance Cruise control, adjustable speed limiter, lane departure warning, forward collision warning, city-brake active system
Audio System Color audio system or display audio system with AM/FM/DAB, CD, USB, iPod, Bluetooth, HDMI, aux input
Climate Control Manual heating and cooling system or automatic climate control with dust/pollen filter
Maintenance Intervals Oil change every 12 months or 15,000 km (whichever comes first); other items per service reminder
Engine Oil Capacity Approx. 3.5 L (including filter) - use 0W-20 or 5W-30, API SN or higher
Coolant Capacity Approx. 5.5 L (Honda Long Life Coolant Type 2)
Brake Fluid DOT 4 brake fluid from a sealed container
Spare Parts and Repairability Available at authorized Honda dealers; DIY maintenance possible for basic items (bulbs, wipers, fuses)
General Information Owner's manual covers all models; specifications subject to change without notice

Frequently Asked Questions - Jazz (2018) Honda

Why does the beeper sound when I open the driver's door?
The beeper sounds when the exterior lights are left on, when Auto Idle Stop is active, or if the key is left in the ignition (models with keyless access system) or the power mode is in ACCESSORY.
Why does the brake pedal pulsate slightly when braking?
This can occur when the Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) activates. It is normal and indicates the system is working. Apply firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal; do not pump it.
What type of fuel should I use?
Your Honda Jazz requires unleaded premium petrol with a Research Octane Number (RON) of 95 or higher. Gasohol up to E10 (10% ethanol) can be used. Temporary use of 91 RON fuel may cause knocking and reduced performance.
How do I turn off the passenger front airbag?
If it is unavoidable to install a rear-facing child restraint system in the front passenger seat, you must manually deactivate the passenger front airbag using the ignition key or built-in key. Insert the key into the switch (located on the side panel of the passenger side instrument panel) and turn to OFF. Remember to turn it back ON when the child restraint is removed.
Why does the SRS indicator stay on?
The Supplemental Restraint System indicator comes on for a few seconds when the ignition is turned to ON, then goes off. If it remains on or comes on while driving, there is a problem with the airbag system or seat belt tensioners. Have the vehicle inspected by a Honda dealer as soon as possible.
How do I adjust the clock?
For models with a color audio system: press and hold the MENU/CLOCK button, rotate the selector knob to change hour, press, then rotate to change minute, then press to set. For models with display audio system: select the HOME icon, then Settings, Info, Clock, Clock Adjustment, and use the touchscreen to adjust.
What should I do if the engine does not start?
Check that the shift lever is in P or N (CVT) or the clutch is fully depressed (manual). If the battery is dead, jump start using a booster battery. Ensure the power mode is correct or the ignition key is turned properly. If the steering wheel is locked, move it while pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button (keyless) or turning the key (without keyless).
How do I use the Auto Idle Stop function?
Auto Idle Stop automatically stops the engine when the vehicle is stopped (e.g., at traffic lights) to improve fuel economy. To restart, release the brake pedal (CVT) or depress the clutch and select 1st gear (manual). The green Auto Idle Stop indicator lights up when active. You can temporarily disable it by pressing the Auto Idle Stop OFF button.
What is the correct way to fasten the seat belt?
Sit upright and well back in the seat. Pull the seat belt out slowly, insert the latch plate into the buckle, and tug to ensure it is secure. Position the lap belt as low as possible across your hips and the shoulder belt across the center of your chest and over your shoulder. Adjust the shoulder anchor height if necessary.
How do I replace a flat tyre?
Park on a level surface, set the parking brake, and turn on hazard lights. If equipped with a spare tyre, locate the jack and tools in the luggage area. Jack up the vehicle, remove the flat tyre, install the compact spare, and tighten the wheel nuts. Consult the manual for torque specifications. With a tyre repair kit, follow the instructions to seal and inflate the puncture.

User questions about Jazz (2018) Honda

0 question about this device. Answer the ones you know or ask your own.

Ask a new question about this device

The email remains private: it is only used to notify you if someone responds to your question.

No questions yet. Be the first to ask one.

Download the instructions for your Automobile in PDF format for free! Find your manual Jazz (2018) - Honda and take your electronic device back in hand. On this page are published all the documents necessary for the use of your device. Jazz (2018) by Honda.

USER MANUAL Jazz (2018) Honda

As you read this manual, you will find Information that is preceded by a NOTICE. This information is intended to help you avoid damage to your vehicle, other property, or the environment.

Symbols ▲ on labels attached to your vehicle are to remind you to read this owner's manual for proper and safe operation of your vehicle.

⚠️ Is colour-coded to indicate “danger” (red), “warning” (orange), or “caution” (amber).

Safety Labels P. 83

A Few Words About Safety

Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. And operating this vehicle safely is an important responsibility.

To help you make informed decisions about safety, we have provided operating procedures and other information on labels and in this manual. This information alerts you to potential hazards that could hurt you or others.

Of course, it is not practical or possible to warn you about all the hazards associated with operating or maintaining your vehicle. You must use your own good judgement.

You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms, including:

●Safety Labels - on the vehicle.
● Safety Messages - preceded by a safety alert symbol ⚠ and one of three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION These signal words mean:

DANGER

You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if you don't follow instructions.

WARNING

You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if you don't follow instructions.

WARNING

You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if you don't follow instructions.

CAUTION

You CAN be HURT if you don't follow instructions.

● Safety Headings - such as Important Safety Precautions.
●Safety Section - such as Safe Driving.
● Instructions - how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.

This entire book is filled with important safety information - please read it carefully.

Event Data Recorders

Your vehicle is equipped with several devices commonly referred to as Event Data Recorders. They record various types of real time vehicle data such as SRS airbag deployment and SRS system components failure.

This data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by anyone else except as legally required or with the permission of the vehicle owner.

However this data may be accessed by Honda, its authorised dealers and authorised repairers, employees, representatives and contractors only for the purpose of the technical diagnosis, research and development of the vehicle.

Service Diagnostic Recorders

Your vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record information about powertrain performance and driving conditions. The data can be used to help technicians diagnose, repair and maintain the vehicle. This data may not be accessed by anyone else except as legally required or with the permission of the vehicle owner.

However this data may be accessed by Honda, its authorised dealers and authorised repairers, employees, representatives and contractors only for the purpose of the technical diagnosis, research and development of the vehicle.

This owner's manual should be considered a permanent part of the vehicle and should remain with the vehicle when it is sold.

This owner's manual covers all models of your vehicle. You may find descriptions of equipment and features that are not on your particular model.

Images throughout this owner's manual represent features and equipment that are available on some, but not all, models. Your particular model may not have some of these features.

The information and specifications included in this publication were in effect at the time of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co., Ltd. reserves the right, however, to discontinue or change specifications or design at any time without notice and without incurring any obligation.

Although this manual is applicable to both right-hand and left-hand drive models, the illustrations contained in this manual mainly refer to the left-hand drive models.

→Safe Driving P. 31

For Safe Driving P. 32 Seat Belts P. 36 Airbags P. 49

→Instrument Panel P. 85

Indicators P. 86 Gauges and Multi-Information Display P. 123

→Controls P. 139

Clock P. 140 Locking and Unlocking the Doors P. 142

Opening and Closing the Windows P. 162

Adjusting the Seats P. 187

Climate Control System ^P. 213

→Features P. 219

Audio System P. 220 Audio System Basic Operation P. 227, 257

Customized Features P. 313 Hands-Free Telephone System P. 339, 362

→Driving P. 381

Before Driving P. 382 Towing a Trailer P. 386 When Driving P. 392

Multi-View Rear Camera* P. 469 Refueling P. 471

→Maintenance P. 475

Before Performing Maintenance P. 476 Service Reminder System P. 479

Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 511

Heating and Cooling System*/Climate Control System Maintenance P. 529

→Handling the Unexpected P. 539

Tools P. 540 If a Tyre Goes Flat P. 541

Overheating P. 566 Indicator, Coming On/Blinking P. 568

Information P. 589

Specifications P. 590 Identification Numbers P. 594

Child Safety P. 62

Exhaust Gas Hazard P. 82

Safety Labels P. 83

Opening and Closing the Tailgate P. 156

Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel P. 164

Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items P. 199 Heating and Cooling System

Security System P. 159

Adjusting the Mirrors P. 185

* P. 209

Audio Error Messages P. 305 General Information on the Audio System P. 308

Braking P. 453 Parking Your Vehicle P. 463

Fuel Economy and CO₂ Emissions P. 473

Maintenance Schedule * P. 484

Checking and Maintaining Tyres P. 515

Cleaning P. 532 Accessories and Modifications P. 537

Maintenance Under the Bonnet P. 488

Battery P. 522

Replacing Light Bulbs P. 499

Remote Transmitter Care P. 527

Engine Does Not Start P. 559

Fuses P. 573

Jump Starting P. 562

Emergency Towing P. 584

Shift Lever Does Not Move P. 565

When You Cannot Open the Tailgate P. 587

Devices that Emit Radio Waves * P. 595 EC Declaration of Conformity Content Outline

* P. 607

Contents

Quick Reference Guide

P. 4

Safe Driving

P. 31

Instrument Panel

P. 85

Controls

P. 139

Features

P. 219

Driving

P. 381

Maintenance

P. 475

Handling the Unexpected

P. 539

Information

P. 589

Index

P. 609

Visual Index

Left-hand drive type System Indicators P.86 Gauges P.123 Multi-Information Display P.124 Hazard Warning Button Clock P.140 Audio/Information Screen P.258 Audio System P.227, 257 Navigation System * See the Navigation System Manual Rear Window Demister P.183 Heated Door Mirror * P.183 Heating and Cooling System * P.209 Climate Control System * P.213 ENGINE START/STOP Button *1 P.165 Ignition Switch * P.164 Steering Wheel Adjustments P.184 (Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System OFF) Button P.447 Parking Sensor System Button * P.465 Headlight Adjuster * P.174 Lane Departure Warning Button * P.439

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Right-hand drive type Clock P. 140 Audio/Information Screen P. 258 Audio System P. 227, 257 Navigation System * See the Navigation System Manual Hazard Warning Button System Indicators P. 86 Gauges P. 123 Multi-Information Display P. 124 Ignition Switch * P. 164 Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System OFF) Button P. 447 Parking Sensor System Button * P. 465 Headlight Adjuster * P. 174 Lane Departure Warning Button * P. 439 Steering Wheel Adjustments P. 184 ENGINE START/STOP Button *1 P. 165 Rear Window Demister P. 183 Heated Door Mirror * P. 183 Climate Control System * P. 213 Heating and Cooling System * P. 209

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

* Not available on all models

Visual Index

Headlights/Turn Signals P. 169, 170 Front Fog Lights * P. 172 Rear Fog Light P. 172 Paddle Shifter (Shift down) * P. 405 (Display) Button * P. 258 (Select/Reset) Knob P. 125 Brightness Control P. 182 Paddle Shifter (Shift up) * P. 405 Wipers/Washers P. 179 Cruise Control Buttons P. 420 Adjustable Speed Limiter Buttons P. 423 Intelligent Speed Limiter Buttons * P. 427 (information) Buttons P. 124 SEL/RESET Button P. 125 Horn (Press an area around) Hands-Free Telephone System Buttons P. 339, 362 Audio Remote Controls P. 225

Left-hand drive type Power Window Switches → P.162 Power Door Lock Master Switch → P.154 Door Mirror Controls → P.186 Driver Side Interior Fuse Box → P.576, 578 Driver's Front Airbag → P.51 Passenger's Front Airbag → P.51 Driver Side Interior Fuse Box → P.580 Accessory Power Socket → P.205 Glove Box → P.202 USB Port → P.221 HDMI™ Port* → P.222 Auxiliary Input Jack * → P.222 Seat Heater Switches → P.208 Shift Lever Continuously Variable Transmission* → P.402 Manual Transmission* → P.407 Parking Brake → P.453 Auto Idle Stop OFF Button → P.411, 416 Bonnet Release Handle → P.489 Fuel Fill Door Release Handle → P.472

* Not available on all models

Visual Index

Right-hand drive type Passenger Side Interior Fuse Box →P.581 Passenger's Front Airbag →P.51 Glove Box →P.202 USB Port →P.221 HDMI™ Port* →P.222 Auxiliary Input Jack * →P.222 Accessory Power Socket →P.205 Driver's Front Airbag →P.51 Driver Side Interior Fuse Box →P.576 Door Mirror Controls →P.186 Power Door Lock Master Switch →P.154 Power Window Switches →P.162 Fuel Fill Door Release Handle →P.472 Bonnet Release Handle →P.489 Auto Idle Stop OFF Button →P.411, 416 Seat Heater Switches * →P.208 Shift Lever Continuously Variable Transmission* →P.402 Manual Transmission* →P.407 Parking Brake →P.453

Rearview Mirror →P.185 Map Lights →P.200 Sun Visors Vanity Mirrors Side Curtain Airbags →P.58 Ceiling Light →P.199 Grab Handle Coat Hook →P.206 (Only on the rear driver's side) Seat Belts →P.36 Seat Belt (Installing a Child Restraint System) →P.62 Seat Belt to Secure a Child Restraint System →P.75 Luggage Area Cover →P.207 Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor →P.45 Luggage Area Light →P.201 Luggage Floor Box →P.204 Lower Anchorage Points to Secure a Child Restraint System →P.72 Rear Seat →P.190 Side Airbags →P.56 Accessory Power Socket * →P.205 USB Port * →P.221 Front Seat →P.187

* Not available on all models

Visual Index

Maintenance Under the Bonnet →P.488 Windscreen Wipers →P.179,511 Power Door Mirrors →P.186 Side Turn Signal Lights →P.169,505 Door Lock/Unlock Control →P.142 Headlights →P.170,499 Front Turn Signal Lights →P.169,503 Position Lights →P.170,504 Daytime Running Lights * →P.178,505 Tyres →P.515,541 Daytime Running Lights * →P.178,505 Front Fog Lights * →P.172,501 How to Refuel →P.472 Audio Antenna →P.224 High-Mount Brake Light →P.508 Rear Wiper →P.181,513 Opening/Closing the Tailgate →P.156 Tailgate Outer Handle/Release Button →P.157 Rear Licence Plate Lights →P.508 Multi-View Rear Camera * →P.469 Brake/Taillights →P.507 Back-Up Lights →P.506 Rear Turn Signal Lights →P.506 Rear Fog Light →P.172,506

Auto Idle Stop Function

To improve fuel economy, the engine stops and then restarts as detailed below. When Auto Idle Stop is on, the Auto Idle Stop indicator (green) comes on. P. 410, 415

AtContinuously variable transmissionManual transmission Engine status
DecelerationHonda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop Function - 1Depress the brake pedal.Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop Function - 21. Depress the brake pedal.2. Fully depress the clutch pedal.Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop Function - 3Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop Function - 4
Stop↓Keep the brake pedal depressed.Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop Function - 5Continue to depress the brake pedal.Move the shift lever toN.Release the clutch pedal.Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop Function - 6Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop Function - 7
Start-upRelease the brake pedal.Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop Function - 81. Depress the clutch pedal again.Move the shift lever to1.Depress the accelerator pedal to resume driving.Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop Function - 9Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop Function - 10

Safe Driving

P.31

Airbags P. 49 • Your vehicle is fitted with airbags to help to protect you and your passengers during a moderate-to-severe collision. Child Safety P. 62 • All children 12 and younger should be seated in the rear seat. • Small children should be properly restrained in a front facing child restraint system. • Infants must be properly restrained in a rear-facing child restraint system on a rear seat. Exhaust Gas Hazard P. 82 • Your vehicle emits dangerous exhaust gases that contain carbon monoxide. Do not run the engine in confined spaces where carbon monoxide gas can accumulate. Seat Belts P. 36 • Fasten your seat belt and sit upright well back in the seat. • Check that your passengers are wearing their seat belts correctly.

Before Driving Checklist P.35

● Before driving, check that the front seats, head restraints, steering wheel, and mirrors have been properly adjusted.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 1

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 2

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 3

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 4

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 5

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 6

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 7

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 8

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 9

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 10

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 11

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 12

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 13

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 14

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 15

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 16

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 17

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 18

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 19

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 20

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 21

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 22

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 23

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 24

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 25

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 26

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 27

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 28

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 29

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 30

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 31

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 32

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 33

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 34

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 35

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 36

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 37

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 38

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 39

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 40

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 41

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 42

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 43

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 44

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 45

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 46

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 47

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 48

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 49

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 50

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 51

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 52

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 53

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 54

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 55

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 56

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 57

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 58

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 59

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 60

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 61

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 62

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 63

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 64

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 65

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 66

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 67

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 68

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 69

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 70

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 71

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 72

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 73

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 74

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 75

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 76

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 77

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 78

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 79

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 80

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 81

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 82

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 83

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 84

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 85

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 86

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 87

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 88

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 89

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 90

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 91

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 92

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 93

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 94

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 95

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 96

Honda Jazz (2018) - Before Driving Checklist P.35 - 97

Instrument Panel

P.85

Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86

System Indicators
Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 1

Malfunction Indicator Lamp

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 2

Low Oil Pressure Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 3

Charging System Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 4

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 5

VSA OFF Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 6

Immobilizer System Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 7

Keyless Access System Indicator*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 8

Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 9

High Temperature Indicator (Red) Low Temperature Indicator (Blue)

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 10

Auto Idle Stop Indicator (Green) Auto Idle Stop System Indicator (Amber)

Security System Alarm Indicator* Ambient Meter Multi-Information Display Tachometer Security System Alarm Indicator* Security System Alarm Indicator* Speedometer Shift Up/Down* Indicator M (7-speed manual shift mode) Indicator/Shift Indicator* Shift Lever Position Indicator* Fuel Gauge *1: Left-hand drive type with security system *2: Right-hand drive type with security system

System Indicators

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 12

Forward Collision Warning Indicator*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 13

Lane Departure Warning Indicator*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 14

Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning System Indicator

Lights Indicators
Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 15

Lights On Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 16

High Beam Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 17

Front Fog Light Indicator*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 18

Rear Fog Light Indicator

System Indicators
Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 19

Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Indicators

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 20

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 21

Parking Brake and Brake System Indicator (Red)

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 22

Brake System Indicator (Amber)

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 23

Door and Tailgate Open Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 24

Low Fuel Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 25

Seat Belt Reminder Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 26

Supplemental Restraint System Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 27

High Beam Support System Indicator*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 28

City-Brake Active System (CTBA) Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Gauges P.123/Multi-Information Display P.124/System Indicators P.86 - 29

System Message Indicator

Controls

P.139

Clock

P.140

Models with navigation system

The navigation system receives signals from GPS satellites, updating the clock automatically.

Models with audio system

The clock in the multi-information display is automatically updated along with the audio system's clock display.

Models with colour audio system

ADMIT 0 12:34 Admit Clock

1 Press and hold the MENU/CLOCK button.
2 Rotate to change hour, then press &
3 Rotate to change minute, then press ⚙.
4 Select SET, then press.

These indications are used to show how to operate the LIST/SELECT (Selector) knob.

  • Rotate to select.
  • Press to enter.

Models with display audio system

Info settings 12:34 WEIGHT 12:34 - 10:00 12 : 34 am Reset OK

1 Select the (HOME) icon, then select Settings.
② Select Info, Clock, then Clock Adjustment.
3 Touch the ▲ to adjust the numbers up or down.
4 Select OK.

ENGINE START/STOP Button\* P.165

Press the button to change the vehicle's power mode.

STOP ENGINE START

Turn Signals P.169

Turn Signal Control Lever

Right
OFF AUTO OFF OFF LEFT

Lights → P.170

Light Control Switches

High Beam Low Beam Flashing

Wipers and Washers

Honda Jazz (2018) - Wipers and Washers - 1

Wiper/Washer Control Lever

Pull toward you to spray washer fluid. Adjustment Ring Low Sensitivity High Sensitivity MIST OFF

AUTO: Wiper speed varies automatically LO: Low speed wipe HI: High speed wipe

Steering Wheel

Honda Jazz (2018) - Steering Wheel - 1

●To adjust, pull the adjustment lever towards you, adjust to the desired position, then lock the lever back in place.

To adjust To lock

Unlocking the Front Doors from the Inside

Honda Jazz (2018) - Unlocking the Front Doors from the Inside - 1

●Pull either front door inner handle to unlock and open it in one motion.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Unlocking the Front Doors from the Inside - 2

natural_image Close-up of a car door handle with a highlighted inset showing a hand holding a white object (no text or symbols visible)

- Unlocking and opening the driver's door from the inner handle unlocks all the other doors.

The front passenger's door also unlocks and opens in one motion.

Tailgate P.156

Honda Jazz (2018) - Tailgate P.156 - 1

natural_image Illustration of a person cleaning a car with a tool, showing the engine compartment (no text or symbols present)

Models without keyless access system

●With all the doors unlocked, pull the tailgate outer handle, and lift up to open it.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models without keyless access system - 1

natural_image Illustration of a person cleaning a car with a tool, showing the engine compartment (no text or symbols present)

Models with keyless access system

●With all the doors unlocked, push the tailgate release button on the tailgate to open it.
●Press the tailgate release button to unlock and open the tailgate when you carry the keyless access remote.

Power Door Mirrors

P.186

●With the ignition switch in ON ^*1 , move the selector switch to L or R.
●Push the appropriate edge of the adjustment switch to adjust the mirror.
- Press the folding button * to fold in and out the door mirrors.

Selector Switch Folding Button* Adjustment Switch

Power Windows → P.162

●With the ignition switch in ON ^*1 , open and close the power windows.
- If the power window lock button is in the off position, each passenger's window can be opened and closed with its own switch.
- If the power window lock button is in the on position (indicator on), each passenger's window switch is disabled.

Indicator Window Switch Power Window Lock Button

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Heating and Cooling System\*

P.209

●Rotate the fan control dial to adjust the fan speed.
- Rotate the mode control dial (☐ / ☐ / ☐ / ☐) to select the vents air flows from.
●Rotate the temperature control dial to adjust the temperature.
- Rotate the fan control dial to OFF to turn the system off.
- Rotate the mode control dial to to defrost the windscreen.

Air flows from dashboard vents. Air flows from floor and dashboard vents. Air flows from floor and windscreen demister vents. Air flows from windscreen demister vents. Fan Control Dial Temperature Control Dial Mode Control Dial A/C (Air Conditioning) Button A/C (Fresh Air)/(Reirculation) Lever

Climate Control System\*

P.213

  • Select the AUTO icon to activate the climate control system.
    ●Select the ☐to turn the system on or off.
  • Select the icon to defrost the windscreen.

Air flows from dashboard vents. Air flows from floor and dashboard vents. Air flows from floor vents. Air flows from floor and windscreen demister vents. Temperature Control Icons A/C OFF A/C ON Mode Fan Control Icons AUTO Icon AUTO ON/OFF A/C FRONT REAR ON/OFF (On/Off) Icon A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon (Fresh Air) Icon (Recirculation) Icon Mode Control Icon (Finot Windscreen Demister) Icon

* Not available on all models

Features

P.219

Audio System

P.227,257

Models with colour audio system

P. 227

Audio/Information Screen CD Slot (CD Eject) Button (Radio) Button 12:34 VPhone) Button TA Button CD/AUX Button LIST/SELECT (Selector) Knob VOL(Volume/Power) Knob MENU/CLOCK Button VOL/Vol/Seek) Buttons (Preset Buttons (1-6)

Models with display audio system

Honda Jazz (2018) - Audio System - 2

Models without navigation system
(Day/Night) Button (CD Eject) Button CD Slot Audio/Information Screen (Power) Button (Home) Icon VOL (Volume) Icons (Menu) Icon (Back) Icon Models with navigation system For navigation system operation See the Navigation System Manual

Audio Remote Controls

P.225

+ / Button SOURCE Button

●/+Button

Press to adjust the volume up/down.

●SOURCE Button

Press to change the audio mode:

Models with colour audio system

FM1/FM2/DAB1*/DAB2*/LW/MW/CD/USB/

iPod/Bluetooth®Audio/AUX.

Models with display audio system

FM/LW/MW/DAB */CD/USB/iPod/Apps/

Bluetooth®Audio/AUX HDMI™.

● /Button

Radio:Press to change the preset station.

Press and hold to select the next or previous strong station.

CD/USB device:

Press to skip to the beginning of the next song or return to the beginning of the current song.

Press and hold to change a folder.

Driving

P.381

Manual Transmission\*

P.407

Continuously Variable Transmission\*

P.402

●Shift to ☐ and depress the brake pedal when starting the engine.

Shifting

Honda Jazz (2018) - Shifting - 1

Honda Jazz (2018) - Shifting - 2

Depress the brake pedal and press the release button to move out of P.

Move the shift lever without pressing the release button.

Press the release button to move the shift lever.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Shifting - 3

Turn off or start the engine. Transmission is locked.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Shifting - 4

Reverse Used when reversing.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Shifting - 5

Neutral Transmission is not locked.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Shifting - 6

Drive • Normal driving.

- 7-speed manual shift mode can be used temporarily.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Shifting - 7

S Position

- Better acceleration. - Increased engine braking. - Going up or down hills. - 7-speed manual shift mod

Shift Lever Release Button on be used

7-Speed Manual Shift Mode\* P.404

●Allows you to manually shift the transmission up or down without removing your hands from the steering wheel.

When the shift lever is in S

- Pulling a paddle shifter changes the mode from continuously variable transmission to 7-speed manual shift mode. - The M indicator and the selected speed number are displayed in the shift indicator.

When the shift lever is in D

●Pulling a paddle shifter temporarily changes the mode from continuously variable transmission to 7-speed manual shift mode. The selected speed number is displayed in the shift indicator.

Honda Jazz (2018) - When the shift lever is in D - 1

Shift Down — Paddle Shifter
Shift Up ☐ Paddle Shifter
Honda Jazz (2018) - When the shift lever is in D - 2

Honda Jazz (2018) - When the shift lever is in D - 3

Honda Jazz (2018) - When the shift lever is in D - 4

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with Honda logo and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)

* Not available on all models

VSA On and OFF

P. 447

●The vehicle stability assist (VSA) system helps to stabilise the vehicle during cornering, and helps to maintain traction while accelerating on loose or slippery road surfaces.
●VSA comes on automatically every time you start the engine.
●To partially disable VSA functionality/features, press and hold the button until you hear a beep.

Cruise Control

P. 420

●Cruise control allows you to maintain a set speed without keeping your foot on the accelerator pedal.
- To use cruise control, press the MAIN button. Select cruise control by pressing the LIM button, then press the -/SET button once you have achieved the desired speed (above 30 km/h or 18 mph).

Adjustable Speed Limiter

P. 423

●This system enables you to set a maximum speed that cannot be exceeded even if you are depressing the accelerator pedal.
●To use the adjustable speed limiter, press the MAIN button. Select the adjustable speed limiter by pressing the LIM button, then press the -/SET when your vehicle reaches the desired speed.
●The vehicle speed limit can be set from 30 km/h (18 mph) to 250 km/h (156 mph).

Deflation Warning

System →P.449

●Detects a change in tyre conditions and overall dimensions due to decrease in tyre pressures.
●The Deflation warning system is turned on automatically every time you start the engine.
●A calibration procedure must be performed when certain conditions arise.

Refueling → P.471

Unleaded premium petrol/gasohol up to E10 (90% petrol and 10% ethanol), research octane number 95 or higher Fuel tank capacity: 40 L (8.8 Imp gal)

Honda Jazz (2018) - Refueling → P.471 - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's dashboard with a highlighted control panel (no visible text or symbols)

Honda Jazz (2018) - Refueling → P.471 - 2

natural_image Side profile of a Honda car showing front, rear, and side views with mechanical components (no text or symbols visible)

1 Pull the fuel fill door release handle.
② Turn the fuel fill cap slowly to remove the cap.
3 Place the cap in the holder on the fuel fill door.
4 After refueling, screw the cap back on until it clicks at least once.

Maintenance

P.475

Under the Bonnet P.488

  • Check engine oil, engine coolant, and windscreen washer fluid. Add when necessary.
  • Check brake/clutch ^ fluid.
    ●Check the battery condition monthly.

1 Pull the bonnet release handle under the corner of the dashboard.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Under the Bonnet P.488 - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's front panel showing two buttons with a magnified inset highlighting the left side (no text or symbols visible)

2 Locate the bonnet latch lever, push it to the side, and then raise the bonnet. Once you have raised the bonnet slightly, you can release the lever.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Under the Bonnet P.488 - 2

natural_image Front view of a silver car with a highlighted interior component (no visible text or symbols)

3 When finished, close the bonnet and make sure it is firmly locked in place.

Wiper Blades

P.511

●Replace blades if they leave streaks across the windscreen.

res P.515 Lights P.499

Tyres P.515

-

●Inspect tyres and wheels regularly.
●Check tyre pressures regularly.
●Install winter tyres for winter driving.

Lights → P.499

●Inspect all lights regularly.

Handling the Unexpected

P.539

Flat Tyre

P.541

Models with a spare tyre

●Park in a safe location and replace the flat tyre with the compact spare tyre in the luggage area.

Models with tyre repair kit

●Park in a safe location and repair the flat tyre using the tyre repair kit.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with tyre repair kit - 1

natural_image Rear view of a silver minivan (no visible text or symbols)

Engine Won't Start

P.559

- If the battery is dead, jump start using a booster battery.

ENGINE STAGE STOP

Overheating

P.566

●Park in a safe location. If you do not see steam under the bonnet, open the bonnet, and let the engine cool down.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Overheating - 1

natural_image Exterior view of a silver sedan with its hood open, showing engine compartment (no text or symbols visible)

Indicators Come On

P.568

- Identify the indicator and consult the owner's manual.

Car dashboard interface with warning icons and battery symbols, showing vehicle status indicators

Blown Fuse

P.573

- Check for a blown fuse if an electrical device does not operate.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Blown Fuse - 1

natural_image Pure mechanical component diagram without any text, numbers, or symbols

Emergency Towing

P.584

●Call a professional towing service if you need to tow your vehicle.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Emergency Towing - 1

natural_image Illustration of a flatbed truck carrying a car on its side (no text or symbols)

What to Do If

Honda Jazz (2018) - What to Do If - 1

Models without keyless access system

The ignition switch does not turn from 0 to 1. Why?

Models with keyless access system

The power mode does not change from VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) to ACCESSORY. Why?

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 1

- The steering wheel may be locked.

Models without keyless access system

- Try to turn the steering wheel left and right while turning the ignition key.

Models with keyless access system

- Move the steering wheel left and right after pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 1

natural_image Illustration of a car steering wheel with a headset and two circular gauges (no text or symbols)

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 2

Models without keyless access system

The ignition switch does not turn from 1 to 0 and I cannot remove the key. Why?

Models with keyless access system

The power mode does not change from ACCESSORY to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK). Why?

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 1

The shift lever should be moved to P.

P

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 3

Why does the brake pedal pulsate slightly when applying the brakes?

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 4

This can occur when the ABS activates and does not indicate a problem. Apply firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. Never pump the brake pedal.

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 455

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 5

The rear door cannot be opened from inside the vehicle. Why?

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 6

Check if the childproof lock is in the lock position. If so, open the rear door with the outside door handle. To cancel this function, push the lever to the unlock position.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 7

natural_image Close-up of a car's front window with a magnified inset showing a gear shift (no text or symbols visible)

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 8

Why do the doors lock after I unlocked the doors?

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 9

If you do not open the doors within 30 seconds, the doors are relocked automatically for security.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 10

Why does the beeper sound when I open the driver's door?

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 11

The beeper sounds when:

• The exterior lights are left on.
• Auto Idle Stop is in operation.

Models without keyless access system

• The key is left in the ignition switch.

Models with keyless access system

• The power mode is in ACCESSORY.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 12

Why does the beeper sound when I start driving?

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 13

The beeper sounds when:

  • Driver and/or front passenger are not wearing their seat belts.
  • The parking brake lever is not fully released.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 14

I'm seeing an amber indicator of a tyre with an exclamation point. What is that?

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 15

The Deflation Warning System needs attention. If you recently inflated or changed a tyre, you have to recalibrate the system. ▶Deflation Warning System ➕P 449

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 16

Why do I hear a screeching sound when I apply the brake pedal?

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 17

The brake pads may need to be replaced. Have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 18

Is it possible to use unleaded petrol with a Research Octane Number (RON) of 91 or higher on this vehicle?

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with keyless access system - 19

Your vehicle is designed to operate on premium unleaded petrol with a research octane of 95 or higher. If this octane grade is unavailable, regular unleaded petrol with a research octane of 91 or higher may be used temporarily. The use of regular unleaded petrol can cause metallic knocking noises in the engine and will result in decreased engine performance. The long-term use of regular-grade petrol can lead to engine damage.

Safe Driving You can find many safety recommendations throughout this chapter, and throughout this manual.

For Safe Driving

Important Safety Precautions ...... 32

Your Vehicle's Safety Features...... 34

Seat Belts

About Your Seat Belts.... 36

Fastening a Seat Belt 42

Seat Belt Inspection.... 47

Airbags

Airbag System Components...... 49

Types of Airbags 51

Front Airbags (SRS) 51

Side Airbags.... 56

Side Curtain Airbags 58

Airbag System Indicators.... 59

Airbag Care 61

Child Safety

Protecting Child Passengers 62

Safety of Infants and Small Children.... 66

Safety of Larger Children 79

Exhaust Gas Hazard

Carbon Monoxide Gas.... 82

Safety Labels

Label Locations 83

For Safe Driving

The following pages explain your vehicle's safety features and how to use them properly. The safety precautions below are ones that we consider to be among the most important.

Important Safety Precautions

■Always wear your seat belt

A seat belt is your best protection in all types of collisions. Airbags are designed to supplement seat belts, not replace them. So even though your vehicle is equipped with airbags, make sure you and your passengers always wear your seat belts, and wear them properly.

■Restrain all children

Children aged 12 and under should ride properly restrained in a back seat, not the front seat. Infants and small children should be restrained in a child restraint system. Larger children should use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder seat belt until they can use the belt properly without a booster seat.

■Be aware of airbag hazards

While airbags can save lives, they can cause serious or fatal injuries to occupants who sit too close to them, or are not properly restrained. Infants, young children, and short adults are at the greatest risk. Be sure to follow all instructions and warnings in this manual.

■Don't drink and drive

Alcohol and driving don't mix. Even one drink can reduce your ability to respond to changing conditions, and your reaction time gets worse with every additional drink. So don't drink and drive, and don't let your friends drink and drive, either.

Important Safety Precautions

Some countries prohibit the use of mobile phones other than hands-free devices by the driver while driving.

■Pay appropriate attention to the task of driving safely

Engaging in mobile phone conversation or other activities that keep you from paying close attention to the road, other vehicles, and pedestrians could lead to a crash. Remember, situations can change quickly, and only you can decide when it is safe to divert some attention away from driving.

■Control your speed

Excessive speed is a major factor in crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher the speed, the greater the risk, but serious injuries can also occur at lower speeds. Never drive faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum speed posted.

■Keep your vehicle in safe condition

Having a tyre blowout or a mechanical failure can be extremely hazardous. To reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tyre pressures and condition frequently, and perform all regularly scheduled maintenance.

■Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle

Children left unattended in the vehicle may be injured if they activate one or more of the vehicle controls. They may also cause the vehicle to move, resulting in a crash in which the children and/or another person(s) can be injured or killed. Also, depending on the ambient temperature, the temperature of the interior may reach extreme levels, which can result in injury or death. Even if the climate control system is on, never leave children in the vehicle unattended as the climate control system can shut off at any time.

Your Vehicle's Safety Features

1 Safety Cage 2 Crush Zones 3 Seats and Seat-Backs 4 Head Restraints 5 Collapsible Steering Column 6 Seat Belts 7 Front Airbags 8 Side Airbags 9 Side Curtain Airbags 10 Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners

The following checklist will help you take an active role in protecting yourself and your passengers.

Your Vehicle's Safety Features

Your vehicle is equipped with many features that work together to help to protect you and your passengers during a crash.

Some features do not require any action on your part. These include a strong steel framework that forms a safety cage around the passenger compartment, front and rear crush zones, a collapsible steering column, and tensioners that tighten the front and rear outer seat belts in a sufficient crash.

However, you and your passengers cannot take full advantage of these features unless you remain seated in the correct position and always wear your seat belts. In fact, some safety features can contribute to injuries if they are not used properly.

Safety Checklist

For the safety of you and your passengers, make a habit of checking these items each time before you drive.

- Adjust your seat to a position suitable for driving. Be sure the front seats are adjusted as far to the rear as possible while allowing the driver to control the vehicle. Sitting too close to a front airbag can result in serious or fatal injury in a crash.

Adjusting the Seats P. 187

- Adjust head restraints to the proper position. Head restraints are most effective when the centre of the head restraint aligns with the centre of your head. Taller persons should adjust their head restraint to the highest position.

Adjusting the front head restraint positions P. 193

- Always wear your seat belt, and make sure you wear it properly. Confirm that any passengers are properly belted as well.

Fastening a Seat Belt P. 42

- Protect children by using seat belts or child restraint systems according to a child's age, height and weight.

Child Safety P. 62

>>Safety Checklist

If the door and tailgate open indicator is on, a door and/or the tailgate is not completely closed. Close all doors and the tailgate tightly until the indicator goes off.

→ Door and Tailgate Open Indicator P. 95

Diagram of a car dashboard with labeled parts including a robot icon and a car silhouette icon

Seat Belts

About Your Seat Belts

Seat belts are the single most effective safety device because they keep you connected to the vehicle so that you can take advantage of many built-in safety features. They also help to keep you from being thrown against the inside of the vehicle, against any passengers, or out of the vehicle. When worn properly, seat belts also keep your body properly positioned in a crash so that you can take full advantage of the additional protection provided by the airbags.

In addition, seat belts help to protect you in almost every type of crash, including:

  • frontal impacts
  • side impacts
  • rear impacts
  • rollovers

About Your Seat Belts

WARNING

Not wearing a seat belt properly increases the chance of serious injury or death in a crash, even though your vehicle has airbags.

Be sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts and wear them properly.

WARNING: Seat belts are designed to bear upon the bony structure of the body, and should be worn low across the front of the pelvis or the pelvis, chest and shoulders, as applicable; wearing the lap section of the belt across the abdominal area must be avoided.

WARNING: Seat belts should be adjusted as firmly as possible, consistent with comfort, to provide the protection for which they have been designed. A slack belt will greatly reduce the protection afforded to the wearer.

WARNING: Belts should not be worn with straps twisted.

WARNING: Each belt assembly must only be used by one occupant; it is dangerous to put a belt around a child being carried on the occupant's lap.

Lap/shoulder seat belts

All five seating positions are equipped with lap/shoulder seat belts with emergency locking retractors. In normal driving the retractor lets you move freely while keeping some tension on the belt. During a collision or sudden stop the retractor locks to restrain your body.

The seat belt must be properly secured when using a front facing child restraint system.

Child Safety P. 62

About Your Seat Belts

Seat belts cannot completely protect you in every crash. But in most cases, seat belts can reduce your risk of serious injury.

Most countries require you to wear seat belts. Take time to familiarise with the legal requirements of the countries in which you will drive.

If you extend the seat belt too quickly, it will lock in place. If this happens, slightly retract the seat belt, then extend it slowly.

Continued

■Proper use of seat belts

Follow these guidelines for proper use:

  • All occupants should sit upright, well back in the seat, and remain in that position for the duration of the trip. Slouching and leaning reduce the effectiveness of the belt and can increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
  • Never place the shoulder part of a lap/shoulder seat belt under your arm or behind your back. This could cause very serious injuries in a crash.
  • Two people should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they could be very seriously injured in a crash.
  • Do not put any accessories on the seat belts. Devices intended to improve comfort or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can reduce the protective capability and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.

Seat Belt Reminder

Car interior view with steering wheel, dashboard, and circular warning sign showing 'No change' and a person silhouette

Front seats

The seat belt system includes an indicator on the instrument panel to remind the driver or a front passenger or both to fasten their seat belts.

If the ignition switch is turned to ON [Ⅱ]^*1 and a seat belt is not fastened, a beeper will sound and the indicator will blink. After a few seconds, the beeper will stop and the indicator will come on and remain illuminated until the seat belt is fastened.

The beeper will also periodically sound and the indicator will blink while the vehicle is moving until the seat belt is fastened.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Continued

Seat Belt Reminder

The indicator will also come on if a front passenger does not fasten their seat belt within six seconds after the ignition switch is turned to ON ^*1 .

When no one is sitting in the front passenger's seat, the indicator will not come on and the beeper will not sound.

If the indicator comes on or the beeper sounds with no one sitting in the front passenger's seat. Check if:

  • There is nothing heavy placed on the front passenger seat.
    • The driver's seat belt is fastened.

If the indicator does not light when the passenger is seated and is not fastened, something may be interfering with the occupant detection sensor.

Check if:

• A cushion is placed on the seat.
- The front passenger is not sitting properly.

If none of these conditions exist, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.

: Latched : Unlatched

Rear seats

Your vehicle monitors rear seat belt use. A multi-information display notifies you if any of the rear seat belts are used.

The display appears when:

  • A rear door is opened and closed.
  • Any of the rear passengers latches or unlatches their seat belt.

The beeper sounds if any rear passenger's seat belt is unlatched while driving.

To see the display: press the button repeatedly.

Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners

The front seats and the outer rear seats are equipped with automatic seat belt tensioners to enhance safety.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners - 1

natural_image Illustration of a car seatbelt buckle with adjustable arm and foot (no text or symbols)

The tensioners automatically tighten the front seat belts and the outer rear seat belts during a moderate-to-severe frontal collision, sometimes even if the collision is not severe enough to inflate the front airbags.

Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners

The seat belt tensioners can only operate once. If a tensioner is activated, the SRS indicator will come on. Have a dealer replace the tensioner and thoroughly inspect the seat belt system as it may not offer protection in a subsequent crash.

During a moderate-to-severe side impact, the tensioner on that side of the vehicle also activates.

Fastening a Seat Belt

After adjusting a front seat to the proper position, and while sitting upright and well back in the seat:

Adjusting the Seats P. 187
Pull out slowly. Correct Seated Posture.

  1. Pull the seat belt out slowly.

  2. Insert the latch plate into the buckle, then tug on the belt to make sure the buckle is secure.

▶ Make sure that the belt is not twisted or caught on anything.

Latch Plate Buckle

Fastening a Seat Belt

No one should sit in a seat with an inoperative seat belt or one that does not appear to be working correctly. Using a seat belt that is not working properly may not protect the occupant in a crash. Have a dealer check the belt as soon as possible.

Lap belt as low as possible

  1. Position the lap part of the belt as low as possible across your hips, then pull up on the shoulder part of the belt so the lap part fits snugly. This lets your strong pelvic bones take the force of a crash and reduces the chance of internal injuries.
  2. If necessary, pull up on the belt again to remove any slack, then check that the belt rests across the centre of your chest and over your shoulder. This spreads the forces of a crash over the strongest bones in your upper body.

Fastening a Seat Belt

WARNING

Improperly positioning the seat belts can cause serious injury or death in a crash.

Make sure all seat belts are properly positioned before driving.

To release the belt, push the red PRESS button and then guide the belt by hand until it has retracted completely.

When exiting the vehicle, be sure the belt is properly stowed so that it will not get caught in the closing door.

Never insert any foreign objects into the buckle or retractor mechanism.

Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor

The front seats have adjustable shoulder anchors to accommodate taller and shorter occupants.

Pull outward

  1. Move the anchor up and down while pulling the release outward.
  2. Position the anchor so that the belt rests across the centre of your chest and over your shoulder.

Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor

The shoulder anchor height can be adjusted to four levels. If the belt contacts your neck, lower the height one level at a time.

After an adjustment, make sure that the shoulder anchor position is secure.

Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor

Latch Plate Small Latch Plate

Anchor Buckle

Latch Plate Buckle

  1. Pull out the seat belt's small latch plate and the latch plate from each holding slot in the ceiling.
  2. Line up the triangle marks on the small latch plate and anchor buckle. Make sure the seat belt is not twisted. Attach the belt to the anchor buckle.
  3. Insert the latch plate into the buckle. Properly fasten the seat belt the same way you fasten the lap/shoulder seat belt.

Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor

WARNING

Using the seat belt with the detachable anchor unlatched increases the chance of serious injury or death in a crash.

Before using the seat belt, make sure the detachable anchor is correctly latched.

To unlatch the detachable anchor, insert the latch plate into the slot on the side of the anchor buckle.

Anchor Buckle Latch Plate

Continued

Advice for Pregnant Women

If you are pregnant, the best way to protect yourself and your unborn child when driving or riding in a vehicle is to always wear a seat belt and keep the lap part of the belt as low as possible across the hips.

Wear the shoulder belt across the chest avoiding the abdomen.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Advice for Pregnant Women - 1

natural_image Illustration of a pregnant woman wearing a seatbelt, seated in a chair (no text or symbols)

Wear the lap part of the belt as low as possible across the hips.

»Advice for Pregnant Women

Each time you have a checkup, ask your doctor if it is okay for you to drive.

To reduce the risk of injuries to both you and your unborn child that can be caused by an inflating front airbag:

- When driving, sit upright and adjust the seat as far back as possible while allowing full control of the vehicle.

- When sitting in the front passenger's seat, adjust the seat as far back as possible.

Seat Belt Inspection

Regularly check the condition of your seat belts as follows:

  • Pull each belt out fully, and look for frays, cuts, burns, and wear.
  • Check that the latch plates and buckles work smoothly and the belts retract easily.
    If a belt does not retract easily, cleaning the belt may correct the problem. Only use a mild soap and warm water. Do not use bleach or cleaning solvents. Make sure the belt is completely dry before allowing it to retract.

Any belt that is not in good condition or working properly will not provide proper protection and should be replaced as soon as possible.

A belt that has been worn during a crash may not provide the same level of protection in a subsequent crash. Have your seat belts inspected by a dealer after any collision.

Seat Belt Inspection

WARNING

Not checking or maintaining seat belts can result in serious injury or death if the seat belts do not work properly when needed.

Check your seat belts regularly and have any problem corrected as soon as possible.

WARNING: No modifications or additions should be made by the user which will either prevent the seat belt adjusting devices from operating to remove slack, or prevent the seat belt assembly from being adjusted to remove slack.

WARNING: It is essential to replace the entire assembly after it has been worn in a severe impact even if damage to the assembly is not obvious.

WARNING: Care should be taken to avoid contamination of the webbing with polishes, oils and chemicals, and particularly battery acid. Cleaning may safely be carried out using mild soap and water. The belt should be replaced if webbing becomes frayed, contaminated or damaged.

Anchorage points

Honda Jazz (2018) - Anchorage points - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing the front seat and seat compartments with decorative patterns (no text or symbols)

When replacing the seat belts, use the anchorage points shown in the images. The front seat has a lap/shoulder belt.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Anchorage points - 2

natural_image Interior view of a car showing rear seat and dashboard with no visible text or symbols

The rear seat has three lap/shoulder belts.

Airbags

Airbag System Components

The front, front side, and side curtain airbags are deployed according to the direction and severity of impact. The airbag system includes:

  • Two SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) front airbags. The driver's airbag is stored in the centre of the steering wheel; the front passenger's airbag is stored in the dashboard. Both are marked SRS AIRBAG.
  • Two side airbags, one for the driver and one for a front passenger. The airbags are stored in the outer edges of the seat-backs. Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
  • Two side curtain airbags, one for each side of the vehicle. The airbags are stored in the ceiling, above the side windows. The front and rear pillars are marked SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG.

  • An electronic control unit that, when the ignition switch is ON ^*1 , continually monitors information about the various impact sensors, seat and buckle sensors, airbag activators, seat belt tensioners, and other vehicle information. During a crash event the unit can record such information.
    • Automatic front seat belt tensioners.

  • Impact sensors that can detect a moderate-to-severe front or side impact.
  • An indicator on the instrument panel that alerts you to a possible problem with your airbag system or seat belt tensioners.
  • An indicator on the dashboard that alerts you that the front passenger's front airbag has been turned off.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Continued

Important facts about your airbags

Airbags can pose serious hazards. To do their job, airbags must inflate with tremendous force. So, while airbags help to save lives, they can cause burns, bruises, and other minor injuries, sometimes even fatal ones if occupants are not wearing their seat belts properly and sitting correctly.

What you should do: Always wear your seat belt properly, and sit upright and as far back from the steering wheel as possible while allowing full control of the vehicle. A front passenger should move their seat as far back from the dashboard as possible.

Remember, however, that no safety system can prevent all injuries or deaths that can occur in a severe crash, even when seat belts are properly worn and the airbags deploy.

Do not place hard or sharp objects between yourself and a front airbag. Carrying hard or sharp objects on your lap, or driving with a pipe or other sharp object in your mouth, can result in injuries if your front airbag inflates.

Do not attach or place objects on the front airbag covers. Objects on the covers marked SRS AIRBAG could interfere with the proper operation of the airbags or be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone if the airbags inflate.

Important facts about your airbags

Do not attempt to deactivate your airbags. Together, airbags and seat belts provide the best protection.

When driving, keep hands and arms out of the deployment path of the front airbag by holding each side of the steering wheel. Do not cross an arm over the airbag cover.

Types of Airbags

Your vehicle is equipped with three types of airbags:

  • Front airbags: Airbags in front of the driver's and front passenger's seats.
  • Side airbags: Airbags in the driver's and front passenger's seat-backs.
  • Side curtain airbags: Airbags above the side windows.

Each is discussed in the following pages.

Front Airbags (SRS)

The front SRS airbags inflate in a moderate-to-severe frontal collision to help to protect the head and chest of the driver and/or front passenger.

SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) indicates that the airbags are designed to supplement seat belts, not replace them. Seat belts are the occupant's primary restraint system.

Housing Locations

The front airbags are housed in the centre of the steering wheel for the driver, and in the dashboard for the front passenger. Both airbags are marked SRS AIRBAG.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Continued

Types of Airbags

The airbags can inflate whenever the ignition switch is in ON ^*1 .

After an airbag inflates in a crash, you may see a small amount of smoke. This is from the combustion process of the inflator material and is not harmful. People with respiratory problems may experience some temporary discomfort. If this occurs, get out of the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so.

Operation

Front airbags are designed to inflate during moderate-to-severe frontal collisions. When the vehicle decelerates suddenly, the sensors send information to the control unit which signals one or both front airbags to inflate.

A frontal collision can be either head-on or angled between two vehicles, or when a vehicle crashes into a stationary object, such as a concrete wall.

How the Front Airbags Work

Honda Jazz (2018) - How the Front Airbags Work - 1

natural_image Illustration of a car seatbelt with a helmet and seat, no text or symbols present

While your seat belt restrains your torso, the front airbag provides supplemental protection for your head and chest.

The front airbags deflate immediately so that they won't interfere with the driver's visibility or the ability to steer or operate other controls.

The total time for inflation and deflation is so fast that most occupants are not aware that the airbags deployed until they see them lying in front of them.

■When front airbags should not deploy

Minor frontal crashes: Front airbags were designed to supplement seat belts and help to save lives, not to prevent minor scrapes, or even broken bones that might occur during a less than moderate-to-severe frontal crash.

Side impacts: Front airbags can provide protection when a sudden deceleration causes a driver or front passenger to move towards the front of the vehicle. Side airbags and side curtain airbags have been specifically designed to help to reduce the severity of injuries that can occur during a moderate-to-severe side impact which can cause the driver or passenger to move towards the side of the vehicle.

Rear impacts: Head restraints and seat belts are your best protection during a rear impact. Front airbags cannot provide any significant protection and are not designed to deploy in such collisions.

Rollovers: Seat belts and side curtain airbags offer the best protection in a rollover. Because front airbags could provide little if any protection, they are not designed to deploy during a rollover.

■When front airbags deploy with little or no visible damage

Because the airbag system senses sudden deceleration, a strong impact to the vehicle framework or suspension might cause one or more of the airbags to deploy. Examples include running into a curb, the edge of a hole, or other low fixed object that causes a sudden deceleration in the vehicle chassis. Since the impact is underneath the vehicle, damage may not be readily apparent.

■ When front airbags may not deploy, even though exterior damage appears severe

Since crushable body parts absorb crash energy during an impact, the amount of visible damage does not always indicate proper airbag operation. In fact, some collisions can result in severe damage but no airbag deployment because the airbags would not have been needed or would not have provided protection even if they had deployed.

Passenger Front Airbag Off System

If it is unavoidable to install a rear-facing child restraint system in the front passenger seat, you must manually deactivate the passenger front airbag system, using the ignition key or the built-in key.

■Passenger front airbag ON/OFF switch

Passenger Front Airbag ON/OFF Indicator ON/OFF Switch PASSenger OPEN OFF ON OFF ON System Warning Label

When the passenger front airbag ON/OFF switch is in:

OFF: The passenger front airbag is deactivated. The passenger front airbag does not inflate during a frontal crash that inflates driver's front airbag.

The passenger front airbag off indicator stays on as a reminder.

ON: The passenger front airbag is activated. The passenger front airbag on indicator comes on and remains on for about 60 seconds.

■To deactivate the passenger front airbag system

Passenger Front Airbag ON/OFF Switch

  1. Set the parking brake, and turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0 ^4 . Remove the key.
  2. Open the front passenger's door.
  3. Insert the key to the passenger front airbag ON/OFF switch.

The switch is located at the side panel of the front passenger side instrument panel.

  1. Turn the key to OFF, and remove it from the switch.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Passenger Front Airbag Off System

WARNING

The passenger front airbag system must be turned off, if it is not avoidable to put a rear-facing child restraint system in the front passenger seat.

If the front passenger airbag inflates, it can hit the rear-facing child restraint system with enough force to kill or cause a very serious injury to the infant.

WARNING

Make sure to turn on the passenger front airbag system when a rear-facing child restraint system is not used on the front passenger seat.

Leaving the passenger front airbag system deactivated can result in serious injury or death in a crash.

■Passenger front airbag off indicator

When the passenger front airbag system is activated, the indicator goes off after a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 .

When the passenger front airbag system is deactivated, the indicator stays on, or goes off momentarily and comes back on.

■Passenger front airbag off system label

The label is located at the side panel of the front passenger side instrument panel.

Infant in a rear-facing child restraint system: May ride in front if it is unavoidable OFF ON Cannot ride in the front Front passenger front airbag is: Active Inactive

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

To deactivate the passenger front airbag system

NOTICE

  • Use your vehicle's ignition key/built-in key to turn the passenger front airbag ON/OFF switch. If you use a different key, the switch can be damaged, or the passenger front airbag system may not work properly.
  • Do not close the door or apply excessive load on the ignition key/built-in key while the key is in the passenger front airbag ON/OFF switch. The switch or the key can be damaged.

We strongly recommend that you do not install a rear-facing child restraint system in the front passenger seat.

Protecting Infants P. 66

It is your responsibility to change the setting of the passenger front airbag system to OFF when you put a rear-facing child restraint system on the front passenger seat.

When a rear-facing child restraint system is not in use in the front passenger seat, turn the system back on.

Side Airbags

The side airbags help to protect the upper torso and pelvis of the driver or a front passenger during a moderate-to-severe side impact.

Housing Locations
Housing Location

The side airbags are housed in the outside edge of the driver's and passenger's seat-backs.

Both are marked SRS AIRBAG.

Side Airbags

Do not attach accessories on or near the side airbags. They can interfere with the proper operation of the airbags, or hurt someone if an airbag inflates.

Operation

When inflated Side Airbag

When the sensors detect a moderate-to-severe side impact, the control unit signals the side airbag on the impact side to immediately inflate.

■When a side airbag deploys with little or no visible damage

Because the airbag systems senses sudden acceleration, a strong impact to the side of the vehicle's framework can cause a side airbag to deploy. In such cases, there may be little or no damage, but the side impact sensors detected a severe enough impact to deploy the airbag.

■ When a side airbag may not deploy, even though visible damage appears severe

It is possible for a side airbag to not deploy during an impact that results in apparently severe damage. This can occur when the point of impact was towards the far front or rear of the vehicle, or when the vehicle's crushable body parts absorbed most of the crash energy. In either case, the side airbag would not have been needed nor provided protection even if it had deployed.

>>Side Airbags

Do not cover or replace the front seat-back covers without consulting a dealer. Improperly replacing or covering front seat-back covers can prevent your side airbags from properly deploying during a side impact.

Do not let the front passenger lean sideways with their head in the deployment path of the side airbag. An inflating side airbag can strike with strong force and seriously injure the passenger.

Side Curtain Airbags

The side curtain airbags help to protect the heads of the driver and passengers in outer seating positions during a moderate-to-severe side impact.

Housing Locations
Side Curtain Airbag Storage

The side curtain airbags are located in the ceiling above the side windows on both sides of the vehicle.

Operation
Deployed Side Curtain Airbag

The side curtain airbag is designed to deploy in a moderate-to-severe side impact.

■When side curtain airbags deploy in a frontal collision

One or both side curtain airbags may inflate in a moderate-to-severe angled frontal collision.

>>Side Curtain Airbags

The side curtain airbags are most effective when an occupant is wearing their seat belt properly and sitting upright, well back in their seat.

Do not attach any objects to the side windows or roof pillars as they can interfere with the proper operation of the side curtain airbags.

Do not put a coat hanger or hard objects on a coat hook. This could result in injuries if your side curtain airbag inflates.

Airbag System Indicators

If a problem occurs in the airbag system, the SRS indicator comes on and a message appears on the multi-information display.

Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator

Honda Jazz (2018) - Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with control panel and three icon buttons (no text or symbols)

■When the ignition switch is turned to ON [II]\*1

The indicator comes on for a few seconds, then goes off. This tells you the system is working properly.

If the indicator comes on at any other time, or does not come on at all, have the system checked by a dealer as soon as possible. If you don't, your airbags and seat belt tensioners may not work properly when they are needed.

Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator

WARNING

Ignoring the SRS indicator can result in serious injury or death if the airbag systems or tensioners do not work properly.

Have your vehicle checked by a dealer as soon as possible if the SRS indicator alerts you to a possible problem.

Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator

PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF ON

■When the passenger airbag off indicator comes on

The indicator stays on while the passenger's front airbag system is deactivated.

When a rear-facing child restraint system is not in use in the front passenger seat, manually turn the system back on. The indicator should go off.

Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator

WARNING

Remove the rear-facing child restraint system immediately from the front passenger seat if the SRS indicator comes on. Even if the passenger front airbag has been deactivated, do not ignore the SRS indicator.

The SRS system may have a fault which could cause the passenger front airbag to be activated, causing serious injury or death.

Airbag Care

You do not need to, and should not, perform any maintenance on or replace any airbag system components yourself. However, you should have your vehicle inspected by a dealer in the following situations:

■When the airbags have deployed

If an airbag has inflated, the control unit and other related parts must be replaced. Similarly, once an automatic seat belt tensioner has been activated, it must be replaced.

■When the vehicle has been in a moderate-to-severe collision

Even if the airbags did not inflate, have your dealer inspect the following: front seat belt tensioners, and each seat belt that was worn during the crash.

Airbag Care

The removal of airbag components from the vehicle is prohibited.

In case of malfunction, or shutdown, or after the airbag inflation/seat belt tensioner operation, ask a qualified personnel for handling.

We recommend against the use of salvaged airbag system components, including the airbag, tensioners, sensors, and control unit.

Child Safety

Protecting Child Passengers

Each year, many children are injured or killed in vehicle crashes because they are either unrestrained or not properly restrained. In fact, vehicle crashes are the number one cause of death of children aged 12 and under.

To reduce the number of child deaths and injuries, infants and children should be properly restrained when they ride in a vehicle.

Protecting Child Passengers

WARNING

Children who are unrestrained or improperly restrained can be seriously injured or killed in a crash.

Any child too small for a seat belt should be properly restrained in an approved child restraint system. A larger child should be properly restrained with a seat belt, using a booster seat if necessary.

In many countries, the law requires all children aged 12 and under, and whose height are shorter than 150 cm (60 inches) be properly restrained in a rear seat.

In many countries, it is required to use an officially approved and suitable child restraint system for transporting a child on any passenger seat. Check your local legal requirement.

European models

Child restraint systems must meet UN Regulation No. 44 or No. 129 or the regulations of the subject countries.

→ Selecting a Child Restraint System P. 69

Except European models

We recommend that child restraint systems meet UN Regulation No. 44 or No. 129, or the regulations of the subject countries.

Children should sit properly restrained in a rear seat. This is because:

Honda Jazz (2018) - Children should sit properly restrained in a rear seat. This is because: - 1

natural_image Illustration of two people relaxing on a sofa, one seated and one standing (no text or symbols)
  • An inflating front or side airbag can injure or kill a child sitting in the front seat.
  • A child in the front seat is more likely to interfere with the driver's ability to safely control the vehicle.
    • Statistics show that children of all sizes and ages are safer when they are properly restrained in a rear seat.

  • Any child who is too small to wear a seat belt must be properly restrained in an approved child restraint system that is properly secured to the vehicle using the seat belt or the child restraint anchorage system.

  • Never hold a child on your lap because it is impossible to protect them in the event of a collision.
  • Never put a seat belt over yourself and a child. During a crash, the belt would likely press deep into the child and cause serious or fatal injuries.
  • Never let two children use the same seat belt. Both children could be very seriously injured in a crash.

Protecting Child Passengers

Front Passenger's Sunvisor

WARNING

AIRBAG NO BOAT A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z

NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in front of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD can occur.

  • Do not allow children to operate the doors, windows or seat adjustments.
  • Do not leave children in the vehicle unattended, especially in hot weather when the inside of the vehicle can get hot enough to kill them. They could also activate vehicle controls causing it to move unexpectedly.

>>Protecting Child Passengers

WARNING: Use the power window lock button to prevent children from opening the windows. Using this feature will prevent children from playing with the windows, which could expose them to hazards or distract the driver.

Opening/Closing the Power Windows P. 162

WARNING: Always take the ignition key with you whenever you leave the vehicle alone (with other occupants).

To remind you of the passenger's front airbag hazards and child safety, your vehicle has the warning label on the sun visor. Please read and follow the instructions on the label.

→Safety Labels P. 83

Safety of Infants and Small Children

Protecting Infants

An infant must be properly restrained in a rear-facing, reclining child restraint system until the infant reaches the restraint system manufacturer's weight or height limit for the seat, and the infant is at least one year old.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Protecting Infants - 1

natural_image Line drawing of a car seatbelt with hands placed on the seat (no text or symbols)

■Positioning a rear-facing child restraint system

Child restraint system must be placed and secured in a rear seating position.

Protecting Infants

WARNING

Placing a rear-facing child restraint system in the front seat can result in serious injury or death if the passenger's front airbag inflates.

Always place a rear-facing child restraint system in the back seat, not the front.

As required by UN Regulation No. 94:

WARNING

AIRBAG NO BOAT A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z

NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in front of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD can occur.

When properly installed, a rear-facing child restraint system may prevent the driver or a front passenger from moving their seat all the way back, or from locking their seat-back in the desired position.

>>Protecting Infants

Many experts recommend use of a rear-facing child restraint system for a child up to two years old if the child's height and weight are appropriate for a rear-facing child restraint system.

If the passenger's front airbag inflates, it can hit the rear-facing child restraint system with great force, which can dislodge or strike the system, and seriously injure the child.

Rear-facing child restraint systems should never be installed in a front facing position.

Always refer to the child restraint system manufacturer's instructions before installation.

If it is absolutely unavoidable to install a rear-facing child restraint system in the front passenger seat, manually turn off the passenger front airbag system.

→ Passenger Front Airbag Off System P. 54

Continued

Protecting Smaller Children

If a child is at least one year old and has exceeded the weight and height limitations of a rear-facing child restraint system, the child should be properly restrained in a firmly secured front facing child restraint system until they exceed the weight and height limitations for the front facing child restraint system.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Protecting Smaller Children - 1

natural_image Line drawing of a child seated in a car seat, no text or symbols present

■Front facing child restraint system placement

We strongly recommend placing a front facing child restraint system in a rear seating position.

Placing a front facing child restraint system in the front seat can be hazardous. A rear seat is the safest place for a child.

Protecting Smaller Children

WARNING

Placing a front facing child restraint system in the front seat can result in serious injury or death if the front airbag inflates.

If you must place a front facing child restraint system in front, move the vehicle seat as far back as possible, and properly restrain the child.

Educate yourself about the laws and regulations regarding child restraint system use where you are driving, and follow the child restraint system manufacturer's instructions.

Selecting a Child Restraint System

Some child restraint systems are lower anchorage compatible. Some have a rigid-type connector, while others have a flexible-type connector. Both are equally easy to use. Some existing and previously owned child restraint systems can only be installed using the seat belt. Whichever type you choose, follow the child restraint system manufacturer's use and care instructions including recommended expiration dates as well as the instructions in this manual. Proper installation is key to maximizing your child's safety.

The flexible type may not be available in your country.

In seating positions and vehicles not equipped with lower anchorages, install a child restraint system using the seat belt and a top tether for added security. This is because all child restraint systems must be secured with the seat belt when the lower anchorage system is not in use. In addition, the child restraint system manufacturer may advise that a seat belt be used to attach an ISO FIX restraint system once a child reaches a specified weight. Please read the child restraint system owner's manual for proper installation instructions.

■Important consideration when selecting a child restraint system

Make sure the child restraint system meets the following three requirements:

  • The child restraint system is the correct type and size for the child.
  • The child restraint system is the correct type for the seating position.
  • The child restraint system is compliant with safety standards. We recommend a child restraint system compliant with UN Regulation No. 44 or No. 129, or the regulations of the subject countries. Look for the approval mark on the system and the manufacturer's statement of compliance on the box.

Selecting a Child Restraint System

Installation of a lower anchorage-compatible child restraint system is simple.

Lower anchorage-compatible child restraint systems have been developed to simplify the installation process and reduce the likelihood of injuries caused by incorrect installation.

We recommend a rear-facing or a front facing Honda genuine ISOFIX child restraint system for infants or small children, respectively. Ask your dealer.

Various types of child restraint systems are available. Not all types are suitable for your vehicle. Please refer to the table below to select which category of child restraint system can be used on each seating position.

Mass groupSeating position
Front passenger Rear passenger
Passenger front airbag ON/OFF switch position
OFF ON Rear outboard Rear centre
group 0 Up to 10 kg U*1,*2,*4,*5XU*3,*4U*3,*4
group 0+ Up to 13 kg U*1,*2,*4,*5X IL (Honda BABY-SAFE ISOFIX), or U*3,*4U*3,*4
group I 9 kg to 18 kg U*1,*2,*4,*5UF*1,*2,*4,*5IUF (Size class A, B1, B) or U*3,*4U*3,*4
group II 15 kg to 25 kg U*1,*2,*4,*5UF*1,*2,*4,*5L (Honda KID FIX XP SICT) or U*3,*4U*3,*4
group III 22 kg to 36 kg U*1,*2,*4,*5UF*1,*2,*4,*5L (Honda KID FIX XP SICT) or U*3,*4U*3,*4

IL: Suitable for particular ISO FIX child restraint systems (CRS) given in this list.
IUF: Suitable for front facing ISOFIX child restraints system of universal category approved for use in this mass group.
L: Suitable for particular child restraint systems given in this table. These restraints may be of the “specific vehicle,” “restricted,” or “semi-universal” category.
U: Suitable for "universal" category restraints approved for use in this mass group.
UF: Suitable for front facing "universal" category restraints approved for use in this mass group.
X: Seat position not suitable for children in this mass group.

Models with front seat height adjustment

*1: Move the front seat to its slide rail rearmost position.
*2: Adjust seat height to the most upper end position.
*3: Adjust seat-back angle to the upright position (Front most lock position).
*4: Adjust seat-back angle to the upright position (Front most lock position).
*5: Move the front seat to its slide rail rearmost position.

Models without front seat height adjustment

Seating position in the vehicle

Front seat Rear outer seat Rear centre seat

i-Size child restraint systems X i-U X

i-U: Suitable for i-Size "universal" Child Restraint Systems for forward and rearward facing. X: Seating position not suitable for i-Size "universal" Child Restraint systems.

A size class is specified for some child restraint systems. Make sure to check the size class as indicated on the manufacturer's instructions, package, and labels of the child restraint.

The particular child restraints in the table are Honda Genuine Parts. They are available from your dealer.

For a correct installation, please refer to the Child Restraint Instruction Manual.

Installing a Lower Anchorage-Compatible Child Restraint System

A lower anchorage-compatible child restraint system can be installed in either of the two outer rear seats. A child restraint system is attached to the lower anchorages with either the rigid or flexible type of connectors.

Marks

Lower Anchorages Rigid Type

  1. Locate the lower anchorages under the marks.

  2. Make sure to lock the seat-back in the upright position.

  3. Lower the head restraint to its lowest position.

  4. Place the child restraint system on the vehicle seat then attach the child restraint system to the lower anchorages according to the instructions that came with the child restraint system.

When installing the child restraint system, make sure that the lower anchorages are not obstructed by the seat belt or any other object.

Installing a Lower Anchorage-Compatible Child Restraint System

WARNING

Never attach two child restraint system to the same anchor. In a collision, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold two child restraint system attachments and may break, causing serious injury or death.

Some child restraint systems come with optional guide-cups, which avoid possible damage to the seat surface. Follow the manufacturer's instructions when using the guide-cups, and attach them to the lower anchorages as shown in the image.

Lower Anchorage Guide-cup

Flexible TypeLo

Cover TOP TETHER Top Tether Anchor Symbol

FR Anchorage Tether Strap Hook

  1. Open the tether anchorage cover.
  2. Route the tether strap over the seat-back. Make sure the strap is not twisted.
  3. Secure the tether strap hook to the anchorage.
  4. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the child restraint system manufacturer.

  5. Make sure the child restraint system is firmly secured by rocking it forward and back, and side to side; little movement should be felt.

  6. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child can reach is buckled.

Installing a Lower Anchorage-Compatible Child Restraint System

For your child's safety, when using a child restraint system installed using the lower anchorage system, make sure that the child restraint system is properly secured to the vehicle. A child restraint system that is not properly secured will not adequately protect a child in a crash and may cause injury to the child or other vehicle occupants.

The flexible type may not be available in your country.

WARNING: Never use a hook that does not come with a Top Tether anchor symbol when securing an installed child restraint system.

Support Leg

Child restraint system with support leg

  1. Stretch the support leg until it touches the floor as instructed by the child restraint system manufacturer.

▶ Confirm that the section of the floor on which the support leg rests is level. If the section is not level, the support leg will not provide adequate support. If this is the case, move the seat forward or back so that the support leg is resting on a level section.

Installing a Child Restraint System with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt

Honda Jazz (2018) - Installing a Child Restraint System with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt - 1

natural_image Illustration of a person seated in a chair, viewed from the side (no text or symbols present)
  1. Make sure to lock the seat-back in the upright position.
  2. Lower the head restraint to its lowest position.
  3. Place the child restraint system on the vehicle seat.
  4. Route the seat belt through the child restraint system according to the child restraint system manufacturer's instructions, and insert the latch plate into the buckle.
    ▶ Insert the latch plate fully until it clicks.

Installing a Child Restraint System with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt

A child restraint system that is not properly secured will not adequately protect a child in a crash and may cause injury to the child or other vehicle occupants.

Tab

  1. Push down the tab. Route the shoulder part of the belt into the slit at the side of the restraint.
  2. Grab the shoulder part of the belt near the buckle, and pull up to remove any slack from the lap part of the belt.

When doing this, place your weight on child restraint system and push it into the vehicle seat.

  1. Position the belt properly and push up the tab. Make sure the belt is not twisted.
    When pushing up the tab, pull up the upper shoulder part of the belt to remove any slack from the belt.
  2. Make sure the child restraint system is firmly secured by rocking it forward and back, and side to side; little movement should be felt.
  3. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child can reach is buckled.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Installing a Child Restraint System with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt - 3

natural_image Illustration of a person performing a seated exercise with directional arrows indicating motion (no text or symbols)

Locking Clip

Except European models

If your child restraint system does not come with a mechanism that secures the belt, install a locking clip on the seat belt.

After going through the step 1 and 4, pull up the shoulder part of the belt and make sure there is no slack in the lap portion.

  1. Tightly grasp the belt near the latch plate. Pinch both parts of the belt together so they do not slip through the latch plate. Unbuckle the seat belt.

  2. Install the locking clip as shown in the image. Position the clip as close as possible to the latch plate.

  3. Insert the latch plate into the buckle. Go to step 8 and 9.

Adding Security with a Tether

Tether Anchorage Points Cover

Two tether anchorage points are provided on the ceiling for rear outer seating positions. If you have a child restraint system that comes with a tether but can be installed with a seat belt, the tether may be used for additional security.

FR Anchorage Tether Strap Hook

  1. Locate the appropriate tether anchorage point.
  2. Lower the head restraint to its lowest position.
  3. Open the anchorage cover.
  4. Route the tether strap over the seat-back. Make sure the strap is not twisted.
  5. Secure the tether strap hook onto the anchorage.
  6. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the child restraint system manufacturer.

Adding Security with a Tether

WARNING: Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads imposed by correctly fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are they to be used for adult seat belts, harnesses or for attaching other items or equipment to the vehicle.

Always use a tether for forward facing child seats when using the seat belt or lower anchors.

Safety of Larger Children

Protecting Larger Children

The following pages give instructions on how to check proper seat belt fit, what kind of booster seat to use if one is needed, and important precautions for a child who must sit in front.

Checking Seat Belt Fit

When a child is too big for a child restraint system, secure the child in a rear seat using the lap/shoulder seat belt. Have the child sit upright and all the way back, then answer the following questions.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Checking Seat Belt Fit - 1

natural_image Illustration of a person sitting on a chair wearing a seatbelt (no text or symbols)

Checklist

  • Do the child's knees bend comfortably over the edge of the seat?
  • Does the shoulder belt cross between the child's neck and arm?
  • Is the lap part of the seat belt as low as possible, touching the child's thighs?
  • Will the child be able to stay seated like this for the whole trip?

If you answer yes to all these questions, the child is ready to wear the lap/shoulder seat belt correctly. If you answer no to any question, the child needs to ride on a booster seat until the seat belt fits properly without a booster seat.

Safety of Larger Children

WARNING

Allowing a child aged 12 or under to sit in front can result in injury or death if the passenger's front airbag inflates.

If a larger child must ride in front, move the vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible, have the child sit up properly and wear the seat belt properly, using a booster seat if needed.

Booster Seats

Honda Jazz (2018) - Booster Seats - 1

natural_image Illustration of a person sitting on a sofa wearing a seatbelt, viewed from the side (no text or symbols present)

If a lap/shoulder seat belt cannot be used properly, position the child in a booster seat in the rear seat. For the child's safety, check that the child meets the booster seat manufacturer's recommendations.

Guide

A backrest is available for a specific booster seat. Install the backrest to the booster seat and adjust it to the vehicle seat according to the booster seat manufacturer's instructions. Make sure the seat belt is properly routed through the guide at the shoulder of the backrest and the belt does not touch and cross the child's neck.

Booster Seats

When installing a booster seat, make sure to read the instructions that came with it, and install the seat accordingly.

There are high- and low-type booster seats. Choose a booster seat that allows the child to wear the seat belt correctly.

We recommend a booster seat with a backrest as it is easier to adjust the shoulder belt.

Protecting Larger Children - Final Checks

Your vehicle has a rear seat where children can be properly restrained. If you ever have to carry a group of children, and a child must ride in front:

  • Make sure you read and fully understand the instructions and safety information in this manual.
  • Move the front passenger seat as far back as possible.
  • Have the child sit upright and well back in the seat.
  • Check that the seat belt is properly positioned so that the child is secure in the seat.

■Monitoring child passengers

We strongly recommend that you keep an eye on child passengers. Even older, more mature children sometimes need to be reminded to fasten their seat belts and sit up properly.

Exhaust Gas Hazard

Carbon Monoxide Gas

The engine exhaust from this vehicle contains carbon monoxide, a colourless, odourless, and highly toxic gas. As long as you properly maintain your vehicle, carbon monoxide gas will not get into the interior.

■Have the exhaust system inspected for leaks whenever

  • The exhaust system is making an unusual noise.
  • The exhaust system may have been damaged.
  • The vehicle is raised for an oil change.

When you operate a vehicle with the tailgate open, airflow can pull exhaust gas into the interior and create a hazardous condition. If you must drive with the tailgate open, open all the windows and set the heating and cooling system */climate control system* as shown below.

  1. Select the fresh air mode.
  2. Select the mode.
  3. Set the fan speed to high.
  4. Set the temperature control to a comfortable setting.

Adjust the heating and cooling system*/climate control system* in the same manner if you sit in your parked vehicle with the engine running.

Carbon Monoxide Gas

WARNING

Carbon monoxide gas is toxic. Breathing it can cause unconsciousness and even kill you.

Avoid any enclosed areas or activities that expose you to carbon monoxide.

An enclosed area such as a garage can quickly fill up with carbon monoxide gas.

Do not run the engine with the garage door closed. Even when the garage door is open, drive out of the garage immediately after starting the engine.

Safety Labels

Label Locations

These labels are in the locations shown. They warn you of potential hazards that can cause serious injury or death. Read these labels carefully.

If a label comes off or becomes hard to read, contact a dealer for a replacement.

Sun Visor Child Safety/SRS Airbag (Left-hand drive type) P. 62 Sun Visor Child Safety/SRS Airbag (Right-hand drive type) P. 62 Fuel Filler Caution Label P. 471 Passenger Front Airbag Off System Label (Left-hand drive type) P. 54 Passenger Front Airbag Off System Label (Right-hand drive type) P. 54 Air Conditioner Label P. 529 Radiator Cap Radiator Cap Danger Label Battery Danger Label P. 526

Instrument Panel

This chapter describes the buttons, indicators, and gauges that are used while driving.

Indicators 86

Multi-Information Display Warning and

Information Messages.... 108

Gauges and Multi-Information Display

Gauges.... 123

Multi-Information Display 124

Indicators

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 1Parking Brake and Brake System Indicator (Red)Comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON *1, then goes off if the parking brake has been released.Comes on when the parking brake is applied, and goes off when it is released.The beeper sounds and the indicator comes on if you drive with the parking brake not fully released.Comes on when the brake fluid level is low.Comes on if there is a problem with the brake system.Comes on while driving- Make sure the parking brake is released. Check the brake fluid level.What to do when the indicator comes on while driving P. 569Comes on along with the ABS indicator - Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On P. 569Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 2

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 3Brake System Indicator (Amber)Comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.Comes on if there is a problem with a system related to braking other than the conventional brake system.Stays on constantly- Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 4
Comes on if there is a problem with the City-Brake Active system.Comes on along with the CTBA indicator- The City-Brake Active system does not activate. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.City-Brake Active system P. 457Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 5

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 6Low Oil Pressure IndicatorComes on when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , and goes off when the engine starts.Comes on when the engine oil pressure is low.Comes on while driving - Immediately stop in a safe place.If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On P. 568Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 7
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 8Malfunction Indicator LampComes on when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , and goes off when the engine starts.Comes on if there is a problem with the emissions control system.Blinks when a misfire in the engine's cylinders is detected.Comes on while driving - Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Blinks while driving - Stop in a safe place where there are no flammable objects. Stop the engine for 10 minutes or more, and wait for it to cool down. Then, take your vehicle to a dealer.If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks P. 569Shows the self-testing condition of the diagnostics of the emission control system.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 9

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 10Charging System IndicatorComes on when you turn the ignition switch to ON II*, and goes off when the engine starts.Comes on when the battery is not charging.Comes on while driving- Turn off the heating and cooling system*/ climate control system* and rear demister in order to reduce electricity consumption.If the Charging System Indicator Comes On P. 568Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 11
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 12Shift Lever Position Indicator*Indicates the current shift lever position.Shifting P. 402Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 13
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 14Transmission Indicator*Blinks if the transmission system has a problem.Blinks while driving- Avoid sudden starts and acceleration and have your vehicle checked by a dealer immediately.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 15

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 16M (7-speed manual shift mode)Indicator/Shift Indicator*Comes on when 7-speed manual shift mode is applied.7-Speed Manual Shift ModeP. 404Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 17
Seat Belt Reminder IndicatorComes on if you are not wearing a seat belt when you turn the ignition switch to ON II*1.If the front passenger is not wearing a seat belt, the indicator comes on about a few seconds later.Blinks while driving if either you or the front passenger has not fastened a seat belt. The beeper sounds and the indicator blinks at regular intervals.The beeper stops and the indicator goes off when you and the front passenger fasten their seat belts.Stays on after you or the front passenger has fastened the seat belt - A detection error may have occurred in the sensor. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Seat Belt Reminder P. 39Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 18

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 19Low Fuel IndicatorComes on when the fuel reserve is running low (approximately 5.3 Litres/1.17 Imp gal left).Blinks if there is a problem with the fuel gauge.Comes on - Refuel your vehicle as soon as possible.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 20
Blinks - Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 21
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 22Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) IndicatorComes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.If it comes on at any other time, there is a problem with the ABS.Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle checked by a dealer. With this indicator on, your vehicle still has normal braking ability but no anti-lock function.Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)P. 455Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 23
Supplemental Restraint System IndicatorComes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.Comes on if a problem with any of the following is detected: Supplemental restraint systemSide airbag systemSide curtain airbag systemSeat belt tensionerStays on constantly or does not come on at all - Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 24

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Continued

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 25Passenger Front Airbag On/Off IndicatorsBoth indicators come on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off after a system check up.When the passenger front airbag is active: The on indicator comes back on and remains on for about 60 seconds. When the passenger front airbag is inactive: The off indicator comes back on and stays on. This is a reminder that the passenger front airbag is deactivated.→Passenger Front Airbag Off System P. 54

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 26Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System IndicatorComes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.Blinks when VSA is active.Comes on if there is a problem with the VSA or hill start assist system.Stays on constantly- Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System P. 446Hill start assist system P. 394, 398Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 27Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 28
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 29Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) OFF IndicatorComes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.Comes on when you deactivate VSA.VSA On and Off P. 447Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 30

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 31High Temperature Indicator (Red)Comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON *1, then goes off.Blinks when the engine coolant temperature goes up, and stays on if the temperature continues to rise.Goes off, then comes on blue when the engine coolant temperature is low.
Blinks while driving- Drive slowly to prevent overheating.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 32(White)
Stays on while driving- Immediately stop in a safe place and allow the engine to cool.➤Overheating P. 566Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 33(Amber)
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 34Low Temperature Indicator (Blue)Comes on when the engine coolant temperature is low.If the indicator stays on after the engine has reached normal operating temperature, there may be a problem with the temperature sensors. Have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 35Door and Tailgate Open IndicatorComes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.Comes on if any door or the tailgate is not completely closed.The beeper sounds and the indicator comes on if any door or the tailgate is opened while driving.Goes off when all doors and the tailgate are closed.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 36

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 37Low Tyre Pressure/ Deflation Warning System IndicatorComes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON *1, then goes off.May come on briefly if the ignition switch is turned to ON *1and the vehicle is not moved within 45 seconds, to indicate the calibration process is not yet complete.Comes on and stays on when: - One or more tyres' pressures are determined to be significantly low. - The system has not been calibrated.Comes on while driving- Stop in a safe place, check tyre pressures, and inflate the tyre(s) if necessary.Stays on after the tyres are inflated to the recommended pressures -The system needs to be calibrated.Deflation Warning System Calibration P. 449Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 38
Blinks for about one minute, and then stays on if there is a problem with the deflation warning system, or when a compact spare tyre* is temporarily installed.Blinks and remains on- Have your vehicle checked by a dealer. If the vehicle is fitted with a compact spare, get your regular tyre repaired or replaced and put back on your vehicle as soon as you can.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 39

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 40Electric Power Steering (EPS) System IndicatorComes on when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , and goes off when the engine starts.Comes on if there is a problem with the EPS system.Stays on constantly or does not come on at all - Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator Comes On P. 570Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 41
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 42System Message IndicatorComes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.Comes on along with a beep when a problem is detected. A system message on the multi-information display appears at the same time.While the indicator is on, press the ▲1/▼ (information) button to see the message again.Refer to the Indicators information in this chapter when a system message appears on the multi-information display. Take appropriate action for the message.The multi-information display does not return to the normal screen unless the warning is cancelled, or the button is pressed.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 43

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning IndicatorsBlinks when you operate the turn signal lever.Blink along with all turn signals if you press the hazard warning button.Blinks along with all turn signals when you depress the brake pedal during high speed driving.Does not blink or blinks rapidly - A turn signal light bulb has blown.Change the bulb immediately.Replacing Light Bulbs P. 503, 505Emergency Stop Signal P. 462
High Beam IndicatorComes on when the high beam headlights are on.
Lights On IndicatorComes on whenever the light switch is on, or in AUTO when the exterior lights are on.If you remove the key from the ignition switch*, or set the power mode* to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) while the exterior lights are on, a chime sounds when the driver's door is opened.
Front Fog Light Indicator*Comes on when the front fog lights are on.
Rear Fog Light IndicatorComes on when the rear fog light is on.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 44Immobilizer System IndicatorComes on briefly when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.Comes on if the immobilizer system cannot recognize the key information.Blinks -Models without keyless access systemYou cannot start the engine. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0, pull the key out, and then insert the key and turn it to ON again.Models with keyless access systemYou cannot start the engine. Set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), then select the ON mode again.Repeatedly blinks- The system may be malfunctioning. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Do not try to alter this system or add other devices to it. Electrical problems can occur.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 45Security System Alarm Indicator*Blinks when the security system alarm has been set. ➤ Security System Alarm * P. 159Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 46
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 47Keyless Access System Indicator*Comes on for a few seconds when you set the power mode to ON, then goes off.Comes on as soon as a problem is detected in the keyless access system or keyless starting system.Stays on constantly or does not come on at all - Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 48

*1: Left-hand drive type
*2: Right-hand drive type

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
*3UPShift Up IndicatorComes on briefly when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.Comes on when shifting up is recommended.Shift Up IndicatorP. 406Shift Up/Down IndicatorsP. 408
*3Shift Down IndicatorComes on briefly when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.Comes on when shifting down is recommended.Shift Up/Down IndicatorsP. 408
Cruise Main IndicatorComes on when the cruise control is ready to use.Cruise Control P. 420
Adjustable Speed Limiter IndicatorComes on when the adjustable speed limiter is ready to use.Adjustable Speed Limiter P. 423
Cruise Control and Adjustable Speed Limiter Set Speed IndicatorComes on when you have set a speed for cruise control or for adjustable speed limiter.Cruise Control P. 420Adjustable Speed Limiter P. 423

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

*2: Continuously variable transmission models

*3: Manual transmission models

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 49High Beam Support System Indicator*Comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON *1, then goes off.Comes on when all the operating conditions of the high beam support system are met.Auto High-Beam (High Beam Support System)* P. 175Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 50
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 51Auto Idle Stop Indicator (Green)Comes on when Auto Idle Stop is in operation. The engine automatically shuts off.Auto Idle Stop P. 410, 415Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 52
Models with climate control systemBlinks when the ambient conditions may cause the windows to fog up.Blinks when the ambient conditions may become different from the climate control settings you have selected.(windscreen demister) is touched.Models with heating and cooling systemBlinks when the fan is turned on and the mode control dial is turned toManual transmission modelsDepress the clutch pedal. The engine automatically restarts.Auto Idle Stop P. 415Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 53

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 54Auto Idle Stop System Indicator (Amber)Comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.Blinks if there is a problem with the Auto Idle Stop system.Blinks - Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 55
Comes on when the Auto Idle Stop system has been turned off by the Auto Idle Stop system OFF button.Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF P. 411, 416Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 56

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON *1, then goes off.Comes on when you have customized forward collision warning system to turn off.Comes on if there is a problem with the system.Stays on constantly without the system off- Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 57
Forward Collision Warning Indicator*Comes on when the system shuts itself off.Stays on- The temperature inside the camera is too high. The system activates when the temperature inside the system cools down.Automatic shutoff P. 436Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 58
Stays on- The area around the camera is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your vehicle in a safe place, and wipe it off with a soft cloth.Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the indicator and message come back on after you cleaned the area around the camera.Automatic shutoff P. 436Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 59

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
Lane Departure Warning Indicator*Comes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON *1, then goes off.Comes on if there is a problem with the lane departure warning system.Stays on constantly- Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 60
Comes on when the system shuts itself off.Stays on- The temperature inside the camera is too high.Use the heating and cooling system*/ climate control system * to cool down the camera.The system activates when the temperature inside the camera cools down.Lane Departure Warning Camera P. 439Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 61
Stays on- The area around the camera is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your vehicle in a safe place, and wipe it off with a soft cloth.Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the indicator and message come back on after you cleaned the area around the camera.Lane Departure Warning Camera P. 439Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 62

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models

Continued

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
CTBACity-Brake Active System (CTBA) IndicatorComes on for a few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , then goes off.
Goes off when you have customized the City-Brake Active system to turn on.Comes on when you have customized the City-Brake Active system to turn off.City-Brake Active system P. 457Customized Features P. 131
Comes on when the area around the laser sensor, which is located in the upper part of the windscreen, is covered with obstacles, such as dirt, ice and frost.May come on when driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow).Remove the dirt or any obstacles using the washer and wipers.Stop your vehicle in a safe place and wipe away dirt or any obstacles covering the area around the laser sensor on the windscreen.City-Brake Active system P. 457The system resumes when obstacles are removed.CTBA
Comes on when snow is accumulated on the bonnet.Stop your vehicle in a safe place and remove snow from the bonnet.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

IndicatorNameOn/BlinkingExplanationMessage
CTBACity-Brake Active System (CTBA) Indicator· May come on when the temperatures of the area around the laser sensor are high.· Use the heating and cooling system */ climate control system * to cool down the area around the laser sensor.· The system resumes when the temperatures of the area around the laser sensor go down.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 63
· Comes on along with the brake system indicator (amber) if there is a problem with the system.· The system does not activate. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Honda Jazz (2018) - Indicators - 64

Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages

The following messages appear only on the multi-information display. Press the ▲④/▼ (information) button to see the message again with the system message indicator on.

Message Condition Explanation
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 1Continuously variable transmission modelsAppears while you are customizing the settings and the shift lever is moved out ofP.Manual transmission modelsAppears while you are customizing the settings and the parking brake is released.Customized Features P. 131
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 2Appears once if the outside temperature is below 3°C while the ignition switch is in ON II*1.There is a possibility that the road surface is icy and slippery.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 3Appears when any of the rear seat belts are latched or unlatched, or either rear door is opened and closed.Seat Belt Reminder P. 39
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 4Appears when the vehicle speed reaches the set speed. You can set two different speeds for the alarm.Speed Alarm Setting P. 129

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Message Condition Explanation
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 5Appears when the engine oil level is low while the engine is running.Appears while driving - Immediately stop in a safe place.If the Low Oil Level Symbol Appears P. 572
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 6Appears when the engine is running, there is a system problem in the engine oil level sensor.Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 7Appears if there is a problem with the automatic lighting control system.Appears while driving - Manually turn the lights on, and have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Models with LED headlightsAppears if there is a problem with the headlights with LED.Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 8• Flashes when the City-Brake Active system senses a likely collision with a vehicle in front of you. The beeper sounds.• Depress the brake pedal, and keep an appropriate distance from the vehicle ahead. The alert will disappear.• The system automatically applies the brake if a possible collision becomes likely unavoidable. ➞ City-Brake Active system P. 457
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 9Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 10• Changes the display when your vehicle is stopped by the City-Brake Active system. The beeper stops.Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate for some reason.Appears when the engine restarts automatically.
Auto Idle Stop Activates When: P. 412, 417
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 11Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate because the engine coolant temperature is low or high.Auto Idle Stop does not activate when: P. 412, 417
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 12Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate because the climate control system is in use, and the difference between the set temperature and actual interior temperature becomes significant.Auto Idle Stop P. 410, 415
Continuously variable transmission modelsModels with climate control systemAppears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate because the climate control system is in use, and the difference between the set temperature and actual interior temperature becomes significant.The engine restarts automatically in a few seconds.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 13Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate because the battery charge level is low.Appears when the battery is low performance.Auto Idle Stop P. 410, 415
Appears when the system is under the following conditions while Auto Idle Stop activates:- The battery charge level is low.The engine restarts automatically in a few seconds.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 14Appears when the bonnet is opened.Close the bonnet.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 15Appears when there is a problem with the sensor on the battery.Appears when the battery is not charging.Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Checking the Battery P. 522Appears along with the battery charging system indicator - Turn off the climate control system and rear defogger to reduce electricity consumption.If the Charging System Indicator Comes On P. 568

Continuously variable transmission models

Message Condition Explanation
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 16Appears if you press the ENGINE START/STOP button to turn the engine off without the shift lever in P.Press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice with your foot off the brake pedal, after moving the shift lever to P.
Appears when the engine stops without the shift lever in P, and does not restart automatically.If you want to turn the ignition switch to ON II*1, move the shift lever to P.
Appears if you open the bonnet with Auto Idle Stop activated.If you want to start the engine, follow the normal procedure.Starting the Engine P. 392, 395
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 17Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate because the pressure to the brake pedal is not enough.Depress the brake pedal firmly.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Manual transmission models
Message Condition Explanation
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 18Appears when the shift lever is in any position exceptN.Shift to N.➢ Auto Idle Stop Activates When: P. 417
Honda Jazz (2018) - Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages - 19Appears in white when you turn the ignition switch to START III*1 before fully depressing the clutch pedal.Depress the clutch pedal.
Models with climate control systemBlinks when the ambient conditions may cause the windows to fog up.Blinks when the ambient conditions may become different from the climate control settings you have selected.(windscreen demister) is touched.Models with heating and cooling systemBlinks when the fan is turned on and the mode control dial is turned toDepress the clutch pedal. The engine automatically restarts.➢Auto Idle Stop P. 415
Appears in amber when the following conditions are kept while Auto Idle Stop is in operation:- You are not wearing a seat belt.- The shift lever is in any position except N.Depress the clutch pedal. Wear the seat belt immediately, and continue to keep the shift lever in N next time Auto Idle Stop activates.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Models with high beam support system

Message Condition Explanation

Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 1

natural_image Simple dark circular shape with a small symbol inside, no text or labels present.
  • Appears when there is a problem with the high beam support system.
  • Appears when the high beam support system camera lens gets dirty.

  • Manually operate the headlight switch.

  • If you are driving with the high beam headlights when this happens, the headlights are changed to low beams.
  • Stop in a safe place and clean the camera lens with a soft cloth.
  • If the message does not disappear after cleaning the lens, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Message Condition Explanation
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 2Appears when any of the service items is required in less than 30 days. The remaining days are estimated based on your driving conditions.The remaining days will be counted down per day. ➤ Service Reminder System P. 479
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 3Appears when any of the service items is required in less than 10 days. The remaining days are estimated based on your driving conditions.Have the indicated service performed as soon as possible. ➤ Service Reminder System P. 479
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 4Appears when the indicated maintenance service is still not done after the remaining days reach 0.Your vehicle has passed the service required point. Immediately have the service performed and make sure to reset the service reminder. ➤ Service Reminder System P. 479

Models without keyless access system

Message Condition Explanation
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 5• Appears when the ignition key is turned to ACCESSORY I from ON II. (The driver's door is closed.)
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 6• Appears when you open the driver's door while the ignition key is in ACCESSORY I.• Turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0, then remove the key.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 7• Appears when you open the driver's door while the ignition key is in LOCK 0.• Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 8• Appears in white when you turn the ignition switch to START III before fully depressing the clutch pedal.• Turn the ignition switch after fully depressing the clutch pedal.
• Appears in amber when the engine does not restart automatically due to the following reasons:- The bonnet is open.- There is a problem in the system that disables Auto Idle Stop.• Follow the normal procedure to start the engine. ➤ Starting the Engine P. 392
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 9

*1: Manual transmission models
*2: Continuously variable transmission models

Continued

Models with keyless access system

Message Condition Explanation
Appears in white after you unlock and open the driver's door.Appears in white when you set the power mode to ACCESSORY or ON.Starting the Engine P. 395
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 10Appears in amber when the engine does not restart automatically due to the following reasons:- The bonnet is open.- There is a problem in the system that disables Auto Idle Stop.Follow the normal procedure to start the engine.Starting the Engine P. 395
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 11Appears when the power mode is in ACCESSORY.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 12Appears after the driver's door is opened when the power mode is in ACCESSORY.Press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice with your foot off the brake pedal*1 or the clutch pedal*2 to change the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).

*1: Continuously variable transmission models *2: Manual transmission models

Message Condition Explanation
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 13• Appears when you close the door with the power mode in ON without the keyless remote inside the vehicle.• Goes off when you bring the keyless remote back inside the vehicle and close the door. ➤ Keyless Remote Reminder P. 167
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 14• Appears when the keyless remote battery becomes weak.• Replace the battery as soon as possible. ➤ Replacing the Button Battery P. 527
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 15• Appears if the keyless remote battery is too weak to start the engine or the key is not within operating range to start the engine. A beeper sounds six times.➤ If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak P. 560
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 16Appears if the starting system has a problem.As a temporary measure, press and hold the ENGINE START/STOP button for 15 seconds while pressing the brake pedal and clutch pedal (manual transmission only), and manually start the engine. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 17Continuously variable transmission modelsAppears if you press the ENGINE START/STOP button to turn the engine off without the shift lever in P.Press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice after moving the shift lever to P.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 18Appears when the steering wheel is locked.Move the steering wheel left and right while pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button.

Models with forward collision warning

Message Condition Explanation
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 19• Flashes when the system senses a likely collision with a vehicle in front of you. The beeper sounds.• Take the appropriate means to prevent a collision (apply the brakes, change lanes, etc.) ➤Forward Collision Warning * P. 434
Models with lane departure warning
Message Condition Explanation
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 20• Appears when your vehicle is too close to the traffic lane lines. The beeper sounds.• Take appropriate action to keep your vehicle within the lane lines. ➤Lane Departure Warning * P. 438

Models with parking sensor system

Message Condition Explanation
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 21• Appears if there is a problem with the parking sensor system.• Check if the area around the sensor(s) is covered with mud, ice, snow, etc. If the indicator(s) stays on even after you clean the area, have the system checked by a dealer.
Honda Jazz (2018) - Message Condition Explanation - 22• If there is a problem with any of the sensors, the appropriate sensor indicator(s) comes on.

Gauges and Multi-Information Display

Gauges

Gauges include the speedometer, tachometer, and related indicators. They are displayed when the ignition switch is in ON ^*1 .

Speedometer

Right-hand drive type

Displays your driving speed in km/h and mph.

Left-hand drive type

Displays your driving speed in km/h.

Tachometer

Shows the number of engine revolutions per minute.

Ambient Meter

Changes colour to reflect your driving style.

Green: Fuel efficient driving

Blue green: Moderate acceleration/deceleration

Blue: Aggressive acceleration/deceleration

The ambient meter colour changes in accordance with your brake or accelerator pedal operation.

Multi-Information Display

The multi-information display shows the odometer, trip meter, outside temperature, fuel gauge, and other gauges.

It also displays important messages such as warnings and other helpful information.

Switching the Display

■Main displays

Press the ▲(information) button to change the display.

Switching the Display

Right-hand drive type

Switch between km/h and mph by using the customized features on the multi-information display.

Customized Features P. 131

Honda Jazz (2018) - Right-hand drive type - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Instant Fuel Economy"] --> B["12:34"]
    B --> C["23°C 0 10h 20 km/h"]
    C --> D["23°C 323.4km"]
    D --> E["23°C Avg 10.8h/100km"]
    E --> F["23°C Avg 002300km"]
    F --> G["23°C Avg 300km"]
    G --> H["23°C Avg 60km/h"]
    H --> I["23°C Avg 01h 30m"]
    I --> J["23°C Avg 002300km"]
    J --> K["23°C Avg 60km/h"]
    K --> L["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    L --> M["23°C Avg 30km/h"]
    M --> N["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    N --> O["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    O --> P["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    P --> Q["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    Q --> R["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    R --> S["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    S --> T["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    T --> U["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    U --> V["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    V --> W["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    W --> X["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    X --> Y["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    Y --> Z["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    Z --> AA["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AA --> AB["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AB --> AC["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AC --> AD["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AD --> AE["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AE --> AF["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AF --> AG["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AG --> AH["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AH --> AI["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AI --> AJ["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AJ --> AK["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AK --> AL["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AL --> AM["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AM --> AN["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AN --> AO["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AO --> AP["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AP --> AQ["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AQ --> AR["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AR --> AS["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AS --> AT["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AT --> AU["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AU --> AV["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AV --> AW["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AW --> AX["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AX --> AY["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AY --> AZ["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    AZ --> BA["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BA --> BB["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BB --> BC["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BC --> BD["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BD --> BE["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BE --> BF["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BF --> BG["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BG --> BH["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BH --> BI["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BI --> BJ["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BJ --> BK["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BK --> BL["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BL --> BM["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BM --> BN["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BN --> BO["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BO --> BP["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BP --> BQ["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BQ --> BR["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BR --> BS["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BS --> BT["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BT --> BU["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BU --> BV["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BV --> BW["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BW --> BX["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BX --> BY["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BY --> BZ["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    BZ --> CA["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CA --> CB["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CB --> CC["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CC --> CD["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CD --> CE["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CE --> CF["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CF --> CG["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CG --> CH["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CH --> CI["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CI --> CJ["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CJ --> CK["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CK --> CL["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CL --> CM["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CM --> CN["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CN --> CO["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CO --> CP["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CP --> CQ["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CQ --> CR["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CR --> CS["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CS --> CT["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CT --> CU["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CU --> CV["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CV --> CW["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CW --> CX["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CX --> CY["23°C Avg 50km/h"]
    CY --> CZ["23°C Avg 50km/h"]

* Not available on all models

■Lower displays

Press the SEL/RESET button to change the display.

Odometer Outside Temperature Fuel Gauge 12:34 27°C 902300km SEL RESET Trip A Outside Temperature Fuel Gauge 12:34 27°C & 323.4km SEL RESET Trip B Outside Temperature Fuel Gauge 12:34 27°C 10.0km SEL/RESET Button

Switching the Display

Adjusting the Clock P. 140

Models with display audio system

Some of the items on the information display also appear on the audio/information screen. They also change along with the information display changes while the fuel consumption is shown.

Continued

Odometer

Shows the total number of kilometres or miles* that your vehicle has accumulated.

Trip Meter

Shows the total number of kilometres or miles* driven since the last reset. Trip A and B can be used to measure two separate trips.

■Resetting a trip meter

To reset a trip meter, display it, then press and hold the SEL/RESET button. The trip meter is reset to 0.0.

Average Fuel Economy

Shows the estimated average fuel economy of each trip meter in l/100 km or mpg*. The display is updated at set intervals. When a trip meter is reset, the average fuel economy is also reset.

Range

Shows the estimated distance you can travel on the remaining fuel. This distance is estimated from the fuel economy of your previous trips.

Elapsed Time

Shows the time elapsed since the last time trip A or trip B was reset.

>>Trip Meter

Switch between trip A and B by pressing the SEL/RESET button.

Average Fuel Economy

You can change when to reset the average fuel economy.

Customized Features P. 131

Elapsed Time

You can change when to reset the elapsed time.

Customized Features P. 131

Average Speed

Shows the average speed in km/h or mph ^* since the last time trip A or trip B was reset.

Instant Fuel Economy

Shows the instant fuel economy as a bar graph in l/100 km or mpg.

Outside Temperature

Shows the outside temperature in Celsius.

If the outside temperature has been below 3^ C at the time you turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 , the outside temperature indicator blinks for 10 seconds.

■Adjusting the outside temperature display

Adjust the temperature reading up to ±3^ if the temperature reading seems incorrect.

Rear Seat Belt Use Monitor

Shows the rear seat belt use.

Seat Belt Reminder P. 39

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

* Not available on all models

Continued

>>Average Speed

You can change when to reset the average speed.

→Customized Features P. 131

Outside Temperature

The temperature sensor is in the front bumper. Road heat and exhaust from another vehicle can affect the temperature reading when your vehicle speed is less than 30 km/h (19 mph).

It may take several minutes for the display to be updated after the temperature reading has stabilized.

Use the multi-information display's customized features to correct the temperature.

→Customized Features P. 131

▶▶Gauges and Multi-Information Display▶Multi-Information Display

Fuel Gauge

Displays the amount of fuel left in the fuel tank.

Traffic Sign Recognition System\*

Shows the traffic sign recognition system.

Traffic Sign Recognition System * P. 442

Service Reminder System

Shows the service reminder system.

→ Service Reminder System P. 479

Fuel Gauge

NOTICE

You should refuel when the reading approaches 0. Running out of fuel can cause the engine to misfire, damaging the catalytic converter.

The actual amount of remaining fuel may differ from the fuel gauge reading.

Speed Alarm Setting

Sets the speed alarm on and changes the speed alarm setting.

■To set the speed alarm
12:34 30 km/h 50 km/h SEL: 23°C 002300 km 0

  1. Press the ▲ button until the speed alarm setting screen appears on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.

  2. Press the button and select (speed alarm 1) or [speed alarm 2), then press the SEL/RESET button.

▶ (off) switches to (on) then the display returns to the normal screen.

▶If the speed alarm is ☐h), it switches to ☐ (off).

>>Speed Alarm Setting

The default settings for speed alarm 1) and (speed alarm 2) are off.

You can also return to the normal screen by selecting (exit).

12:34 30km/h 50km/h SEL 0.8 23°C 002300 km 0

Continued

■To change the speed setting
12:34 30 km/h 50 km/h SEL 23°C 002300 km 0 12:34 30 km/h SEL 23°C 002300 km 0

  1. Press the ▲ button until the speed alarm setting menu appears on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.
  2. Press the button and select the speed alarm 1 speed setting or speed alarm 2 speed setting, then press the SEL/RESET button.
  3. Press the button and select the speed, then press the SEL/RESET button.

The speed setting is set, then the display returns to the normal screen.
▶You can set the speed setting over 5 km/h (mph) with 1 km/h (mph) steps.

>>Speed Alarm Setting

You cannot change the speed setting while driving.

Customized Features

Use the multi-information display to customize certain features.

How to customize

Select the E①customize Settings) screen by pressing the button/while the ignition switch is in ON Ⅱ*1, the vehicle is at a complete stop, and the shift lever is in P (continuously variable transmission), and the parking brake is set (manual transmission). Press the SEL/RESET button to enter the customizing mode.

Multi-Information Display: Goes to Customize Settings. 12:34 SEL 23°C 002300.0mm SEL/RESET button: Changes the customize menus and items. SEL/RESET button: Enters the selected item.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Continued

>>Customized Features

To customize other features, press the ▲①/▼ button.

List of customizable options P. 134
Example of customization settings P. 137

When you customize settings:

Continuously variable transmission models Shift to P.

Manual transmission models

Set the parking brake.

■Customization flow

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■Customization flow - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Press the Button."] --> B["(Customize Settings)"]
    B --> C["SEL/RESET"]
    C --> D["Deflation Warning System"]
    D --> E["Clock Setup"]
    E --> F["Sel/RESET"]
    F --> G["Adjust Clock"]
    G --> H["Clock Display"]
    E --> I["Driver Assist System Setup"]
    I --> J["Sel/RESET"]
    J --> K["City-Brake Active System"]
    K --> L["Forward Collision Warning Distance*"]
    K --> M["Traffic Sign Recognition System*"]
    C --> N["▲i"]
    N --> O["▼"]
    O --> P["▲i"]
    P --> Q["▼"]
    Q --> R["▲i"]
    R --> S["▼"]
    S --> T["▲i"]

* Not available on all models

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■Customization flow - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["▲i"] --> B["Meter Setup"]
    B --> C["SEL/RESET"]
    C --> D["Language"]
    D --> E["▲i"]
    E --> F["Distance Display Units*"]
    G["▲i"] --> H["Lighting Setup"]
    H --> I["SEL/RESET"]
    I --> J["Headlight Auto Off Timer"]
    K["▲i"] --> L["Maintenance Info. Mainter"]
    L --> M["SEL/RESET"]
    M --> N["Default All"]
    O["▲i"] --> P["(Exit)"]
    Q["SEL/RESET"] --> P

* Not available on all models

Continued

■List of customizable options

Setup Group Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
DeflationWarningSystemInitialises the deflation warning system Cancel/Initialise
Clock SetupAdjust Clock Adjusts the time.
Clock DisplaySets time display 12 hour, 24 hour, or OFF. 12h^*1/24h/OFF
Driver Assist System SetupCity-Brake Active SystemTurns the City-Brake Active system feature on and off. ON^*1/OFF
Forward Collision Warning Distance*Changes at which distance FCW alerts, or turns FCW on and off.Far/Normal*1/Near/OFF
Traffic Sign Recognition System*Selects whether the traffic sign small icons come on.Small Icons ON^*1/Small Icons OFF

*1: Default Setting

Setup GroupCustomizable FeaturesDescriptionSelectable Settings
Meter SetupLanguage Changes the displayed language.English*1/German/Italian/French/Spanish/Polish/Portuguese/Dutch/Danish/Swedish/Norwegian/Finnish/Russian/Turkish
Warning MessageSwitches warning message to be displayed or not.ON/OFF*1
Adjust Outside Temp. DisplayAdjusts the temperature reading by a few degrees.-3°C ~ ±0°C*1 ~ +3°C
"Trip A" Reset TimingChanges the setting of how to reset trip meter A, average fuel economy A, average speed A, and elapsed time A.When Refueled/When Ignition Is Turned Off/Manual Reset*1
"Trip B" Reset TimingChanges the setting of how to reset trip meter B, average fuel economy B, average speed B, and elapsed time B.When Refueled/When Ignition Is Turned Off/Manual Reset*1
Fuel Efficiency BacklightTurns the ambient meter feature on and off.ON*1/OFF

*1: Default Setting

Setup Group Customizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Meter SetupAuto Idle Stop DisplaySelects whether the Auto Idle Stop display comes on or not.ON*1/OFF
Speed Display Unit*Changes the displayed measurement of the vehicle speed on the multi-information display.km/h/mph*1
Distance Display Units*Changes the displayed measurement on the multi-information display.km/miles*1
Lighting SetupHeadlight Auto Off TimerChanges the length of time the exterior lights stay on after you close the driver's door.60sec/30sec/15sec*1/0sec
Maintenance Info.Maintenance Reset Reset the service reminder item(s).Cancel/All Due Items/Item A Only/Item B Only/Item 0 Only/Item 1 Only/Item 2 Only/Item 3 Only/Item 4 Only/Item 5 Only/Item 6 Only/Item 7 Only/Item 8 Only/Item 9 Only
Default All —Cancels/Resets all the customized settings as default.Cancel/OK

*1: Default Setting

■Example of customization settings

The steps for changing the "Trip A" Reset Timing setting to When Refueled are shown below. The default setting for "Trip A" Reset Timing is Manual Reset.

SEL:

  1. Press the button until

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■Example of customization settings - 2

(customize settings) appears on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.

SEL: ← 0: → Meter Setup 3/8

  1. Press the button until Meter Setup appears on the display.

  2. Press the SEL/RESET button.

SEL:← "Trip A" Reset Timing 3/8

  1. Press the ▲/▼ button until "Trip A" Reset Timing appears on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.

The display switches to the customization setup screen, where you can select When Refueled, When Ignition Is Turned Off, Manual Reset, or ← (Exit).

SFL Trib A Reset Timing When Refueled 1/4

  1. Press the ▲i/▼ button and select When Refueled, then press the SEL/RESET button.

The When Refueled Setup screen appears, then the display returns to the customization menu screen.

SFL Trip A' Reset Timing 4/4

  1. Press the button until (Exit) → appears on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.

  2. Repeat Step 6 until you return to the normal screen.

Controls

This chapter explains how to operate the various controls necessary for driving.

Clock 140

Locking and Unlocking the Doors

Key Types and Functions 142

Low Keyless Remote Signal Strength* ..... 145

Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the

Outside 146

Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the

Inside 153

Childproof Door Locks 155

Opening and Closing the Tailgate ..... 156

Security System

Immobilizer System 159

Security System Alarm* 159

Super Locking* 161

Opening and Closing the Windows..... 162

Operating the Switches Around the

Steering Wheel

Models without keyless access system

Ignition Switch.... 164

Models with keyless access system

ENGINE START/STOP Button 165

Ignition Switch and Power Mode Comparison....168

Turn Signals.... 169

Light Switches 170

Fog Lights.... 172

Headlight Adjuster* 174

Auto High-Beam (High Beam Support System) ^4 ...175

Daytime Running Lights 178

Wipers and Washers.... 179

Brightness Control....182

Rear Demister/Heated Door Mirror* ..... 183

Adjusting the Steering Wheel .....184

Adjusting the Mirrors

Interior Rearview Mirror....185

Power Door Mirrors....186

Adjusting the Seats

Front Seats 187

Rear Seats 190

Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items.... 199

Heating and Cooling System\*

Using Vents, Heating and A/C 209

Climate Control System

Using Automatic Climate Control .....213

Automatic Climate Control Sensors .....218

Clock

Adjusting the Clock

You can adjust the time in the clock display with the ignition switch in ON Ⅱ*1.

Adjusting the Time

Models with display audio system

■ Using the settings menu on the audio/information screen

0.100 seconds 17:34 BUTCHIN 12:34 - 18:00 12:34 am Best OK

  1. Select the HOME (HOME) icon, then select Settings.
  2. Select Info, Clock, then Clock Adjustment.
  3. Adjust the hours and minutes by selecting ▲ / ▼
  4. Select OK to set the time.

Adjusting the Clock

Models with display audio system

The clock in the multi-information display is automatically adjusted along with the audio system's clock display.

You can customize the clock display to show the 12 hour clock or 24 hour clock.

Customized Features P. 313

You can turn the clock display on and off.

Customized Features P. 313

The clock is automatically updated when your smartphone is connected to the audio system.

Models with navigation system

The clock is automatically updated through the navigation system, so the time does not need to be adjusted.

Models with colour audio system

■Using the MENU/CLOCK button

12:34 Add Time Control buttons

  1. Press and hold the MENU/CLOCK button.

▶Adjust clock is selected

  1. Rotate to change hour, then press.

  2. Rotate to change minute, then press

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■Using the MENU/CLOCK button - 2

  1. To enter the selection, rotate and select

Set, then press

Adjusting the Time

Models with colour audio system

These indications are used to show how to operate the LIST/SELECT (Selector) knob.

Rotate to select.

Press to enter.

You can customize the clock display to show the 12 hour clock or 24 hour clock.

→Customized Features P. 313

You can turn the clock display on and off.

Customized Features P. 313

You can also select Adjust clock by pressing the MENU/CLOCK button.

Rotate to select Adjust clock, then press.

The clock in the multi-information display is automatically adjusted along with the audio system's clock display.

Setting the Time Zone

Models with display audio system

■Using the settings menu on the audio/information screen

MINTONI 12:34 12 : 34 AM Reset OK

  1. Select the HOME (HOME) icon, then select Settings.

  2. Select Info, Clock, then Time Zone.

  3. Select your time zone.

Locking and Unlocking the Doors

Key Types and Functions

This vehicle comes with the following keys:

Keyless Remote* Retractable Key*

Use the key to start and stop the engine, and to lock and unlock* all the doors and tailgate. You can also use the remote transmitter or keyless access system* to lock and unlock all the doors and tailgate.

Key Types and Functions

All the keys have an immobilizer system. The immobilizer system helps to protect against vehicle theft.

Immobilizer System P. 159

Follow the advice below to prevent damage to the keys:

  • Do not leave the keys in direct sunlight, or in locations with high temperature or high humidity.
  • Do not drop the keys or set heavy objects on them.
  • Keep the keys away from liquids, dust and sand.
  • Do not take the keys apart except for replacing the battery.

If the circuits in the keys are damaged, the engine may not start, and the remote transmitter/keyless access system* may not work.

If the keys do not work properly, have them inspected by a dealer.

Built-in Key\*

Release Knob Built-in Key

The built-in key can be used to lock/unlock the doors when the keyless remote battery becomes weak and the power door lock/unlock operation is disabled.

To remove the built-in key, slide the release knob and then pull out the key. To reinstall the built-in key, push the built-in key into the keyless remote until it clicks.

Retractable keys\*

Release Button Push

The key folds up inside the remote transmitter.

  1. Press the release button to release the key out from the transmitter.

▶ Make sure to fully extend the key.

  1. To close the key, press the release button then push the key inside the transmitter until you hear a click.

Retractable keys

If the key is not fully extended, the immobilizer system may not work properly, and the engine may not start.

Avoid contact with the key whenever it extends or retracts.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Key Number Tag

Honda Jazz (2018) - Key Number Tag - 1

natural_image Simple white rectangular object with a small oval shape on top, set against a plain gray background (no text or symbols)

Contains a number that you will need if you purchase a replacement key.

Key Number Tag

Keep the key number tag separate from the key in a safe place outside of your vehicle. If you wish to purchase an additional key, contact a dealer.

If you lose your key and you cannot start the engine, contact a dealer.

Low Keyless Remote Signal Strength\*

The vehicle transmits radio waves to locate the keyless remote when locking/unlocking the doors and tailgate, or to start the engine.

In the following cases, locking/unlocking the doors and tailgate, or starting the engine may be inhibited or operation may be unstable:

• Strong radio waves are being transmitted by nearby equipment.
- You are carrying the keyless remote together with telecommunications equipment, laptop computers, mobile phones, or wireless devices.
- A metallic object is touching or covering the keyless remote.

Low Keyless Remote Signal Strength \*

Communication between the keyless remote and the vehicle consumes the keyless remote's battery. Battery life is about two years, but this varies depending on regularity of use.

The battery is consumed whenever the keyless remote is receiving strong radio waves. Avoid placing it near electrical appliances such as televisions and personal computers.

Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside

Using the Keyless Access System\*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Using the Keyless Access System\* - 1

natural_image Top-down view of a car with two circular wheels, no text or symbols visible

When you carry the keyless remote, you can lock/unlock the doors and tailgate. You can lock/unlock the doors and the tailgate within a radius of about 80 cm (32 inches) of the outside door handle. You can open the tailgate within about 80 cm (32 inches) radius from the tailgate release button.

Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside

If the interior light switch is in the door activated position, the interior lights come on when you press the unlock button.

No doors opened: The lights fade out after 30 seconds.

Doors relocked with the remote transmitter: The lights go off immediately.

→Interior Lights P. 199

Using the Keyless Access System \*

If you do not open a door or the tailgate within 30 seconds of unlocking the vehicle with the keyless access system, the doors and tailgate will automatically relock.

You can lock or unlock doors using the keyless access system only when the power mode is in VEHICLE OFF.

  • Do not leave the keyless remote in the vehicle when you get out. Carry it with you.
  • Even if you are not carrying the keyless remote, you can lock/unlock the doors and the tailgate while someone else with the remote is within range.
  • The door may be unlocked if the door handle is covered with water in heavy rain or in a car wash if the keyless remote is within range.
  • If you grip a front door handle wearing gloves, the door sensor may be slow to respond or may not respond by unlocking the doors.

Door Lock Button

Lock Button

■Locking the doors and tailgate

Press the door lock button on the front door or the tailgate.

▶ Some exterior lights flash three times; all the doors and tailgate lock; and the security system sets.

Using the Keyless Access System \*

  • You cannot unlock the door by gripping the handle after two seconds of locking it.
  • The door may not open if you pull it immediately after gripping the door handle. Grip the handle again and confirm that the door is unlocked before pulling the handle.
  • Even within the 80 cm (32 inches) radius, you may not be able to lock/unlock the doors and the tailgate with the keyless remote if it is above or below the outside handle.
  • The keyless remote may not operate if it is too close to the door and door glass.

▶▶ Locking and Unlocking the Doors▶Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside

Honda Jazz (2018) - Using the Keyless Access System \* - 1

natural_image Illustration of a person cleaning a car with a tool, showing the brush applying paint (no text or symbols present)

■Unlocking the doors and the tailgate

▶ All the doors and tailgate unlock.
▶ Some exterior lights flash once.

Tailgate Release Button

Press the tailgate release button:

▶ All the doors and tailgate unlock.
▶ Some exterior lights flash once.
Using the Tailgate Outer Handle/Release

Button P. 157

Using the Remote Transmitter

LED Lock Button Unlock Button Lock Button LED Unlock Button

■Locking the doors and tailgate

Press the lock button.

▶ Some exterior lights flash three times, all the doors and tailgate lock, and the security system ^* sets.

Using the Remote Transmitter

If you do not open a door or the tailgate within 30 seconds of unlocking the vehicle with the remote transmitter, the doors and tailgate will automatically relock.

Right-hand drive models

You cannot lock any doors from the outside when the keyless remote is inside the vehicle, and the beeper sounds. If you want to lock a door while the remote is still in the vehicle, do any of the following four times:

  • Press the lock button on the keyless remote.
  • Turn the key in the cylinder to lock.
  • Press the door lock button on the door handle or the tailgate.

■Unlocking the doors

Press the unlock button.

▶ Some exterior lights flash once, and all doors and the tailgate unlock.

Using the Remote Transmitter

The remote transmitter uses low-power signals, so the operating range may vary depending on the surroundings.

Models without keyless access system

The remote transmitter will not work when the key is in the ignition switch.

Models with keyless access system

You can lock or unlock doors using the remote transmitter or keyless access system only when the power mode is in VEHICLE OFF.

All models

The remote transmitter will not lock the vehicle when a door or the tailgate is open.

If the distance at which the remote transmitter works varies, the battery is probably low. Replace the button battery as soon as possible. If the LED does not come on when you press a button, the battery is dead.

→ Replacing the Button Battery P. 527

Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key

If the lock or unlock button of the keyless remote does not work, use the key instead.

Models with keyless access system Lock Unlock Models without keyless access system Lock Unlock

Fully insert the key and turn it.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key

When you lock/unlock the driver's door with the key, all the other doors and the tailgate lock/unlock at the same time.

Unlocking the doors with the key will cause the security system* to alarm. Always unlock the doors with the remote transmitter or keyless access system*.

Models with retractable key

If you are using the retractable key, make sure it is fully extended.

Locking a Door Without Using a Key

If you do not have the key on you, or if for some reason you cannot lock a door using the key, you can lock the door without it.

Diagram showing car door seatbelting process with numbered steps: opening, adjusting seatbelt, and closing.

■Locking the driver's door

Push the lock tab forward ① or push the master door lock switch in the lock direction ②, then pull and hold the outside door handle ③. Close the door, then release the handle.

■Locking the passengers' doors

Push the lock tab forward and close the door.

■Lockout prevention system

Models without keyless access system

The doors and the tailgate cannot be locked when the key is in the ignition switch.

Models with keyless access system

The doors and the tailgate cannot be locked when the keyless remote is inside the vehicle.

>>Locking a Door Without Using a Key

When you lock the driver's door, all the other doors and tailgate lock at the same time.

Before locking a door, make sure that the key is not inside the vehicle.

Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside

Using the Lock Tab
To Lock To Unlock Lock Tab

■Locking a door

Push the lock tab forward.

■Unlocking a door

Pull the lock tab rearward.

Using the Lock Tab

When you lock/unlock the door using the lock tab on the driver's door, all the other doors and the tailgate lock/unlock at the same time.

Continued

Unlocking Using the Front Door Inner Handle

Inner Handle

Pull the front door inner handle.

The door unlocks and opens in one motion.

Unlocking and opening the driver's door from the inner handle unlocks all the other doors.

Using the Master Door Lock Switch

To Lock To Unlock Master Door Lock Switch

Press the master door lock switch in as shown to lock or unlock all the doors and the tailgate.

Unlocking Using the Front Door Inner Handle

The front door inner handles are designed to allow the front seat occupants to open the door in one motion.

However, this feature requires that front seat occupants never pull a front door inner handle while the vehicle is in motion.

Children should always ride in a rear seat where childproof door locks are provided.

→ Childproof Door Locks P. 155

Using the Master Door Lock Switch

When you lock/unlock the driver's door using the master lock switch, all the other doors and the tailgate lock/unlock at the same time.

Childproof Door Locks

The childproof door locks prevent the rear doors from being opened from the inside regardless of the position of the lock tab.

Setting the Childproof Door Locks

Unlock Lock

Slide the lever in the rear door to the lock position, and close the door.

■When opening the door

Open the door using the outside door handle.

>>Childproof Door Locks

To open the door from the inside when the childproof door lock is on, put the lock tab in the unlock position, lower the rear window, put your hand out of the window, and pull the outside door handle.

Opening and Closing the Tailgate

Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate

Always make sure individuals and objects are clear of the tailgate before opening or closing it.

  • Open the tailgate all the way.
    ▶If it is not fully opened, the tailgate may begin to close under its own weight.
  • Be careful when it is windy. The wind may cause the tailgate to close.

Keep the tailgate closed while driving to:

▶ Avoid possible damage.
▶Prevent exhaust gas from leaking into the vehicle.
Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 82

Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate

WARNING

Anyone caught in the path of a tailgate that is being opened or closed can be seriously injured.

Make sure that all people are clear of the tailgate before opening or closing it.

Be careful not to hit your head on the tailgate or to put your hands between the tailgate and the luggage area when closing the tailgate.

When you are storing or picking up luggage from the luggage area while the engine is idling, do not stand in front of the exhaust pipe. You may get burned.

Do not allow any passenger in the luggage space. They may get hurt during hard braking, a sudden acceleration, or a crash.

Using the Tailgate Outer Handle/Release Button

Tailgate Release Button

Models with keyless access system

When all the doors are unlocked, the tailgate is unlocked. Press the tailgate release button and lift open the tailgate.

Tailgate Outer Handle

Models without keyless access system

When all the doors are unlocked, the tailgate is unlocked.

Pull up the tailgate outer handle and lift open the tailgate.

Using the Tailgate Outer Handle/Release Button

Models with keyless access system

  • Do not leave the keyless remote in the vehicle when you get out. Carry it with you.
  • Even if you are not carrying the remote, you can unlock the tailgate while someone else with the remote is within range.

If you are carrying the keyless remote, you do not have to unlock the tailgate before opening it.

Continued

▶▶ Opening and Closing the Tailgate▶ Using the Tailgate Outer Handle/Release Button

Inner Handle

All models

To close the tailgate, grab the inner handle, pull the tailgate down, and push it closed from outside.

Security System

Immobilizer System

The immobilizer system prevents a key that has not been pre-registered from starting the engine. Each key contains electronic transmitters that use electronic signals to verify the key.

Pay attention to the following when inserting the key into the ignition switch or pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button:

  • Do not allow objects that emit strong radio waves near the ignition switch or the ENGINE START/STOP button.
  • Make sure the key is not covered by or touching a metal object.
  • Do not bring a key from another vehicle's immobilizer system near the ignition switch or the ENGINE START/STOP button.

Do not put the key near magnetic items. Electronic device, such as televisions and audio systems emit strong magnetic fields. Note that even a key chain can become magnetic.

Security System Alarm\*

The security system alarm activates when the doors, tailgate, or bonnet are opened without the remote transmitter or keyless access system*.

■When the security system alarm activates

The horn sounds intermittently and some exterior lights flash.

■To deactivate the security system alarm

Unlock the vehicle using the remote transmitter or keyless access system, or turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 . The system, along with the horn and flashing lights, is deactivated.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Immobilizer System

NOTICE

Leaving the key in the vehicle can result in theft or accidental movement of the vehicle. Always take the ignition key with you whenever you leave the vehicle unattended.

Do not alter the system or add other devices to it. Doing so may damage the system and make your vehicle inoperable.

If the system repeatedly does not recognize the coding of your key, contact your dealer. If you have lost your key and cannot start your engine, contact your dealer.

»Security System Alarm \*

Do not alter the system or add other devices to it. Doing so may damage the system and make your vehicle inoperable. The security alarm continues for 30 seconds, then the system resets. If the cause of the alarm continues, alarming will repeat several times at about 5 second intervals.

■Setting the security system alarm

The security system alarm automatically sets when the following conditions have been met:

• The ignition switch is in LOCK 0*1.
• The bonnet is closed.
- All doors and the tailgate are locked from outside with the key, the remote transmitter, or keyless access system*.

Models without keyless access system

- The key has been removed from the ignition switch.

■When the security system alarm sets

The security system alarm indicator in the instrument panel blinks. When the blinking interval changes after about 15 seconds, the security system alarm is set.

■To cancel the security system alarm

The security system alarm is cancelled when the vehicle is unlocked using the remote transmitter, keyless access system* or the ignition switch is turned to ON ^*1 . The security system alarm indicator goes off at the same time.

»Security System Alarm \*

Do not set the security system alarm when someone is in the vehicle or a window is open. The system can accidentally activate when:

  • Unlocking the door with the lock tab.
  • Opening the bonnet with the bonnet release.

If the battery goes dead after you have set the security system alarm, the security alarm may go off once the battery is recharged or replaced.

If this occurs, deactivate the security system alarm by unlocking a door using the remote transmitter or keyless access system.

Do not unlock the door using the key. The security system alarm goes off.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models

Super Locking\*

The super locking function disables the lock tabs on all doors.

■To activate the super locking function

  • Turn the key in the driver's door towards the vehicle front twice within five seconds.
  • Press the lock button on the remote transmitter twice within five seconds.

Models with keyless access system

- Press the door lock button on the door handle or the tailgate twice within five seconds.

■To cancel the super locking function

Unlock the driver's door with the remote transmitter or keyless access system*.

Super Locking *

WARNING

No one must be inside the vehicle with the super locking set. Persons locked in can get seriously sick or die from the heat built inside the vehicle if left in the sun.

Make sure there is no one inside the vehicle before setting the super locking.

Do not unlock the door using the key. The security system alarm goes off.

Even if you have unlocked, opened, and then closed the tailgate, the super locking function continues to be in effect.

Opening and Closing the Windows

Opening/Closing the Power Windows

The power windows can be opened and closed when the ignition switch is in ON Ⅲ *1, using the switches on the doors.

The driver's side switches can be used to open and close all of the windows.

The power window lock button on the driver's side must be switched off (not pushed in, indicator off) to open and close the windows from anywhere other than the driver's seat.

When the power window lock button is pushed in, the indicator comes on and you can only operate the driver's window. Turn the power window lock button on if a child is in the vehicle.

Opening/Closing Windows with Auto-Open/Close Function

Driver's Window Switch Power Window Lock Button Indicator Front Passenger's Window Switch (Auto Function)

■Manual operation

To open: Push the switch down lightly, and hold it until the desired position is reached.

To close: Pull the switch up lightly, and hold it until the desired position is reached.

■Automatic operation

To open: Push the switch down firmly.

To close: Pull the switch up firmly.

The window opens or closes completely. To stop the window at any time, push or pull the switch briefly.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

* Not available on all models

Opening/Closing the Power Windows

WARNING

Closing a power window on someone's hands or fingers can cause serious injury.

Make sure your passengers are away from the windows before closing them.

WARNING: Always take the ignition key with you whenever you leave the vehicle alone or with other occupants.

The power windows can be operated for up to 10 minutes after you turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0 ^1 .

Opening either front door cancels this function.

Auto Reverse

If a power window senses resistance when closing automatically, it will stop closing and reverse direction.

The driver's window auto reverse function is disabled when you continuously pull up the switch.

The auto reverse function stops sensing when the window is almost closed to ensure that it fully closes.

■ Opening/Closing Windows without Auto-Open/Close Function

Close Open

To open: Push the switch down.

To close: Pull the switch up.

Release the switch when the window reaches the desired position.

Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel

Models without keyless access system

Ignition Switch

Honda Jazz (2018) - Ignition Switch - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car interior showing the steering wheel and dashboard (no visible text or symbols)

☐ LOCK: Insert and remove the key in this position.
☐ ACCESSORY: Operate the audio system and other accessories in this position.
☐ ON: This is the position when driving.
III START: This position is for starting the engine. The switch returns to ON II when you let go of the key.

Ignition Switch

Manual transmission models

WARNING

Removing the key from the ignition switch while driving locks the steering. This can cause you to lose control of the vehicle.

Remove the key from the ignition switch only when parked.

Continuously variable transmission models

You cannot take the key out unless the shift lever is in [P].

All models

If you open the driver's door when the key is in LOCK 0 or ACCESSORY 1, the following symbol appears on the multi-information display:

• In LOCK 0: symbol
• In ACCESSORY I: symbol

If the key won't turn from LOCK 0 to ACCESSORY 1, turn the key while moving the steering wheel left and right. The steering wheel will unlock, allowing the key to turn.

Models with keyless access system

ENGINE START/STOP Button

Changing the Power Mode

Continuously Variable Transmission Manual Transmission
Honda Jazz (2018) - Changing the Power Mode - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["ENGINE START STOP"] --> B["ENGINE START STOP"]
    B --> C["ENGINE START STOP"]
    C --> D["ENGINE START STOP"]
    D --> E["ENGINE START STOP"]
    E --> F["ENGINE START STOP"]
    F --> G["ENGINE START STOP"]
    G --> H["ENGINE START STOP"]
    H --> I["ENGINE START STOP"]
    I --> J["ENGINE START STOP"]
    J --> K["ENGINE START STOP"]
    K --> L["ENGINE START STOP"]
    L --> M["ENGINE START STOP"]
    M --> N["ENGINE START STOP"]
    N --> O["ENGINE START STOP"]
    O --> P["ENGINE START STOP"]
    P --> Q["ENGINE START STOP"]
    Q --> R["ENGINE START STOP"]
    R --> S["ENGINE START STOP"]
    S --> T["ENGINE START STOP"]
    T --> U["ENGINE START STOP"]
    U --> V["ENGINE START STOP"]
    V --> W["ENGINE START STOP"]
    W --> X["ENGINE START STOP"]
    X --> Y["ENGINE START STOP"]
    Y --> Z["ENGINE START STOP"]
    Z --> AA["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AA --> AB["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AB --> AC["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AC --> AD["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AD --> AE["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AE --> AF["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AF --> AG["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AG --> AH["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AH --> AI["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AI --> AJ["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AJ --> AK["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AK --> AL["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AL --> AM["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AM --> AN["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AN --> AO["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AO --> AP["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AP --> AQ["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AQ --> AR["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AR --> AS["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AS --> AT["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AT --> AU["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AU --> AV["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AV --> AW["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AW --> AX["ENGINE START STOP"]
    AX --> AY["ENGINE START STOP"]

Without depressing the brake pedal
Press the button. Press the button without the shift lever in P. Shift to P then press the button.

Without depressing the clutch pedal

ENGINE START/STOP Button

ENGINE START/STOP Button Operating Range You can start the engine when the keyless remote is inside the vehicle.

Operating Range

The engine may also run if the keyless remote is close to the door or window, even if it is outside the vehicle.

ON mode:

The button is on (in red), if the engine is running.

If the battery of the keyless remote is getting low, the engine may not start when you push the ENGINE START/STOP button. If the engine does not start, refer to the following link.

If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak P. 560

Automatic Power Off

If you leave the vehicle for 30 to 60 minutes with the shift lever in [P]^*1 and the power mode in ACCESSORY, the vehicle automatically goes into the mode similar to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) to avoid draining the battery.

When in this mode:

The steering wheel does not lock.

You cannot lock or unlock doors with the remote transmitter or the keyless access system.

Press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice to switch the mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).

Changing the Power Mode P. 165

ENGINE START/STOP Button

If the power mode does not change from VEHICLE OFF to ACCESSORY, press the ENGINE START/STOP button while moving the steering wheel left and right. The steering wheel will unlock, allowing the mode to change.

Do not leave the power mode in ACCESSORY or ON when you get out.

Power Mode Reminder

If you open the driver's door when the power mode is set to ACCESSORY, a warning beep sounds.

Keyless Remote Reminder

Honda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Remote Reminder - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with steering wheel and dashboard (no visible text or symbols)

Warning buzzers may sound from inside and/or outside the vehicle to remind you that the keyless remote is out of the vehicle. If the buzzer continues even after the remote is put back inside, place it to be within its operational range.

■When the power mode is in ON

If the keyless remote is taken out of the vehicle, and the driver's door is closed, a warning buzzer sound from both inside and outside the vehicle. A warning symbol on the multi-information display notifies the driver inside that the remote is outside of the vehicle.

■When the power mode is in ACCESSORY

If the keyless remote is taken out of the vehicle, and all the doors are closed, a warning buzzer sounds from outside the vehicle.

Keyless Remote Reminder

When the keyless remote is within the system's operational range, and the driver's door is closed, the warning function cancels.

If the keyless remote is taken out of the vehicle after the engine has been started, you can no longer change the ENGINE START/STOP button mode or restart the engine. Always make sure if the remote is in your vehicle when you operate the ENGINE START/STOP button.

Removing the keyless remote from the vehicle through a window does not activate the warning buzzer.

Do not put the keyless remote on the dashboard or in the glove box. It may cause the warning buzzer to go off. Under some other conditions that can prevent the vehicle from locating the remote, the warning buzzer may also go off even if the remote is within the system's operational range.

Ignition Switch and Power Mode Comparison

Ignition Switch PositionLOCK 0(with/without the key) Honda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Remote Reminder - 1ACCESSORY IHonda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Remote Reminder - 2ON IIHonda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Remote Reminder - 3START IIIHonda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Remote Reminder - 4
Without Keyless Access SystemEngine is turned off and power is shut down.The steering wheel is locked.No electrical components can be used.Engine is turned off.Some electrical components such as the audio system and the accessory power socket can be operated.Normal key position while driving.All electrical components can be used.Use this position to start the engine.The ignition switch returns to ON IIposition when you release the key.
Power Mode VEHICLEOFF(LOCK) Honda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Remote Reminder - 5ACCESSORY ON SHonda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Remote Reminder - 6Button is, blinking OnHonda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Remote Reminder - 7
With Keyless Access System and ENGINE START/STOP ButtonButton-OffEngine is turned off and power is shut down.The steering wheel is locked.No electrical components can be used.Button-Blinking in redEngine is turned off.Some electrical components such as the audio system and the accessory power socket can be operated.Button-Blinking in red (engine is turned off)On in red (engine is running)All electrical components can be used.Button-On in redThe mode automatically returns to ON after the engine starts.

Turn Signals

Right Turn Left Turn

The turn signals can be used when the ignition switch is in ON *1.

■One touch turn signal

When you lightly push up or down and release the turn signal lever, the exterior turn signals and turn signal indicator blink three times.

This feature can be used when signalling for a lane change.

Light Switches

Manual Operation

High Beams Flashing the high beams Low Beams -200° Turns on position, tail, and rear licence plate lights -0° Turns on headlights, position, tail, and rear licence plate lights

Rotating the light switch turns the lights on and off, regardless of the position of the ignition switch ^*1 .

■High beams

Push the lever forward until you hear a click.

■Low beams

When in high beams, pull the lever back to return to low beams.

■Flashing the high beams

Pull the lever back, and release it.

■Lights off

Turn the lever to OFF either when:

- The shift lever is in ^*2 .

• The parking brake is applied.

To turn the lights on again, turn the lever to

OFF to cancel the lights off mode. Even if you do not cancel the lights off mode, the lights come on automatically when:

• The shift lever is moved out of P ^2 .
• The parking brake is released.
• The vehicle starts to move.

>>Light Switches

Models without keyless access system

If you remove the key from the ignition switch while the lights are on, a chime sounds when the driver's door is opened.

Models with keyless access system

If you leave the power mode in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) while the lights are on, a chime sounds when the driver's door is opened.

When the lights are on, the lights on indicator in the instrument panel will be on.

→Lights On Indicator P. 98

Do not leave the lights on when the engine is off because it will cause the battery to discharge.

If you sense that the level of the headlights is abnormal, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
*2: Continuously variable transmission models

Automatic Operation (automatic lighting control)

OFF- AUTO+ 34° ID+ 10° OFF- 2 34°

Automatic lighting control can be used when the ignition switch is in ON ^*1 .

When the light switch is in AUTO, the headlights and other exterior lights will switch on and off automatically depending on the ambient brightness.

The headlights comes on when you unlock a door in dark areas with the headlight switch in AUTO.

▶Once you lock the door, the headlights will go off.

Automatic Lighting Off Feature

The headlights, all other exterior lights, and the instrument panel lights turn off 15 seconds after you remove the key or set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), take the remote with you, and close the driver's door.

However, when the switch is in ☐the position lights remain on.

If you turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0*1 with the headlight switch on, but do not open the door, the lights turn off after 10 minutes (3 minutes, if the switch is in the AUTO position).

The lights turn on again when you unlock or open the driver's door. If you unlock the door, but do not open it within 15 seconds, the lights go off. If you open the driver's door, you will hear a lights on reminder chime.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

>>Automatic Operation (automatic lighting control)

We recommend that you turn on the lights manually when driving at night, in a dense fog, or in dark areas such as long tunnels or parking facilities.

The light sensor is in the location shown below. Do not cover this light sensor with anything; otherwise, the automatic lighting system may not work properly.

Models with front sensor camera Light Sensor Models without front sensor camera Light Sensor

>>Automatic Lighting Off Feature

You can change the headlight auto off timer setting. →Customized Features P. 131

▶▶ Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel▶ Fog Lights

Fog Lights

Can be used when the position lights or the headlights are on.

■Rear fog light

Can be used when the headlights or the front fog lights are on.

Front and Rear Fog Lights Switch\*

OFF- AUTO- 36 Front and Rear Fog Lights Switch

■To turn the front fog lights on

Rotate the switch up from the OFF position to the position. The indicator comes on.

■To turn the front and rear fog lights on

Rotate the switch one position up from the position. The hand indicator comes on.

■To turn the rear fog light on

Rotate the switch down from the OFF position. The Indicator comes on.

Rear Fog Lights \*

Rear Fog Light Switch

■To turn the rear fog light on

Rotate the switch to The indicator comes on.

Headlight Adjuster\*

Diagram showing car interior with steering wheel and directional arrow, indicating vehicle movement or navigation

You can adjust the vertical angle of the low beam headlights when the ignition switch is in ON Ⅱ*1.

Turn the adjusting dial to select an appropriate angle of the headlights.

The larger dial number indicates the lower angle.

■To select the adjusting dial position

Refer to the below table for the appropriate dial position for your vehicle's riding and loading conditions.

Condition Dial position
A driver0
A driver and a front passenger
Five persons in the front and rear seats 1
Five persons in the front and rear seats and luggage in the luggage area, within the limit of maximum permissible axle weight and maximum permissible vehicle weight2
A driver and luggage in the luggage area, within the limits of maximum permissible axle weight and maximum permissible vehicle weight3

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models

Headlight Adjuster \*

Models with LED low beam headlights

Your vehicle is equipped with the automatic headlight adjusting system that automatically adjusts the vertical angle of the low beam headlights. If you find a significant change in the vertical angle of the headlights, there may be a problem with the system. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.

You may need to alter the headlight beam distribution.

Adjusting Headlight Distribution P. 451

Auto High-Beam (High Beam Support System) \*

Using a camera mounted to the inside of the windshield, this system detects light sources ahead of the vehicle. Depending on the light source, the system automatically switches the headlights to high beam for optimal visibility at night.

The system operates when:

■The headlight switch is in AUTO.
■The lever is in the low beam position.
The low beams are on and the system recognizes that you are driving at night.
The vehicle speed is above 40 km/h (25 mph).

Diagram of a car with a circular icon labeled 'A' and a magnified inset showing a dashboard or camera view.

How it works

When the camera detects lights coming from a preceding or oncoming vehicle, the headlights remain in low beam.

When the camera detects no lights coming from a preceding or oncoming vehicle, the headlights change to high beam.

The view angle or distance that the camera can detect lights ahead differs depending on conditions, such as the brightness of the lights and the weather.

Honda Jazz (2018) - How it works - 1

natural_image Top-down diagram of three cars with a dotted line indicating a collision or perspective, no text or symbols present

* Not available on all models

Continued

Auto High-Beam (High Beam Support System) \*

The auto high-beam determines when to change the headlight beams by responding to the brightness of the lights ahead of your vehicle. In the following cases, the system may not respond to the lights properly:

  • The brightness of the lights from the preceding or oncoming vehicle is intense or poor.
  • Visibility is poor due to the weather (rain, snow, fog, windscreen frost, etc.).
  • Other light sources, such as streetlights and electric billboards are illuminating the road ahead.
  • The brightness level of the road ahead constantly changes.
    • The road is bumpy or with many curves.
  • A vehicle cuts in front of you, or a vehicle in front of you is not in the preceding or oncoming direction.
  • Your vehicle is tilted with a heavy load in the rear.

If you find the timing of beam changes inconvenient for driving, change the headlight beams manually.

If you do not want the system to be activated at any time when the headlight switch is in AUTO, consult a dealer.

Operating the System

A Headlight Switch

To activate the system, turn the headlight switch to AUTO and then set the headlights to low beam. The auto high-beam indicator will come on.

Light Switches P. 170

The high beams remain on unless:

  • You have been driving below 24km/h (15mph) for an extended amount of time.
  • The speed of the vehicle drops below 10km/h (6mph).
  • The windshield wipers have been running at a high speed for more than a few seconds.
  • You enter a well lit location.

The high beams come back on once the condition that caused them to turn off no longer exists.

Operating the System

For the auto high-beam to work properly:

  • Do not place an object that reflects light on the dashboard.
  • Keep the windscreen around the camera clean. When cleaning the windscreen, be careful not to apply the windscreen cleanser to the camera lens
  • Do not attach an object, sticker or film to the area around the camera.
  • Do not touch the camera lens.

If the camera receives a strong impact, or repairing of the area near the camera is required, consult a dealer.

To help reduce the likelihood that high interior temperatures will cause the camera system to shut off, when parking, find a shady area or face the front of the vehicle away from the sun.

If you use a reflective sun shade, do not allow it to cover the camera housing. Covering the camera can concentrate heat on the camera.

If the message appears:

  • Use the heating and cooling system */climate control system* to cool down the interior and, if necessary, also use defroster mode with the air flow directed towards the camera.
  • Start driving the vehicle to lower the windscreen temperature, which cools down the area around the camera.

If needed, you can temporarily turn the high beams off manually. Turn on the high beams by pushing the lever forward until you hear a click, or flash the high beams once by pulling the lever toward you. To turn the high beams back on, repeat one of the procedures. If you want the auto high-beam operation to resume at once, pull and hold the lever towards you for a few seconds.

Operating the System

If the message appears:

- Park your vehicle in a safe place, and clean the windscreen. If the message does not disappear after you have cleaned the windscreen and driven for a while, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.

Daytime Running Lights

The position */daytime running lights come on when the following conditions have been met:

  • The ignition switch is in ON ^*1 .
    • The headlight switch is in AUTO.

Turning off the ignition switch or setting the power mode to VEHICLE OFF will turn off the daytime running lights.

The daytime running lights are off once the headlight switch is turned on, or when the head light switch is in AUTO and it is getting darker outside.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

* Not available on all models

Wipers and Washers

Pull to use washer. MIST OFF AUTO: Automatic intermittent operation LO: Low speed wipe HI: High speed wipe

The windscreen wipers and washers can be used when the ignition switch is in ON ^*1 .

MIST

The wipers run at high speed until you release the lever.

■Wiper switch (OFF, AUTO, LO, HI)

Change the wiper switch setting according to the amount of rain.

Automatic Intermittent Wipers P. 180

Washer

Sprays while you pull the lever toward you. When you release the lever for more than one second, the spray stops, the wipers sweep two or three more times to clear the windscreen, then stop.

Continued

Wipers and Washers

NOTICE

Do not use the wipers when the windscreen is dry. The windscreen will get scratched, or the rubber blades will get damaged.

Turn the washers off if no washer fluid comes out. The pump may get damaged.

The wiper motor may stop motor operation temporarily to prevent an overload. Wiper operation will return to normal within a few minutes, once the circuit has returned to normal.

NOTICE

In cold weather, the blades may freeze to the windscreen, becoming stuck. Operating the wipers in this condition may damage the wipers. Use the demister to warm the windscreen, then turn the wipers on.

If the wipers stop operating due to any obstacle such as the build-up of snow, park the vehicle in a safe place.

Rotate the wiper switch to OFF, and turn the ignition switch to ACCESSORY 1 or LOCK 0*1, then remove the obstacle.

Automatic Intermittent Wipers

Adjustment Ring

When you push the lever down to AUTO, the windscreen wipers sweep once, and go into the automatic mode.

The wipers operate intermittently, at low speed, or at high speed and stops in accordance with the amount of rainfall the rainfall sensor detects.

■AUTO sensitivity adjustment

When the wiper function is set to AUTO, you can adjust the sensitivity of the rain fall sensor (using the adjustment ring) so that wipers will operate in accordance with your preference.

Sensor sensitivity

Honda Jazz (2018) - Sensor sensitivity - 1

Low sensitivity

High sensitivity

>>Automatic Intermittent Wipers

The rainfall sensor is in the location shown below.

Rainfall Sensor

AUTO should always be turned OFF before the following situation in order to prevent severe damage to the wiper system:

  • Cleaning the windshield
  • Driving through a car wash
  • No rain present

Rear Wiper/Washer

INT: Intermittent ON OFF Washer

The rear wiper and washer can be used when the ignition switch is in ON Ⅱ ^1 .

■Wiper switch (OFF, INT, ON)

Change the wiper switch setting according to the amount of rain.

Washer ( )

Sprays while you rotate the switch to this position. Hold it to activate the wiper and to spray the washer. Once released, it stops operating after a few more sweeps.

■Operating in reverse

When you shift the transmission to R with the windscreen wipers activated, the rear wiper operates automatically as follows even if its switch is off.

Front Wiper Position Rear Wiper Operation

AUTO (Intermittent) Intermittent

LO (Low speed wipe)

HI (High speed wipe)

Continuous

Brightness Control

(Select/Reset) Knob

When the ignition switch is in ON ^*1 , you can use the Select/Reset) knob to adjust instrument panel brightness.

Brighten: Turn the knob to the right.

Dim: Turn the knob to the left.

You will hear a beeper when the brightness reaches minimum or maximum. Several seconds after you have adjusted the brightness, you will be returned to the previous screen.

12:34 - + 23°C 002300km 0

■Brightness level indicator

The brightness level is shown on the multi-information display while you are adjusting it.

Brightness Control

Instrument panel brightness varies, depending on whether the exterior lights are on or off. The instrument panel dims to reduce glare when they are on.

To cancels the reduced instrument panel brightness when the exterior lights are on, turn the knob to the right until the brightness display is up to max, the beeper sounds.

The brightness can be set differently for when the exterior lights are on, and when they are off.

Rear Demister/Heated Door Mirror\*

Press the rear demister and heated door mirror button or touch the icon to defog the rear window and mirrors when the ignition switch is in ON Ⅲ*1.

Models with heating and cooling system SEAR SEAR

Models with climate control system REAR LEAF

Models with climate control system

The rear demister and heated door mirrors automatically switch off after 10-30 minutes depending on the outside temperature. However, if the outside temperature is 0^ or below, they do not automatically switch off.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

* Not available on all models

Rear Demister/Heated Door Mirror *

NOTICE

When cleaning the inside of the rear window, be careful not to damage the heating wires. It is critical to wipe the window from side to side along the demister heating wires.

This system consumes a lot of power, so turn it off when the window has been demisted or deiced. Also, do not use the system for a long period when the engine is idling. This may weaken the battery, making it difficult to start the engine.

Adjusting the Steering Wheel

The steering wheel height and distance from your body can be adjusted so that you can comfortably grip the steering wheel in an appropriate driving posture.

To adjust To lock Lever Height and Distance

  1. Pull the steering wheel adjustment lever up.

The steering wheel adjustment lever is under the steering column.

  1. Move the steering wheel up or down, and in or out.

▶ Make sure you can see the instrument panel gauges and indicators.

  1. Push the steering wheel adjustment lever down to lock the steering wheel in position.

▶ After adjusting the position, make sure you have securely locked the steering wheel in place by trying to move it up, down, in, and out.

Adjusting the Steering Wheel

WARNING

Adjusting the steering wheel position while driving may cause you to lose control of the vehicle and be seriously injured in a crash.

Adjust the steering wheel only when the vehicle is stopped.

Adjusting the Mirrors

Interior Rearview Mirror

Adjust the angle of the rearview mirror when you are sitting in the correct driving position.

Rearview Mirror with Day and Night Positions
Tab Daytime Position Night Position

Flip the tab to switch the position. The night position will help to reduce the glare from headlights behind you when driving after dark.

Adjusting the Mirrors

Keep the inside and outside mirrors clean and adjusted for best visibility.

Adjust the mirrors before you start driving.

→Front Seats P. 187

Power Door Mirrors

Selector Switch Adjustment Switch Folding Button*

You can adjust the door mirrors when the ignition switch is in ON [Ⅱ]^*1 .

■Mirror position adjustment

L/R selector switch: Select the left or right mirror. After adjusting the mirror, return the switch to the centre position.

Mirror position adjustment switch: Press the switch left, right, up, or down to move the mirror.

Press the folding button to fold in and out the door mirrors.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

* Not available on all models

Adjusting the Seats

Front Seats

Allow sufficient space. Move back.

Adjust the driver's seat as far back as possible while allowing you to maintain full control of the vehicle. You should be able to sit upright, well back in the seat and be able to adequately press the pedals without leaning forward, and grip the steering wheel comfortably. The passenger's seat should be adjusted in a similar manner, so that it is as far back from the front airbag in the dashboard as possible.

■ Adjusting the Seat Position

Horizontal Position Adjustment Pull up on the bar to move the seat, then release the bar. Height Adjustment* Pull up or push down the lever to raise or lower the seat. Seat-back Angle Adjustment Pull up the lever to change the angle. Driver's seat is shown.

* Not available on all models
Continued

Adjusting the Seats

WARNING

Sitting too close to a front airbag can result in serious injury or death if the front airbags inflate.

Always sit as far back from the front airbags as possible while maintaining control of the vehicle.

In addition to the seat adjustment, you can adjust the steering wheel up and down, in and out. Allow at least 25 cm (10 inches) between the centre of the steering wheel and the chest.

Always make seat adjustments before driving.

Once a seat is adjusted correctly, rock it back and forth to make sure it is locked in position.

Adjusting the Seat-Backs

Honda Jazz (2018) - Adjusting the Seat-Backs - 1

natural_image Illustration of a person seated in a car seat using a medical device, with no visible text or symbols.

Adjust the driver's seat-back to a comfortable, upright position, leaving ample space between your chest and the airbag cover in the centre of the steering wheel.

The front seat passenger should also adjust their seat-back to a comfortable, upright position.

Reclining a seat-back so that the shoulder part of the belt no longer rests against the occupant's chest reduces the protective capability of the belt. It also increases the chance of sliding under the belt in a crash and being seriously injured. The farther a seat-back is reclined, the greater the risk of injury.

Adjusting the Seat-Backs

WARNING

Reclining the seat-back too far can result in serious injury or death in a crash.

Adjust the seat-back to an upright position, and sit well back in the seat.

Do not put a cushion, or other object, between the seat-back and your back.

Doing so may interfere with proper seat belt or airbag operation.

If you cannot get far enough away from the steering wheel and still reach the controls, we recommend that you investigate whether some type of adaptive equipment may help.

Reclining the Front Seats

Reclining the seat-backs on the front seats until they are level with the rear seat cushions provides a large cushioned area that can (and should only) be used when the vehicle is safely parked.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Reclining the Front Seats - 1

natural_image 3D diagram of a car seatbelt mechanism with directional arrows indicating movement (no text or symbols)
  1. Remove the front head restraints while pushing the release button.
    ▶ Store the head restraints in the luggage area.
  2. Adjust the front seats forward as far as possible.
  3. While pulling the seat-back angle adjustment lever, pivot the seat-back backward until it is level with the rear seat cushion.
  4. Move the front seat backward until it touches the rear seat.
  5. Unlatch the detachable anchor from the anchor buckle, and store the rear centre seat belt.
    Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor P. 45

  6. Adjust the rear seat-back to the desired position.

To return the front seats and rear centre seat belt to their original positions, reverse this procedure.

When you return a seat-back to its upright position, hold the seat-back to keep it from going up too quickly.

Reclining the Front Seats

Both front seats must be returned to their normal upright position, and the head restraints reinstalled and properly adjusted before driving.

Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints P. 196

Rear Seats

■ Adjusting the Rear Seat-Backs

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■ Adjusting the Rear Seat-Backs - 1

natural_image 3D illustration of a car seat assembly with a magnified inset showing the internal components (no text or symbols)

Pull the lever on the right to change the angle of the right half of the seat-back, and left for the left half.

Folding Down the Rear Seats

The rear seats can be folded down separately to allow for additional storage space.

Anchor Buckle Latch Plate

■To fold down the seat

  1. Store the centre seat belt first. Insert the latch plate into the slot on the side of the anchor buckle.
  2. Retract the seat belt into the holder on the ceiling.
    Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor P. 45
  3. Lower the head restraint to its lowest position.
  4. Pull the release lever and fold down the seat-back.

Release Lever

To return the seat to the original position, pull up the seat-back in the upright position.

Folding Down the Rear Seats

Make sure all items in the luggage area or items extending to the rear seats are properly secured. Loose items can fly forward if you have to brake hard.

Remove any items from the rear seat cushion and floor before you fold down the rear seat.

To lock the seat-back upright, push it backwards until it locks.

Make sure the seat-back, head restraints and seat cushion are securely latched back into place before driving. Also, make sure all rear shoulder belts are positioned in front of the seat-back, and the centre shoulder belt is re-positioned in the holding slot.

Folding the Rear Seat Up

Loop

Separately lift up the left and right rear seat cushions to make room for luggage area.

■Lifting up the seat cushion

  1. Make sure the seat belt buckles are in their loops on the seat.

Seat Leg

  1. Pull up the rear seat cushion.

  2. Fold the seat leg down while pushing the seat cushion firmly against the seat-back to lock it.

Seat Leg Latch Floor Guide

■Putting the seat in the original position

  1. Hold the seat cushion in the upright position, and pull up the seat leg fully.

The seat cushion can abruptly fall down once you pull up the seat leg.

  1. Slowly put down the seat cushion and set the seat leg in the floor guide.

▶ A latch comes out when the leg is set properly.

Folding the Rear Seat Up

After you fold the seat up, or put it back in the original position, make sure the seat is firmly secured by rocking it forward and back.

Check if there are any items on the seat before you pull the seat cushion up. Check if there are any obstacles around the floor guide before you put the seat back in the original position.

Head Restraints

Your vehicle is equipped with head restraints in all seating positions.

Adjusting the front head restraint positions

Position head in the centre of the head restraint.

Head restraints are most effective for protection against whiplash and other rear-impact crash injuries when the centre of the back of the occupant's head rests against the centre of the restraint. The tops of the occupant's ears should be level with the centre height of the restraint.

The front head restraints can also be tilted to adjust its position properly.

Adjusting the front head restraint positions

WARNING

Improperly positioning head restraints reduces their effectiveness and increases the likelihood of serious injury in a crash.

Make sure head restraints are in place and positioned properly before driving.

In order for the head restraint system to work properly:

  • Do not hang any items on the head restraints, or from the restraint legs.
  • Do not place any object between an occupant and the seat-back.
    • Install each restraint in its proper location.

Continued

Honda Jazz (2018) - WARNING - 1

natural_image 3D diagram of a mechanical component with an inset showing a pipe fitting and directional arrows (no text or symbols)

To raise the head restraint:

Pull it upward.

To lower the head restraint:

Push it down while pressing the release button.

Release Button

To tilt the head restraint: Pivot it while pressing the release button.

Changing the Rear Seat Head Restraint Positions

Outer Release Button

A passenger sitting in a back seating position should adjust the height of their head restraint to an appropriate position before the vehicle begins moving.

To raise the head restraint:

Pull it upward.

To lower the head restraint:

Push it down while pressing the release button.

Release Button Centre

Changing the Rear Seat Head Restraint Positions

When you use the head restraint in a rear seating position, pull up the head restraint to its highest position. Do not use it in any lower position.

Continued

Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints

Head restraints can be removed for cleaning or repair.

To remove a head restraint:

Pull the restraint up as far as it will go. Then push the release button, and pull the restraint up and out.

To reinstall a head restraint:

Insert the legs back in place, then adjust the head restraint to an appropriate height while pressing the release button. Pull up on the restraint to make sure it is locked in position.

Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints

WARNING

Failure to reinstall, or correctly reinstall, the head restraints can result in severe injury during a crash.

Always replace the head restraints before driving.

Maintain a Proper Sitting Position

After all occupants have adjusted their seats and head restraints, and put on their seat belts, it is very important that they continue to sit upright, well back in their seats, with their feet on the floor, until the vehicle is safely parked and the engine is off.

Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury during a crash. For example, if an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward, leans forward or sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of injury during a crash is greatly increased.

In addition, an occupant who is out of position in the front seat can be seriously or fatally injured in a crash by striking interior parts of the vehicle or being struck by an inflating front airbag.

Maintain a Proper Sitting Position

WARNING

Sitting improperly or out of position can result in serious injury or death in a crash.

Always sit upright, well back in the seat, with your feet on the floor.

▶▶Adjusting the Seats▶Armrest*

Armrest\*

Using the Front Seat Armrest

Honda Jazz (2018) - Using the Front Seat Armrest - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car seatbelt and rear seats (no text or symbols visible)

The console lid can be used as an armrest.

Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items

Interior Lights

Interior Light Switch

Door Activated Position On Off

■ON

The interior light comes on regardless of whether the doors are open or closed.

■Door activated

The interior light comes on in the following situations:

  • When any doors are opened.
  • You unlock the driver's door.

Models without keyless access system

- You remove the key from the ignition switch.

Models with keyless access system

- When the power mode is set to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).

OFF

The interior light remains off regardless of whether the doors are open or closed.

Interior Light Switch

In the door activated position, the interior light fades out and goes off about 30 seconds after the doors are closed.

The light goes off after 30 seconds in the following situations:

- When you unlock the driver's door but do not open it.

Models without keyless access system

- When you remove the key from the ignition switch but do not open a door.

Models with keyless access system

- When you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) but do not open a door.

The interior light goes off immediately in the following situations:

  • When you lock the driver's door.
  • When you turn the ignition switch to ON II ^-1 .

Models without keyless access system

- When you close the driver's door with the key in the ignition switch.

Models with keyless access system

- When you close the driver's door in ACCESSORY mode.

If you leave any of the doors open in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) mode, or without the key in the ignition switch, the interior light goes off after about 15 minutes.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Continued

▶▶ Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items▶ Interior Lights

Map Lights

Models with display audio system

The map lights can be turned on and off by pressing the lenses.

Models with colour audio system

Luggage Area Light

Honda Jazz (2018) - Luggage Area Light - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's side panel with a magnified inset showing a textured surface (no text or symbols visible)

The light comes on when you open the tailgate, and goes off when closed.

Interior Convenience Items

Glove Box
Honda Jazz (2018) - Interior Convenience Items - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing the dashboard and seat area with a highlighted directional arrow (no text or symbols)

Pull the handle to open the glove box.

Console Compartment*
Honda Jazz (2018) - Interior Convenience Items - 2

natural_image Interior view of a car seat with hand operating controls and a magnified inset showing a mechanical component (no text or symbols visible)

Pull the handle to open the console compartment.

Glove Box

WARNING

An open glove box can cause serious injury to your passenger in a crash, even if the passenger is wearing the seat belt.

Always keep the glove box closed while driving.

Beverage Holders

Honda Jazz (2018) - Beverage Holders - 1

■Front seat beverage holders

Pull the lid backward to use the front panel beverage holder.

The beverage holder is at the front of each door.

Beverage Holders

NOTICE

Spilled liquids damage the upholstery, carpeting, and electrical components in the interior.

Be careful when you are using the beverage holders. Hot liquid can scald you.

Continued

▶▶ Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items▶ Interior Convenience Items

Honda Jazz (2018) - NOTICE - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing front and rear door compartments with no visible text or symbols

■Rear seat beverage holders

The beverage holder is at the front of each door.

Luggage Floor Box

Floor Lid Luggage Floor Box

Pull up the luggage area floor lid.

Accessory Power Socket(s)

The accessory power socket can be used when the ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY I or ON II*1.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Accessory Power Socket(s) - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car with a highlighted camera module and directional arrow (no text or symbols)

■Accessory power socket (console panel) Open the cover to use it.

Cover

■Accessory power socket (console compartment)* Open the console lid and the cover to use it.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

* Not available on all models

Continued

>>Accessory Power Socket(s)

NOTICE

Do not insert an automotive type cigarette lighter element. This can overheat the power socket.

The accessory power socket is designed to supply power for 12-volt DC accessories that are rated 180 watts (15 amps) or less.

To prevent battery drain, only use the power socket with the engine running.

Coat Hook

Honda Jazz (2018) - Coat Hook - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing the rearview side of the window with a close-up inset highlighting the door mechanism (no text or symbols visible)

There is a coat hook on the rear driver's side grab handle. Pull it down to use it.

Tie-down Anchors

Front Anchors Rear Anchors

The tie-down anchors on the luggage area floor can be used to install a net for securing items.

Coat Hook

The coat hook is not designed for large or heavy items.

Luggage Area Cover

The luggage area cover may be removed to give you more luggage room.

■To remove the luggage area cover

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To remove the luggage area cover - 1

natural_image Exterior view of a car trunk with open lid and attached cable (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Open the tailgate.
  2. Remove the strap on each side of the tailgate.

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To remove the luggage area cover - 2

natural_image Diagram of a car trunk with attached seatbelt and directional arrows indicating movement (no text or symbols)
  1. Disengage the support rods, then remove the luggage area cover.

Reverse this procedure to install the luggage area cover.

After reinstalling the luggage area cover, make sure it is latched securely.

Luggage Area Cover

Do not place items on the luggage area cover, or stack objects higher than the top of the back seat. They could block your view and be thrown around the vehicle during a crush or sudden stop.

Do not apply excessive pressure to the cover, such as leaning on it to retrieve an item.

Continued

Seat Heaters\*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Seat Heaters\* - 1

natural_image Two black car seats with white panels, no visible text or symbols

The ignition switch must be in ON ^II ^*1 to use the seat heaters. The HI setting heats the seats faster than the LO setting.

Car interior control panel with Chinese annotation indicating a switch or mode selection

While in HI, the heater cycles on and off.

The appropriate indicator will be on while the seat heater is on. Briefly press the switch on the opposite side to turn the heater off. The indicator will be off. When a comfortable temperature is reached, select LO to keep the seat warm.

Seat Heaters*

WARNING

Heat induced burns are possible when using seat heaters.

Persons with a diminished ability to sense temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes, lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or with sensitive skin should not use seat heaters.

Do not use the seat heaters even in LO when the engine is off. Under such conditions, the battery may be weakened, making the engine difficult to start.

In the LO setting, the heater runs continuously and does not automatically turn off.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models

Heating and Cooling System\*

Using Vents, Heating and A/C
Dashboard vents Floor and dashboard vents Floor vents Floor and windscreen demister vents Windscreen demister vents Fan Control Dial Adjusts the fan speed. Rotate the dial all the way to OFF to turn everything off. Mode Control Dial Changes airflow. Temperature Control Dial Adjusts the interior temperature. A/C Button Press to cool the interior or dehumidify while heating. Fresh Air/Recirculation Lever This lever controls the source of the air going into the system. (Recirculation) Mode: Recirculates air from the vehicle's interior through the system. (Fresh Air) Mode: Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in fresh air mode in normal situations.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Heating

Diagram of a car air conditioner panel with icons for driving, walking, and cooling system

The heater uses heat from the engine coolant to warm the air.

  1. Adjust the fan speed using the fan control dial.
  2. Select and
  3. Adjust the temperature using the temperature control dial.

■To rapidly warm up the interior

  1. Set the fan to the maximum speed.
  2. Select ↓ ↓
  3. Set the temperature to maximum warm.
  4. Select

■To dehumidify the interior

When used in combination with the heater, the air conditioning system makes the interior warm and dry and can prevent the windows from fogging up.

  1. Turn the fan on.
  2. Press the A/C button to turn on the air conditioning.
  3. Select 📞 and 🐵. Adjust the temperature to your preference.

To rapidly warm up the interior

Change to fresh air mode as soon as the interior gets warm enough. The windows may fog up if kept in recirculation mode.

Cooling

A/C A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 1 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 2 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3 A/C 3

  1. Adjust the fan speed using the fan control dial.
  2. Select and
  3. Adjust the temperature using the temperature control dial.
  4. Press the A/C button (indicator on).

■To rapidly cool down the interior

  1. Set the fan to the maximum speed.
  2. Select
  3. Set the temperature to maximum cool.
  4. Press the A/C button (indicator on).
  5. Select

To rapidly cool down the interior

If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down more rapidly by partially opening the windows.

During the Auto Idle Stop, the air conditioning system will be turned off. To keep the air conditioning on, press the Auto Idle Stop OFF button to turn off the Auto Idle Stop system.

Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF P. 411, 416

Continued

Defrosting the Windscreen and Windows

A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0 A/C 0

  1. Set the fan to the high speed.
  2. Select
  3. Select
  4. Press the A/C button (indicator on).

Honda Jazz (2018) - Defrosting the Windscreen and Windows - 2

■To rapidly defrost the windows

  1. Set the fan to the maximum speed.
  2. Select
  3. Press the A/C button (indicator on).
  4. Select
  5. Set the temperature to maximum warm.

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To rapidly defrost the windows - 1

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To rapidly defrost the windows - 2

Defrosting the Windscreen and Windows

For your safety, make sure you have a clear view through all the windows before driving.

Do not set the temperature near the upper or lower limit.

When cold air hits the windscreen, the outside of the windscreen may fog up.

If the side windows fog up, adjust the vents so that the air hits the side windows.

Continuously variable transmission models

Selecting with the fan on restarts the engine during the Auto Idle Stop activated.

Manual transmission models

To defrost the windscreen during the Auto Idle Stop activated, restart the engine as follows:

  1. Make sure the shift lever is in the |N| position.
  2. Depress the clutch pedal fully.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Manual transmission models - 1

To rapidly defrost the windows

After defrosting the windows, switch over to fresh air mode. If you keep the system in recirculation mode, the windows may fog up from humidity. This impedes visibility.

Climate Control System\*

Using Automatic Climate Control

The automatic climate control system maintains the interior temperature you select. The system also selects the proper mix of heated or cooled air that raises or lowers the interior temperature to your preference as quickly as possible.

Dashboard vents Floor and dashboard vents Floor vents Floor and windscreen demister vents Temperature Control Icons Mode Control Icon Fan Control Icons AUTO Icon (On/Off) Icon (A/C) (Fresh Air) Icon (Recirculation) IconA/ Left-hand drive models shown.

Use the system when the engine is running.

  1. Select the AUTO icon.
  2. Adjust the interior temperature using the temperature control icons.
  3. Select the ☑ to cancel.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Using Automatic Climate Control

If any icons are selected while using the climate control system in auto, the function of the icon that was selected will take priority.

The AUTO indicator will go off, but functions unrelated to the icon that was selected will be controlled automatically.

To prevent cold air from blowing in from outside, the fan may not start immediately when the AUTO icon is selected.

If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down more rapidly by partially opening the windows, turning the system on auto, and setting the temperature to low. Change the fresh mode to recirculation mode until the temperature cools down.

When you set the temperature to the lower or upper limit, Lo or Hi is displayed.

You can raise or lower the temperature or fan speed setting flicking either control icon.

Diagram showing two hands pointing at a diagonal line with directional arrows and symbols indicating equality or equivalence.

■Switching between the recirculation and fresh air modes

Select the icon to switch the mode depending on environmental conditions.

Recirculation mode (indicator on): Recirculates air from the vehicle's interior through the system.
Fresh air mode (indicator on): Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in fresh air mode in normal situations.

Using Automatic Climate Control

Selecting the ON/OFF switches the climate control system between on and off. When turned on, the system returns to your last selection.

During the Auto Idle Stop, the air conditioning system will be turned off.

The air conditioning system may also be turned off when driving uphill.

Defrosting the Windscreen and Windows

FRONT AUTO 2500 AVIC AIR AIR

Select the ☐ on to turn the air conditioning system on and automatically switch the system to fresh air mode.

Select the ☐on again to turn off, the system returns to the previous settings.

25 AUTO AIR AIC AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG AVG

■To rapidly defrost the windows

  1. Select the 2. Select the

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To rapidly defrost the windows - 1

Defrosting the Windscreen and Windows

For your safety, make sure you have a clear view through all the windows before driving.

Do not set the temperature near the upper or lower limit.

When cold air hits the windscreen, the outside of the windscreen may fog up.

If the side windows fog up, adjust the vents so that the air hits the side windows.

Continuously variable transmission models

Selecting 📄starts the engine automatically during the Auto Idle Stop.

Manual transmission models

To defrost the windscreen during the Auto Idle Stop activated, restart the engine as follows:

  1. Make sure the shift lever is in the N position.

  2. Depress the clutch pedal fully.

  3. Select the icon

To rapidly defrost the windows

After defrosting the windows, switch over to fresh air mode. If you keep the system in recirculation mode, the windows may fog up from humidity. This impedes visibility.

Continued

Turning On and Off the Touch Screen Beep

You hear the beep when operating the climate control system on the touch screen. This can be turned on and off.

Diagram showing vehicle safety indicators with checkmark and warning symbols for driving or monitoring

To turn off the beep:

  1. Set the power mode to ON.
  2. Touch the of the temperature control icon five times while pressing and holding the
  3. Release the 📄, after -- blinks five times and OF is displayed.

Diagram showing car interior control panel with directional arrows and warning symbols

To turn on the beep:

  1. Set the power mode to ON.
  2. Touch the of the temperature control icon five times while pressing and holding the
  3. Release the 📄, after OF blinks five times and -- is displayed.

Turning On and Off the Touch Screen Beep

If you touch any other icons during this procedure, the setting may fail. In this case, once you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), then follow this procedure again.

■ Touch Panel Sensitivity Setting

You can set the level of sensitivity of the touch control panel to high, normal, or low.

Temperature display 25 AUTO AUTO ON/OFF

  1. Set the power mode to ON.
  2. Press and hold the AUTO icon, then press any of the following icons five times to set the level.
    • : High (Hi) *1

▶ Previous setting blinks five times and Hi will be displayed in the temperature display area.

• : Normal (--)
▶ Previous setting blinks five times and -- will be displayed in the temperature display area.
• : Low (Lo)
▶ Previous setting blinks five times and Lo will be displayed in the temperature display area.
3. Release the AUTO icon.

>>Touch Panel Sensitivity Setting

If you touch any other icons during this procedure, the setting may fail. In this case, once you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), then follow this procedure again.

Automatic Climate Control Sensors

Sensor

The automatic climate control system is equipped with sensors. Do not cover or spill any liquid on them.

Sensor

Features

This chapter describes how to operate technology features.

Audio System

About Your Audio System.... 220

USB Port(s)....221

HDMI™ Port ^* 222

Auxiliary Input Jack ^* 222

Audio System Theft Protection 223

Audio Antenna 224

Audio Remote Controls.... 225

Models with colour audio system

Audio System Basic Operation.... 227

Audio/Information Screen 228

Adjusting the Sound 232

Display Setup 233

Playing AM/FM Radio 234

Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting)* ....241

Playing a CD 245

Playing an iPod 248

Playing a USB Flash Drive 251

Playing Bluetooth® Audio 254

Models with display audio system

Audio System Basic Operation 257

Audio/Information Screen 258

Adjusting the Sound.... 274

Display Setup.... 275

Playing AM/FM Radio 277

Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) * .... 282

Playing a CD 285

Playing an iPod 288

Playing a USB Flash Drive 291

Playing Bluetooth® Audio.... 294

Playing a Video Using the HDMI™ .....296

On Board Apps....298

Smartphone Connection....299

Wi-Fi Connection....302

Siri® Eyes Free....304

Audio Error Messages 305

General Information on the Audio

System 308

Customized Features....313

Models with colour audio system

Hands-Free Telephone System ....339

Models with display audio system

Hands-Free Telephone System ....362

Audio System

About Your Audio System

The audio system features AM/FM radio. It can also play audio CDs, WMA/MP3/AAC files, USB flash drives, and iPod, iPhone and Bluetooth ^® devices.

You can operate the audio system from the buttons and switches on the panel, the remote controls on the steering wheel, or the icons on the touchscreen interface*.

Models with display audio system HDMI™ USB Port Remote Controls iPod USB Flash Drive USB Port*

Models with colour audio system Remote Controls USB Port Auxiliary Input Jack iPod® USB Flash Drive

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models

About Your Audio System

Video CDs, DVDs, and 8-cm mini CDs are not supported.

iPod, iPhone and iTunes are trademarks of Apple Inc.

Models with display audio system

Key Off Operation

After you turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0 ^1 , you can use the audio system for up to 30 minutes per driving cycle. However, whether you can continue using the audio system depends on the battery condition. Repeatedly using this feature may drain the battery.

USB Port(s)

Honda Jazz (2018) - USB Port(s) - 1
* Not available on all models

  1. Open the cover.
  2. Install the iPod USB connector or the USB flash drive to the USB port.

>>USB Port(s)

  • Do not leave the iPod or USB flash drive in the vehicle. Direct sunlight and high temperatures may damage it.
  • We recommend using an extension cable with the USB port.
  • Do not connect the iPod or USB flash drive using a hub.
  • Do not use a device such as a card reader or hard disk drive, as the device or your files may be damaged.
  • We recommend backing up your data before using the device in your vehicle.
  • Displayed messages may vary depending on the device model and software version.

If the audio system does not recognize the iPod, try reconnecting it a few times or reboot the device. To reboot, follow the manufacturer's instructions provided with the iPod or visit www.apple.com/ipod.

HDMI™ Port\*

HDMI Port

  1. Open the cover.
  2. Install the HDMI™ cable to the HDMI™ port.

Auxiliary Input Jack\*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Auxiliary Input Jack\* - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with control panel and directional arrow indicator (no text or symbols)

Use the jack to connect standard audio devices.

  1. Open the AUX cover.
  2. Connect a standard audio device to the input jack using a 3.5 mm (1/8 inch) stereo miniplug.

The audio system automatically switches to the AUX mode.

HDMI™ Port \*

  • Do not leave the HDMI™ connected device in the vehicle. Direct sunlight and high temperatures may damage it.
  • We recommend backing up your data before using the device in your vehicle.
  • Displayed messages may vary depending on the device model and software version.

The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition Multimedia Interface, and the HDMI Logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries.

Auxiliary Input Jack \*

To switch the mode, press any of the audio mode buttons. You can return to AUX mode by pressing the CD/AUX button.

Audio System Theft Protection

The audio system is disabled when it is disconnected from the power source, such as when the battery is disconnected or goes dead. In certain conditions, the system may display a code entry screen. If this occurs, reactivate the audio system.

■Reactivating the audio system

  1. Turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1
  2. Turn on the audio system.
  3. Press and hold the audio system power button for more than two seconds.
    The audio system is reactivated when the audio control unit establishes a connection with the vehicle control unit. If the control unit fails to recognise the audio unit, you must go to a dealer and have the audio unit checked.

Audio Antenna

Honda Jazz (2018) - Audio Antenna - 1

natural_image Side view of a car with a magnified inset showing a small object on the roof (no text or symbols visible)

Your vehicle is equipped with a removable antenna at the rear of the roof.

>>Audio Antenna

NOTICE

Before using a "drive-through" car wash, remove the antenna by unscrewing it by hand. This prevents the antenna from being damaged by the car wash brushes.

Audio Remote Controls

Allows you to operate the audio system while driving.

(Display) Button * Button Button SOURCE Button Button SOURCE Button Button -(Menu) Button*

SOURCE Button

Cycles through the audio modes as follows:

Models with colour audio system

FM1→FM2→DAB1*→DAB2*→LW→MW→

CD→USB→iPod→Bluetooth® Audio→AUX

Models with display audio system

FM→LW→MW→DAB*→CD→USB→iPod→

Apps→Bluetooth® Audio→AUX HDMI™

+(Volume) Buttons

Press +: To increase the volume.

Press ☐: To decrease the volume.

Honda Jazz (2018) - SOURCE Button - 1

Buttons

- When listening to the radio

Press ▶: To select the next preset radio station.

Press ◀: To select the previous preset radio station.

Press and hold ▶To select the next strong station.

To select the next service (DAB ^* ).

Press and hold ▶To select the previous strong station.

To select the previous service (DAB ^* ).

- When listening to a CD, iPod, USB flash drive, or Bluetooth® Audio

Press ▶: To skip to the next song.

Press ▶: To go back to the beginning of the current or previous song.

- When listening to a CD or USB flash drive

Press and hold ▶To skip to the next folder.

Press and hold 📂 to go back to the previous folder.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Audio Remote Controls

Some mode appears only when an appropriate device or medium is used.

Depending on the Bluetooth ^® device you connect, some functions may not be operated.

Models with display audio system

Steering Wheel (Menu) Button

  • When listening to the radio
    Press 📄: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Save Preset, or Seek.
  • When listening to a CD or USB flash drive Press 📄: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Repeat, or Random.
  • When listening to an iPod Press 📄: To display the menu items. You can select Repeat or Shuffle.
  • When listening to a Bluetooth® Audio Press 📄: To display the menu items. You can select Pause or Play.
  • When watching a video Press 📄: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Repeat, Random or Play/Pause.

(Display) Button

Cycles through the displays as follows:

Navigation ^* →Phone→Audio

Audio Remote Controls

The button is available only when the audio mode is FM, DAB*, LW, MW, CD, USB, iPod, or Bluetooth® Audio.

Audio System Basic Operation

Models with colour audio system

To use the audio system function, the ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY [I] or ON [II].

(Day/Night) Button TA Button Menu/ CLOCK Button (Back) Button Selector Knob

Use the selector knob or MENU/CLOCK button to access some audio functions.

Press &to switch between the normal and extended display for some functions.

Selector knob: Rotate left or right to scroll through the available choices. Press to set your selection.

Menu Display 12:34 Menu Scan Settings

MENU/CLOCK button: Press to select any mode.

The available mode includes the wallpaper, display, clock, language setup, sound settings, RDS settings, and play modes. Play modes can be also selected from scan, random, repeat, and so on.

(Back) button: Press to go back to the previous display.

TA button: Press to select the traffic announcement mode.

(Day/Night) button: Press to change the audio/information screen brightness.

Press 🙏 then adjust the brightness using .

▶ Each time you press ⚙️, the mode switches between the daytime mode, nighttime mode and OFF mode.

>>Audio System Basic Operation

These indications are used to show how to operate the selector knob.

Rotate to select.

Press 🔔 to enter.

Audio Menu Items

Adjust Clock P. 141

Wallpaper Setup P. 230

→Display Setup P. 233

Sound Settings P. 232

→Scan P. 247, 253

Play Mode P. 247, 250, 253

→RDS Settings P. 235

→DAB Settings P. 244

Bluetooth P. 254

Press the SOURCE, +, or button on the steering wheel to change any audio setting

Audio Remote Controls P. 225

One of the operating systems used in this unit is eCos.

For software license terms and condition, visit their website (eCos license URL:

http://ecos.sourceforge.org/license-overview.html)

For source code disclosure and other details regarding eCos, visit:

http://www.hondaopensource2.com

Audio/Information Screen

Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this screen, you can go to various setup options.

Switching the Display
Audio/Information Screen 12:34 600000 / 600000 Song AAA iPod Album AAA Artist AAA Clock/Wallpaper

Audio

Shows the current audio information.

■Clock/Wallpaper

Shows a clock screen or an image you import.

■Change display

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Settings, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔊 to select Display change, then press 🔕.
  4. Rotate 🔺 to select Wallpaper, then press 😊.
    ▶ If you want to return to the audio display, select Audio.

Wallpaper Setup

You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Wallpaper Setup - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Menu 12:34"] --> B["Scan Settings"]
    B --> C["Settings 12:34"]
    C --> D["Display change Wallpaper Colour theme"]
    D --> E["12:34"]
    E --> F["Select Import Delete"]

■Import wallpaper

You can import up to three images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash drive.

  1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB port.

USB Port(s) P. 221

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.

  2. Rotate 🔒 to select Settings, then press 🔒.

  3. Rotate 🔒 to select Wallpaper, then press 🔒.

  4. Rotate 🔒 to select Import, then press 🔒. ▶The picture name is displayed on the list.

  5. Rotate to select a desired picture, then press 😊.

The selected picture is displayed.

  1. Press to save the picture.

  2. Press 🕒 to select OK.

  3. Rotate to select a location to save the picture, then press 😊

The display will return to the wallpaper setting screen.

Wallpaper Setup

  • When importing wallpaper files, the image must be in the USB flash drive's root directory. Images in a folder cannot be imported.
    • The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
  • The file format of the image that can be imported is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
    • The individual file size limit is 2 MB.
  • The maximum image size is 1,920 x 936 pixels. If the image size is less than 420 x 234 pixels, the image is displayed in the middle of the screen with the extra area appearing in black.
  • Up to 255 files can be selected
  • If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures, the No files detected message appears.

■Select wallpaper

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Settings, then press 😊.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Wallpaper, then press 😊.
  4. Rotate 🔺 to select Select, then press 😊.
    The screen changes to the wallpaper list.

  5. Rotate to select a desired wallpaper, then press.

■To view wallpaper once it is set

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Settings, then press 😊.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Display change, then press 😊.
  4. Rotate 🔊 to select Wallpaper, then press 😊.
    The screen changes to the wallpaper list.

  5. Rotate 🔒 to select a wallpaper that you want to set, then press 😊.

■Delete wallpaper

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Settings, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔊 to select Wallpaper, then press 😊.
  4. Rotate 🔺 to select Delete, then press 😊.
    The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
  5. Rotate 🔺 to select a wallpaper that you want to delete, then press 😊.
  6. Rotate 🔺 to select Yes, then press 😊.
    The display will return to the wallpaper setting screen.

Wallpaper Setup

To go back to the previous screen, press the (Back) button.

When the file size is large, it takes a while to be previewed.

Adjusting the Sound

LIST/SELECT (Selector) Knob

TRE is selectable. 12:34 Sound BAS TRE FAD R +

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Sound, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate to scroll through the following choices:

Honda Jazz (2018) - Adjusting the Sound - 3

flowchart
graph TD
    A["BAS"] --> B["TRE"]
    B --> C["FAD"]
    C --> D["BAL"]
    D --> E["SVC"]
    style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style B fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style C fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style D fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style E fill:#f9f,stroke:#333

Rotate to adjust the sound setting, then press 😊.

Adjusting the Sound

The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High. SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As you slow down, audio volume decreases.

Display Setup

You can change the brightness or colour theme of the audio/information screen.

Changing the Screen Brightness

12:34 Display adjustment Brightness Contrast

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Settings, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Display adjustment, then press 🔺
  4. Rotate 🔺 to select Brightness, then press 🔺.
  5. Rotate to adjust the setting, then press ⚙.

Changing the Screen's Colour Theme

12:34 Colour theme Blue Red Amber

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Settings, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Colour theme, then press 😊.
  4. Rotate to select the setting you want, then press 😊

Changing the Screen Brightness

You can change the Contrast and Black level settings in the same manner.

Playing AM/FM Radio

RADIO Button Press to select a band. Audio/Information Screen TA Button Press to activate the TA stand by function. VOL/(Volume/Power) Knob Press to turn the audio system on and off. Turn to adjust the volume. VOL 12:34 FM1 103.5MHz 1 2 3 4 5 6 TA LIST ON SELECT MENU/CLOCK Menu/CLOCK Button Turn to tune the radio frequency. Press, and then turn to select an item. After that, press again to make your selection. MENU / Buttons Press to set up and down the selected band for a station with a strong signal. Preset Buttons (1-6) To store a station: 1. Tune to the selected station. 2. Pick a preset button and hold it until you hear a beep. To listen to a stored station, select a band, then press the preset button. MENU/CLOCK Press to display the menu items. (Back) Button Press to go back to the previous display or cancel a setting.

FM mode

Radio Data System (RDS) ^*

Provides convenient automated services related to your selected RDS-capable FM station.

■To find an RDS station from Station List

12:34 Station list Update list WWWWWWWWWWWWWW WWWWWWWWWWWWWW TP

  1. Press ☑ while listening to an FM station.
  2. Rotate to select the station, then press ⚙.

■Manual Update

Updates your available station list at any time.

  1. Press ☑ while listening to an FM station.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Update list, then press 😊.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Playing AM/FM Radio

The ST indicator appears on the display indicating stereo FM broadcasts. Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.

Switching the Audio Mode

Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel.

Audio Remote Controls P. 225

You can store 12 AM stations and 12 FM stations into the preset button memory. AM has two types of frequencies LW and MW, and each lets you store six stations. FM1 and FM2 let you store six stations each.

>>Radio Data System (RDS)\*

When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS automatically turns on, and the frequency display changes to the station name. However, when the signals of that station become weak, the display changes from the station name to the frequency.

▶▶ Audio System Basic Operation ▶ Playing AM/FM Radio

■Available RDS functions

Alternative Frequency (AF):

Automatically changes the frequency of the same programme as you enter different regions.

Regional Programme (REG):

Keeps the same frequency of the stations within that region even if the signal gets weak.

Except AM/FM/DAB mode

News Programme (NEWS):

Automatically tunes to the news programme.

Radio Data System (RDS) \*

While listening to an FM station on Station list, pressing (Seek/Skip) button change station.

■Selecting the RDS functions
Settings 12:34 RDS settings Bluetooth 12:34 RDS settings Radio text AF REG

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button with the FM selected.
  2. Rotate 🔊 to select RDS settings and press 🔒.
  3. Each RDS function is displayed every time you rotate 🔒
  4. Press to select a function.

>>Radio Data System (RDS) \*

Turning the Alternative Frequency (AF) function on and off turns the RDS on and off.

Pressing switches the function between on and off.

* Not available on all models

Continued

■Traffic announcement (TA) button

TA standby function allows the system to stand by for traffic announcements in any mode. The last tuned station must be an RDS-capable traffic programme station.

To turn the function on: Press the TA button. When a traffic announcement begins on your last tuned station, the system automatically switches to the FM mode. TA-INFO appears on the display. The system returns to your last selected mode after the traffic announcement is finished.

If you want to go back to your last selected mode during the traffic announcement, press the TA button again.

To cancel the function: Press the TA button.

Except AM/FM/DAB \* mode

■Programme type (PTY)/News interrupt function

Allows the system to interrupt with a newscast in any mode. The last tuned station must be the NEWS PTY coded station.

To activate the function: Select NEWS from RDS settings and display the NEWS PTY before changing to other modes. When a newscast begins on your last tuned station, the system automatically switches to the FM mode.

Selecting the RDS functions P. 237

The system returns to your last selected mode if changed to another programme, or signal gets weak.

Radio Data System (RDS) *

TA

When you press the TA button, the TA indicator appears on the display.

If you select SCAN while the TA standby function is on, the system searches TP station only.

Pressing the TA button while the traffic announcement is on does not cancel the TA standby function.

■PTY alarm

When the PTY code for emergency announcements, such as natural disasters, is received, ALARM appears on the display and the system interrupts your audio operation.

■Radio Text
RDS settings Radio text AF REG 12:34

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button with the FM selected.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Radio text and press 😊.

Radio Text

The TEXT indicator appears on the display indicating radio text information.

Continued

AM (MW/LW) mode

Station List

Lists the strongest stations on the selected band.

  1. Press the RADIO button to switch to a mode.
  2. Press to switch to the station list mode.
  3. Rotate to select the station, then press.

■Manual update

Updates your available station list at any time.

  1. Press the RADIO button to switch to a mode.
  2. Press & to switch to the station list mode.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Update list, then press 😊.

Scan

Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Scan, then press 😊.

To turn off scan, press 😊

Station List

If the system cannot find any station on Station list, a confirmation message for updating the list appears. Rotate 🔔 to select Yes, then press to update list.

12:34 Confirmation The station list is not the latest. Recommend to update the list. No Yes

Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting)*
RADIO Button Press to select a band. The DAB indicator appears on the display when the DAB band is selected. Audio/Information Screen VOL (Volume/Power) Knob Press to turn the audio system on and off. Turn to adjust the volume. 12:34 Reelution www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//www.//w/ 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 TA VOL 1 2 3 4 5 6 LIST FOR SELECT MENU CLOCK Selector Knob Turn to tune the station. Press, and then turn to select an item. After that, press again to make your selection. MENU/CLOCK Button Press to display the menu items. Press to go back to the previous display or cancel a setting. (Back) Button Press to listen to a stored station, select a band, then press the preset button. Preset Buttons (1-6) To store a station: 1. Tune to the selected station. 2. Pick a preset button and hold it until you hear a beep. To listen to a stored station, select a band, then press the preset button.

* Not available on all models

Continued

To find a DAB station from Service List or Ensemble List

12:34 Ensemble list Update list Ensemble 001 Ensemble 002

  1. Press & while selecting the DAB mode.
  2. Rotate to select the station, then press
    ▶ If you select Update list, the system updates the station list.

Honda Jazz (2018) - To find a DAB station from Service List or Ensemble List - 2

To find a DAB station from Service List or Ensemble List

If the system cannot find a station, a confirmation message for updating the list appears. Rotate to select Yes, then press to update the list.

12:34 Confirmation The station list is not the latest. Recommend to update the list. No Yes

■Setting the DAB functions

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■Setting the DAB functions - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Settings"] --> B["DAB settings"]
    B --> C["Bluetooth"]
    D["DAB settings"] --> E["DAB-Link"]
    D --> F["FM-Link"]
    E --> G["Band select [BandIII"]]
    F --> G
  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button with the DAB selected.
  2. Rotate 🔒 to select DAB settings and press 😊.

  3. Each DAB function is displayed every time you rotate 📞

  4. Press to select a function.
  5. Rotate to select a setting, then press.

▶▶ Audio System Basic Operation ▶ Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting)*

DAB Settings

Automatically searches for the same station from Ensembles, and switches to it.

If the system finds the same station from an FM band, it automatically switches the band.

■Band select:

You can select specific bands. This can reduce the time to update the lists, and search for a station.

Radio Text
12:34 DAB settings Radio text ✓ DAB-Link

  1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button with the DAB selected.
  2. Rotate 🔒 to select Radio text and press 🔒.

>>Radio Text

The TEXT indicator appears on the display indicating radio text information.

Playing a CD

Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs and CD-RWs in either MP3, WMA, or AAC ^4 format. With the CD loaded, press the CD/AUX button.

Audio/Information Screen CD Slot Insert a CD about halfway into the CD slot. (CD Eject) Button Press to eject a CD. CD/AUX Button Press to play a CD. VOL/(Volume/Power) Knob Press to turn the audio system on and off. Turn to adjust the volume. VOL 12:34 256 255 Track AAA 13'24" Album AAA E Artist AAA 1 2 3 4 5 6 TA MENU/CLOCK Selector Knob Turn to change tracks/files. Press to display a track/folder list. Press, and then turn to select an item. After that, press again to make your selection. MENU/CLOCK Button Press to display the menu items. Press and hold to move rapidly within a track/file. Play Mode Buttons (1-6) Press to select a play mode. (Back) Button Press to go back to the previous display or cancel a setting.

*1: Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.

Continued

How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob (MP3/WMA/AAC)

Honda Jazz (2018) - How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob (MP3/WMA/AAC) - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["12:34 Track AAA"] --> B["Folder Selection"]
    B --> C["12:34 Folder list"]
    C --> D["Track Selection"]
    D --> E["12:34 Track list"]
  1. Press ☐ switch the display to a folder list.
  2. Rotate to select a folder.
  3. Press to display a list of files in that folder.
  4. Rotate to select a track, then press.

Playing a CD

NOTICE

Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can cause the CD to jam in the unit.

WMA files protected by digital rights management (DRM) cannot be played.

The audio system displays Unplayable file, then skips to the next file.

Text data appears on the display under the following circumstances:

  • When you select a new folder, file, or track.
  • When you change the audio mode to CD.
  • When you insert a CD.

If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot, the system reloads the CD automatically after several seconds.

How to Select a Play Mode

You can select repeat, random, and scan modes when playing a track or file.

12:34 CD56 82.261 Track AAA 11 Album AAA 12 AUM AAA Play Mode Buttons

Available mode icons appear above the play mode buttons.

Press the button corresponding to the mode you want to select.

■To turn off a play mode

Press the selected button.

How to Select a Play Mode

Play Mode Menu Items

Repeat

Repeat one folder (MP3/WMA/AAC):

Repeats all files in the current folder.

Repeat one track: Repeats the current track/file.

Random

Random in folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Plays all files in the current folder in random order.

Random all: Plays all tracks/files in random order.

Scan

Scan folders (MP3/WMA/AAC): Provides 10-second sampling of the first file in each of the main folders.

Scan tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all tracks on the CD (all files in the current folder in MP3, WMA, or AAC).

You can also select a play mode by pressing the MENU/CLOCK button.

Rotate to select Play mode, then press. Rotate to select a mode, then press.

To turn it off, rotate to select Normal play, then press 😊.

Playing an iPod

Using your USB connector, connect the iPod to a USB port, then press the CD/AUX button.

USB Port(s) P. 221

USB Indicator Appears when an iPod is connected. Audio/Information Screen CD/AUX Button Press to select iPod (if connected). VOL/(Volume/Power) Knob Press to turn the audio system on and off. Turn to adjust the volume. 12:34 600000 / 600000 Song AAA iPod Album AAA QH Artist AAA 1 2 3 4 5 6 TA VOL 1 2 3 4 5 6 LIST SELECT MENU/CLOCK Selector Knob Turn to change songs. Press, and then turn to select an item. After that, press again to make your selection. MENU/CLOCK Button Press to display the menu items. Press / Buttons Press to change songs. Press and hold to move rapidly within a song. Album Art Play Mode Buttons Press to select a play mode. (Back) Button Press to go back to the previous display or cancel a setting.

How to Select a Song from the iPod Music List with the Selector Knob

Honda Jazz (2018) - How to Select a Song from the iPod Music List with the Selector Knob - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["12:34"] --> B["Category Selection"]
    B --> C["12:34"]
    C --> D["Item Selection"]
    D --> E["12:34"]
  1. Press & to display the iPod music list.
  2. Rotate to select a category.
  3. Press to display a list of items in the category.
  4. Rotate to select an item, then press.

▶Press and rotate repeatedly until a desired item you want to listen is displayed.

Playing an iPod

Available operating functions vary on models or versions. Some functions may not be available on the vehicle's audio system.

If there is a problem, you may see an error message on the audio/information screen.

→ iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 306

Continued

How to Select a Play Mode

You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a song.

12-34 Play Mode Buttons

Available mode icons appear above the play mode buttons.

Press the button corresponding to the mode you want to select.

■To turn off a play mode

Press the selected button.

>>How to Select a Play Mode

Play Mode Menu Items

Shuffle albums: Plays all available albums in a selected category (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres, or composers) in random order.
Shuffle all: Plays all available songs in a selected category (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres, or composers) in random order.
Repeat one track: Repeats the current song.

You can also select a play mode by pressing the MENU/CLOCK button.

Rotate to select Play mode, then press

Honda Jazz (2018) - >>How to Select a Play Mode - 1

Rotate to select a mode, then press. To turn it off, rotate to select Normal play, then press.

Playing a USB Flash Drive

Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3, WMA or AAC ^4 format.

Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then press the CD/AUX button.

USB Port(s) P. 221

Audio/Information ScreenUSB Indicator Appears when a USB flash drive is connected. CD/AUX Button Press to select USB flash drive (if connected). VOL/(Volume/Power) Knob Press to turn the audio system on and off. Turn to adjust the volume. Play Mode Buttons (1-6) Press to select a play mode. Selector Knob Turn to change files. Press, and then turn to select an item. After that, press again to make your selection. MENU/CLOCK Button Press to display the menu items. Press to go back to the previous display.

*1: Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.

Continued

How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob

Honda Jazz (2018) - How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["12:34"] --> B["Folder Selection"]
    B --> C["12:34"]
    C --> D["Track Selection"]
    D --> E["12:34"]
  1. Press to display a folder list.
  2. Rotate to select a folder.
  3. Press to display a list of files in that folder.
  4. Rotate to select a file, then press.

Playing a USB Flash Drive

Use the recommended USB flash drives.

General Information on the Audio System P. 308

Files in WMA format protected by digital rights management (DRM) cannot be played. The audio system displays Unplayable file, and then skips to the next file.

If there is a problem, you may see an error message on the audio/information screen.

iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 306

How to Select a Play Mode

You can select repeat, random, and scan modes when playing a file.

12:34 C100 8:25 Tota AAA Album AAA Album AAA Play Mode Buttons

Available mode icons appear above the play mode buttons.

Press the button corresponding to the mode you want to select.

■To turn off a play mode

Press the selected button.

How to Select a Play Mode

Play Mode Menu Items

Repeat

Repeat one folder: Repeats all files in the current folder.

Repeat one track: Repeats the current file.

Random

Random in folder: Plays all files in the current folder in random order.

Random all: Plays all files in random order.

Scan

Scan folders: Provides 10-second sampling of the first file in each of the main folders.

Scan tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all files in the current folder.

You can also select a play mode by pressing the MENU/CLOCK button.

Rotate to select Play mode, then press. Rotate to select a mode, then press.

To turn it off, rotate to select Normal play, then press 😊.

Playing Bluetooth® Audio

Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible phone.

This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle's Bluetooth® Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) system.

Phone Setup P. 346

CD/AUX Button Press to select Bluetooth® Audio. Bluetooth Indicator Appears when your phone is connected to HFT. Audio/Information Screen VOL/ (Volume/ Power) Knob Press to turn the audio system on and off. Turn to adjust the volume. 12:34 600000 Track AAA Album AAA Artist AAA Phone AAA VOL 1 2 3 4 5 6 TA MENU/CLOCK Button Press to display the menu items. Pause Button (Preset 2) Press to pause playing a file. Play Button (Preset 1) Press to resume playing a file. Press / Buttons to change files.

Playing Bluetooth® Audio

Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming audio capabilities are compatible with the system. To check if your phone is compatible, ask a dealer.

In some countries, it may be illegal to perform some data device functions while driving.

Only one phone can be used with HFT at a time. When there are more than two paired phones in the vehicle, the first paired phone the system finds is automatically connected.

If more than one phone is paired to the system, there will be a delay before the system begins to play.

In some cases, the name of the artist, album, or track may not appear correctly.

Some functions may not be available on some devices.

To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files

CD/AUX Button 12:34 Pause Button Play Button

  1. Make sure that your phone is paired and connected to the system.
  2. Press the CD/AUX button.

If the phone is not recognized, another HFT-compatible phone, which is not compatible for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be connected.

■To pause or resume a file

Press a Play or Pause button to select a mode.

To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files

To play the audio files, you may need to operate your phone. If so, follow the phone maker's operating instructions.

The pause function may not be available on some phones.

If any audio device is connected to the auxiliary input jack or USB port, you may need to press the CD/AUX button repeatedly to select the Bluetooth® Audio system.

Switching to another mode pauses the music playing from your phone.

Continued

■ How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the Selector Knob

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■ How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the Selector Knob - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["12:34 Track AAA\nAlbum AAA\nArtist AAA\nPhone AAA"] --> B["Category Selection"]
    B --> C["12:34 Music\n04:Albums\n05:Artists\n06:Genres"]
    C --> D["Item Selection"]
    D --> E["12:34 Artists\n01:All\n02:Artist AAA\n03:Artist BBB"]
  1. Press to display the music search list.
  2. Rotate to select a category.
  3. Press to display a list of items in the category.
  4. Rotate to select an item, then press

▶Press and rotate repeatedly until a desired item you want to listen is displayed.

How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the Selector Knob

Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect, some or all of the categories may not be displayed.

Audio System Basic Operation

Models with display audio system

To use the audio system function, the ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY [I] or ON [II]*1.

(Home) Icon Button Back Icon (Back) Icon (Menu) Icon

(Home): Select to go to the home screen. Switching the Display P. 258
MENU (Menu): Touch to select any mode. The available mode includes Change Source, Station List, Save Preset, Radio Text, Music Search, and play modes. Play modes can be also selected from Scan, Random/Repeat, and so on.
(Back): Select to go back to the previous display when it is displayed.

(Day/Night) button:

Press to change the audio/information screen brightness.

Press ☐ once and select or to make an adjustment.

▶ Each time you press 📣the mode switches between the daytime mode, nighttime mode and OFF mode.

>>Audio System Basic Operation

Audio Menu Items

Station List P. 279
Music Search P. 286, 289, 292
Random/Repeat P. 287, 293
→Scan P. 279, 287, 293

When the battery has been reconnected or replaced, the next start-up may take a few minutes for the audio system to start. Wait a few moments while the system is starting up.

Press and hold the ☐Power) button for approximately 10 seconds to reset the system. When the system is reset and started up, you are required to input the password.

→ Audio System Theft Protection P. 223

Key Off Operation

Key Off Operation P. 220

Audio/Information Screen

Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this screen, you can go to various setup options.

Switching the Display

■Using the button

Press the (display) button on the steering wheel to change the display.

(Display) Button Audio/Information Screen

■Using the home screen

Home Screen Models without navigation system FM 12:34 Phone info Area Audio Settings Models with navigation system 12:34 Navigation Phone Info TA Audio Settings Area

Select 📄 go to the home screen.

Select Phone, Info, Audio, Settings, Navigation*, or TA.

Phone

Shows the HFT information.

→ Hands-Free Telephone System P. 362

* Not available on all models

Continued

Info

To see all available information, Trip Computer, Clock/Wallpaper, or System/

Device Information, select

Trip Computer:

  • Current Drive tab: Displays the current trip information.
  • History of Trip A tab: Displays information for the three previous drives. The information is stored every time you reset Trip A.

Clock/Wallpaper: Displays the clock and wallpaper.

System/Device Information:

  • Version Information: Displays the software version of the audio system.
    • USB Device Information: Displays the memory usage of the USB device.
  • USB Device Change: Connects or disconnects USB device to this audio system.

Audio

Shows the current audio information.

Settings

Enters the customizing menu screen.

→ Customized Features P. 313

Displays the navigation screen.

Refer to the Navigation System Manual

■ (App List)

Adds or removes App or Widget on the home screen.

Home Screen P. 264

TA

Turns on and off the traffic information.

* Not available on all models

Audio/Information Screen

Touchscreen operation

  • Use simple gestures - including touching, swiping and scrolling - to operate certain audio functions.
  • Some items may be greyed out during driving to reduce the potential for distraction.
  • You can select them when the vehicle is stopped or use voice commands.
  • Wearing gloves may limit or prevent touchscreen response.

Changing the Home Screen Icon Layout

Home customize 12:34 Navigation Phone Info TA Audio Settings Also Default OK

  1. Select HOME.
  2. Select Settings.
  3. Select System.
  4. Select the HOME tab.
  5. Select Home icon position.
  6. Select and hold the icon then, drag it to the desired position.

Wallpaper Setup

You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.

■Import wallpaper

You can import up to five images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash drive.

Clock/Wallpaper type 12:34 Clock Wallpaper Galaxy Metallic Blank 12:34. Customs All Add New OK

Import new wallpaper 12:34 AA.JPG BB.JPG AAA.jpg BBB.jpg Start Import

  1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB port.
    USB Port(s) P. 221
  2. Select Settings to go to the Settings screen.
  3. Select Info
  4. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then the Wallpaper tab.
  5. Select Add New.

The picture name is displayed on the list.

  1. Select a desired picture.
    The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
  2. Select Start Import to save the data.
    ▶Then the display will return to the wallpaper list.

Wallpaper Setup

  • When importing wallpaper files, the image must be in the USB flash drive's root directory. Images in a folder cannot be imported.
  • The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
  • The file format of the image that can be imported is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
    • The individual file size limit is 5 MB.
  • The maximum image size is 4,096 × 4,096 pixels. If the image size is less than 800 × 480 pixels, the image is displayed in the middle of the screen with the extra area appearing in black.
  • Up to 5 files can be selected.
  • If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures, the No files detected message appears.

■Select wallpaper

  1. Select Settings to go to the Settings screen.
  2. Select Info.
  3. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then the Wallpaper tab.
    The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
  4. Select a desired wallpaper.
    The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
    The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
  5. Select Set.
    The display will return to the wallpaper list.

■To view wallpaper once it is set

  1. Select HOME.
  2. Select Info.
  3. Select MENU.
  4. Select Clock/Wallpaper.

■Delete wallpaper

  1. Select Settings to go to the Settings screen.
  2. Select Info.
  3. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then the Wallpaper tab.
    The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
  4. Select a wallpaper that you want to delete.
    The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
    The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
  5. Select Delete.
    The confirmation message will appear.
  6. Select Yes to delete completely.
    The display will return to the wallpaper list.

Wallpaper Setup

From the pop-up menu, select Preview to see a preview at full-size screen.

Clock/Wallpaper type 12:34 Set Preview Delete 12:34 X.XC.XCC OK

To go back to the previous screen, select OK, or BACK

When the file size is large, it takes a while to be previewed.

To delete all wallpapers you add, select Delete All, then Yes.

▶▶ Audio System Basic Operation ▶ Audio/Information Screen

Home Screen

■To change to a next screen

12:34 Swipe Honda App Center Icon Current page position 12:34 Navigation Phone Info TA Audio Settings Aha

Selecting ▶or , ▶r swiping the screen left or right changes to the next screen.

Home Screen

The home screen has 5 pages (fixed). You cannot add any more pages.

■To use apps or widgets
12:34 Navigation Phone Info TA Audio Settings Aha Icon App/Widget List 12:34 App Widget File Edit Browse Calculate Describe Check Downloads Actions Show Image Mouse Search SendMe

1. Select

The App/Widget List screen appears.

  1. Select the app or widget you want to use.

• Aha Radio: Starts up Aha Radio app.
- Browser: Displays the web browser utilized by smartphone and Wi-Fi connection.
• Calculator: Displays Calculator.
• Calendar: Displays Calender.
- Clock: Displays Clock.
- Downloads: Displays the data downloaded from the web browser and so on.
- Gallery: Displays the image list stored in the audio system.
• Germin Navigator: Starts up navigation app.
- Honda App Center: Displays Honda App Center.
• Install App: Installs and updates app stored in the USB flash drive. However, you can install and update app only through Honda App Center.
- Music: Displays the music list stored in the audio system.
- Search: Displays various retrieval screens.
- Settings: Displays the Android setting screen.

To use apps or widgets

Select and hold a selected app or widget to add that app's or widget's shortcut on the home screen.

Pre-installed apps may not start up normally. If this occurs, you need to reset the system.

→ Defaulting All the Settings P. 338

If you perform Factory Data Reset, it may reset all the settings to their factory default.

→ Defaulting All the Settings P. 338

In case those apps still do not startup normally even after Factory Data Reset, contact your dealer.

There is a possibility that a browser is shut down in the situation of the use. In that situation, the screen will return to before the browser startup.

You can delete user installed apps by the following procedure.

  1. Select HOME
  2. Select Settings
  3. Select System
  4. Select the Others tab.
  5. Select Detail Information.
  6. Select an App that you want to delete.
  7. Select Delete.

Pre-installed apps cannot be deleted.

▶▶ Audio System Basic Operation ▶ Audio/Information Screen

■To add app or widget icons on the home screen

App or widget icons can be added on the home screen.

12:34 Navigation Phone Info TA Audio Settings Select and hold. 12:34 Add App Add Widget Select Wallpaper

  1. Select and hold empty space on the home screen.

The pop-up menu appears on the screen.

  1. Select Add App or Add Widget.

The Add App/Widget screen appears.

App/Widget List 12:34 App Widget Select and hold. Home customize 12:34 Drag and drop. Default OK

  1. Select and hold an app or widget icon you want to add.

The screen switches to the customization screen.

  1. Drag and drop the icon to where you want it to be.

  2. Select OK.

The screen will return to the home screen.

■To move icons on the home screen

You can change location on the home screen.

Home customize 12:34 Select and hold. Default OK Home customize 12:34 Drag and drop. TA Audio Settings Auto Default OK

  1. Select and hold an icon.
    The screen switches to the customization screen.
  2. Drag and drop the icon to where you want it to be.
  3. Select OK.
    The screen will return to the home screen.

To move icons on the home screen

You can also move the Phone, Info, Audio,

Settings, and Navigation* icons in the same manner.

■To remove icons on the home screen

You can delete the icons on the home screen.

Home customize 12:34 Navigation Phone Info TA Audio Select Default OK Select and hold. Home customize 12:34 Navigation Phone Info TA Audio Select Default OK Drag and drop.

  1. Select and hold an icon.
    The screen switches to the customization screen.
  2. Drag and drop the icon you want to delete to the waste basket icon.
    The icon is deleted.
  3. Select OK
    The screen will return to the home screen.

To remove icons on the home screen

You cannot delete the Phone, Info, Audio, Settings, and Navigation * icons.

Apps or widgets will not be deleted by deleting the icon on the home screen.

■To change the home screen wallpaper

You can change a wallpaper of the home screen.

12:34 Add App Add Widget Select Wallpaper

  1. Select and hold empty space on the home screen.
    The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
  2. Select Select Wallpaper.
    The pop-up menu appears on the screen.

12:34 Choose wallpaper from Gates Live Wallpaper Wallpapers 12:34 Set wallpaper

  1. Select an app for selecting wallpapers.
  2. Select the wallpaper you want to change.
  3. Select Set wallpaper.

The wallpaper is changed, then the screen will return to the home screen.

Status Area

12:34 Navigation Swipe Info TA Audio Settings Aha 12:34 1/1/2013 Garmin Navigator IconSta

Swipe the upper area of the screen.

The status area appears.

Select an item to see the details.

Select 📄 swipe up the icon to close the area.

Changing the Screen Interface

You can change the screen interface design.

System settings 12:34 Voice Recog Clock Others Language Remember Last Screen Off Memory Refresh On Refresh Time Adjustment Skin Change Default OK 12:34 FM 87.5mm Audio Phone NAV Ana Info

  1. Select HOME
  2. Select Settings.
  3. Select System.
  4. Select the Others tab.
  5. Select Skin Change
  6. A confirmation message appears on the screen. Select Yes.

Changing the Screen Interface

You need to reboot the system after changing the interface design. Wait a few moments while the system is starting up.

You can change the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.

Wallpaper Setup P. 262

If you change the screen interface, some of the setting items will change.

Customized Features P. 313

Closing Apps

You can close specific apps running in the background on the system.

Task/History manager 12:34 Active App : 5 Active/History Active Application1 Application2 Application3 Application4 Clear All Task/History manager 12:34 Active App : 5 Show Clear

1. Select

  1. Select the Active tab.

If you select the Active/History tab, you can close the apps that are currently running and delete the app activity history simultaneously.

  1. Select an app you want to close.

  2. Select Clear.

The display will return to the app list.

Closing Apps

If you leave the apps used open in the background, some apps may stop operating properly next time using them.

If this happens close unused apps.

To close all apps on the system, select Clear All, then Yes.

You cannot close the Garmin ^app.

Adjusting the Sound

Audio settings 12:34 Sound Source Popup Off RDS Settings Default OK

  1. Select HOME
  2. Select Settings.
  3. Select Audio.
  4. Select Sound.

Select the tabs to adjust the following choices: BASS, TREBLE, FADER, BALANCE, Speed Volume Compensation (SVC)

Sound 12:34 BAS-TRE FAD-BAL SVC BASS - TREBLE - Default OK

Adjusting the Sound

The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High. SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As you slow down, audio volume decreases.

Display Setup

You can change the brightness or colour theme of the audio/information screen.

Changing the Screen Brightness

Display settings 12:34 Brightness - Contrast - Black Level - - - - - + OK

  1. Select HOME.
  2. Select Settings to go to the Settings screen.
  3. Select System.
  4. Select the Display tab.
  5. Select Display Settings.
  6. Select the setting you want.
  7. Select OK

Changing the Screen's Colour Theme

System settings 12:34 Background Colour Blue Amber Red Violet

  1. Select HOME
  2. Select Settings to go to the Settings screen.
  3. Select System.
  4. Select the Display tab.
  5. Select Background Colour.
  6. Select the setting you want.
  7. Select OK
    ▶A confirmation message appears on the screen. Select Yes to reboot the system.

Changing the Screen Brightness

You can change the Contrast and Black Level settings in the same manner.

Changing the Screen's Colour Theme

Reboot may take a few minutes. If you default the System settings when the colour theme is changed from its default colour, the system reboots.

Customized Features P. 313

Continued

Selecting an Audio Source

Select the source icon. Source Select Screen FM 12:34 SOURCE 87.5 MHz Tune Seek Source List Icons

Select the current source icon, then select an icon on the source list to switch the audio source.

Limitations for Manual Operation

Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion. You cannot select a grayed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.

>>Selecting an Audio Source

If you startup preinstalled audio apps, audio Apps displayed on the upper left of the screen. These preinstalled apps cannot be displayed on the source select screen.

You can startup those audio apps from App/Widget List.

Playing AM/FM Radio

(Power) Button Press to turn the audio system on and off. Audio/Information Screen VOL (Volume) Icons Select to adjust the volume. (Menu) Icon Select to display the menu items. (Back) Icon Select to go back to the previous display. Open/Close Icon*1 Displays/hides the detailed information. Tune Icons Select up to tune the radio frequency. Seek Icons Select to switch up and down the selected band for a station with a strong signal.

*1: Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.

Preset Memory

To store a station:

  1. Tune to the selected station.
  2. Select MENU.
  3. Select Save Preset.
  4. Select the preset number you want to store that station.

Playing AM/FM Radio

The ST indicator appears on the display indicating stereo FM broadcasts.

Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.

Switching the Audio Mode

Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel or select SOURCE on the list.

Audio Remote Controls P. 225

You can also switch the mode by selecting Change Source on the Audio menu screen.

You can store 12 AM stations and 12 FM stations into the preset memory. AM has two types of frequencies LW and MW, and each lets you store six stations.

Station List

Lists the strongest stations on the selected band.

  1. Select MENU to switch to the Audio menu screen.
  2. Select Station List.
  3. Select the station.

■Manual update

Updates your available station list at any time.

  1. Select ☐ to switch to the Audio menu screen.
  2. Select Station List.
  3. Select Refresh.

Scan

Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.

  1. Select MENU.
  2. Select Scan

To turn off scan, select Cancel.

Radio Data System (RDS)\*

Provides text data information related to your selected RDS-capable FM station.

■To find an RDS station from Station List

  1. Select ☐ while listening to an FM station.
  2. Select Station List.
  3. Select the station.

■Manual update

Updates your available station list at any time.

  1. Select ☐ while listening to an FM station.
  2. Select Station List.
  3. Select Update List.

Radio Data System (RDS) \*

When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS automatically turns on, and the frequency display changes to the station name. However, when the signals of that station become weak, the display changes from the station name to the frequency.

■Radio text

Displays the radio text information of the selected RDS station.

  1. Select MENU.

  2. Select Radio Text.

Scan

Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.

  1. Select MENU

  2. Select Scan.

To turn off scan, select Cancel Scan

Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting)\*

(Power) Button Press to turn the audio system on and off. Audio/Information Screen VOL (Volume) Icons Select to adjust the volume. (Menu) Icon Select to display the menu items. (Back) Icon Select to go back to the previous display. Open/Close Icon*1 Displays/hides the detailed information. Ensemble Icons Select to tune the frequency. Service Icons Select to set up and down the selected band for a station with a strong signal.

*1: Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.

Preset Memory

Stores a station:

  1. Tune to the selected station.
  2. Select MENU.
  3. Select Save Preset.
  4. Select the preset number for the station you want to store.

Ensemble List

Lists the strongest stations.

  1. Select MENU
  2. Select Ensemble List.
  3. Select the station.

■Manual update

Updates your available station list at any time.

  1. Select MENU
  2. Select Ensemble List.
  3. Select Update List.

Scan

Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.

  1. Select MENU.
  2. Select Scan
  3. Select Scan Ensemble or Scan Service.

To turn off scan, select Cancel Scan.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *

Switching the Audio Mode

Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel or select SOURCE on the screen.

Audio Remote Controls P. 225

You can also switch the mode by selecting Change Source on the Audio menu screen.

You can store 12 DAB stations into preset memory.

▶▶ Audio System Basic Operation ▶ Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting)*

Radio text

Displays the radio text information of the selected DAB station.

  1. Select MENU.
  2. Select Radio Text.

Playing a CD

Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs and CD-RWs in either MP3, WMA, or AAC ^4 format. With the CD loaded, select the CD mode.

Audio/Information Screen (Power) Button Press to turn the audio system on and off. CD Slot Insert a CD about halfway into the CD slot. (CD Eject) Button Press to eject a CD. VOL (Volume) Icons Select to adjust the volume. (Menu) Icon Select to display the menu items. (Back) Icon Select to go back to the previous display. Open/Close Icon *2 Displays/hides the detailed information. Folder Icons Select to skip to the next folder, and to skip to the beginning of the previous folder in MP3, WMA, or AAC. Track Icons Select to drop tracks (files in MP3, WMA, or AAC). Select and hold to move rapidly within a track.

*1: Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.

*2: Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.

Continued

How to Select a File from the Music Search List (MP3/WMA/AAC)

Honda Jazz (2018) - How to Select a File from the Music Search List (MP3/WMA/AAC) - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Audio menu 12:34"] --> B["Scan"]
    A --> C["Random/Repeat"]
    A --> D["Music Search"]
    A --> E["Sound"]
    A --> F["Change Source"]
    B --> G["Folder Selection"]
    C --> G
    D --> G
    E --> G
    F --> G
    G --> H["Track Selection"]
    H --> I["Music Search 12:34"]
    I --> J["01 ROOT"]
    I --> K["02 AAA"]
    I --> L["03 BBB"]
    I --> M["04 CCC"]
    I --> N["05 DDD"]
    I --> O["06 EEE"]
    I --> P["01 01 aaa"]
    I --> Q["02 02 bbb"]
    I --> R["03 03 ccc"]
    I --> S["04 04 ddd"]
    I --> T["05 05 eee"]
    I --> U["06 06 ff"]
  1. Select MENU and select Music Search
  2. Select a folder.
  3. Select a track.

Playing a CD

NOTICE

Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can cause the CD to jam in the unit.

WMA files protected by digital rights management (DRM) cannot be played.

The audio system displays Unplayable File, then skips to the next file.

Text data appears on the display under the following circumstances:

  • When you select a new folder, file, or track.
  • When you change the audio mode to CD.
  • When you insert a CD

If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot, the system reloads the CD automatically after several seconds.

How to Select a Play Mode

You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a track or file.

Random/Repeat 12:34 Repeat Folder ×× Random All Tracks Repeat Track ×× Random in Folder Random/Repeat is selected.

  1. Select MENU
  2. Select Scan or Random/Repeat.
  3. Select a mode.

■To turn off a play mode

  1. Select MENU.
  2. Select the mode you want to turn off.

How to Select a Play Mode

Play Mode Menu Items

Scan

Scan Folders (MP3/WMA/AAC): Provides 10-second sampling of the first file in each of the main folders.

Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all tracks on the CD (all files in the current folder in MP3, WMA, or AAC).

Random/Repeat

Repeat Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Repeats all files in the current folder.

Repeat Track: Repeats the current track/file.

Random in Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Plays all files in the current folder in random order.

Random All Tracks: Plays all tracks/files in random order.

Playing an iPod

Connect the iPod using your USB connector to the USB port, then select the iPod mode.

USB Port(s) P. 221

(Power) Button Press to turn the audio system on and off. Audio/Information Screen USB Indicator Appears when an iPod is connected. VOL (Volume) Icons Select to adjust the volume. MENU (Menu) Icon Select to display the menu items. Back (Back) Icon Select to go back to the previous display. Open/Close Icon*1 Displays/hides the detailed information. Cover Art Song Icons Select to change songs. Select and hold to move rapidly within a song.

*1: Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.

How to Select a Song from the Music Search List

Honda Jazz (2018) - How to Select a Song from the Music Search List - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Audio menu 12-34"] --> B["Category Selection"]
    B --> C["Track Selection"]
  1. Select 📄 and select Music Search.
  2. Select the items on that menu.

How to Select a Song from the Music Search List

Available operating functions vary on models or versions. Some functions may not be available on the vehicle's audio system.

If there is a problem, you may see an error message on the audio/information screen.

→ iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 306

If you operate the music app on your iPhone/iPod while the phone is connected to the display audio system, you may no longer be able to operate the same app on the display audio. Reconnect the device if necessary.

Select USB device change in the Audio menu screen to switch to another USB device.

Continued

How to Select a Play Mode

You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a file.

Shuffle/Repeat 12:34 Shuffle Albums Shuffle All Songs Repeat Song

  1. Select MENU
  2. Select Shuffle/Repeat.
  3. Select a mode.

■To turn off a play mode

  1. Select MENU
  2. Select the mode you want to turn off.

>>How to Select a Play Mode

Play Mode Menu Items

Shuffle Albums: Plays all available albums in a selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, podcasts, genres, composers, or audiobooks) in random order.

Shuffle All Songs: Plays all available files in a selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs, podcasts, genres, composers, or audiobooks) in random order.

Repeat Song: Repeats the current file.

Playing a USB Flash Drive

Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3, WMA, AAC ^*1 , or WAV format.

Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then select the USB mode.

USB Port(s) P. 221

(Power) Button Press to turn the audio system on and off. VOL (Volume) Icons Select to adjust the volume. excess (Menu) Icon Select to display the menu items. excess (Back) Icon Select to go back to the previous display. Audio/Information Screen USB Indicator Appears when a USB flash drive is connected. Open/Close Icon* Displays/hides the detailed information. Folder Icons Select skip to the next folder, and skip to the beginning of the previous folder. Track Icons Select to change files. Select and hold to move rapidly within a track.

*1: Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
*2: Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.

Continued

How to Select a File from the Music Search List

Honda Jazz (2018) - How to Select a File from the Music Search List - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Music Search 12:34"] --> B["Folder Selection"]
    B --> C["Track Selection"]
  1. Select MENU and select Music Search.
  2. Select Music or Movie.

  3. Select a folder.

  4. Select a track.

Playing a USB Flash Drive

Use the recommended USB flash drives.

General Information on the Audio System P. 308

Files in WMA format protected by digital rights management (DRM) are not played. The audio system displays Unplayable File, and then skips to the next file.

If there is a problem, you may see an error message on the audio/information screen.

iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 306

Select USB device change in the Audio menu screen to switch to another USB device.

How to Select a Play Mode

You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a file.

Random/Repeat 12:34 Repeat Folder SC Random All Tracks Repeat Track SC Random in Folder Random/Repeat is selected.

  1. Select MENU
  2. Select Scan or Random/Repeat.
  3. Select a mode.

■To turn off a play mode

  1. Select MENU.
  2. Select the mode you want to turn off.

How to Select a Play Mode

Play Mode Menu Items

Scan

Scan Folders: Provides 10-second sampling of the first file in each of the main folders.

Scan Tracks (Scan Movies ^*1 ): Provides 10-second sampling of all files in the current folder.

Random/Repeat

Repeat Folder: Repeats all files in the current folder.

Repeat Track (Repeat Movies ^*1 ): Repeats the current file.

Random in Folder: Plays all files in the current folder in random order.

Random All Tracks (Random All Movies ^1 ): Plays all files in random order.

When playing a video file:

Play/Pause: Select to resume or play a file.

Stop: Select to stop a file.

*1: When playing a video file

Playing Bluetooth® Audio

Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible phone.

This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle's Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) system.

Phone Setup P. 368

Bluetooth Indicator Appears when your phone is connected to HFT. Audio/Information Screen (Power) Button Press to turn the audio system on and off. Open/Close Icon*1 Displays/hides the detailed information. VOL/ (Volume) Icons Select to adjust the volume. excess (Menu) Icon Select to display the menu items. (Back) Icon Select to go back to the previous display. Play Icon Pause Icon Group Icons Group Track Icons Select to change tracks. Select to change group.

Playing Bluetooth® Audio

Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming audio capabilities are compatible with the system. To check if your phone is compatible, ask a dealer.

It may be illegal to perform some data device functions while driving.

Only one phone can be used with HFT at a time. When there are more than two paired phones in the vehicle, the first paired phone the system finds is automatically linked.

If more than one phone is paired to the HFT system, there may be a delay before the system begins to play.

In some cases, the name of the artist, album, or track may not appear correctly.

A No Device Connected message may be displayed if:

• The phone is not linked to HFT.
• The phone is not turned on.
• The phone is not in the vehicle.
- An incompatible phone is connected.

Some functions may not be available on some devices.

*1: Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect, some or all of the lists may not be displayed.

To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files

Sunseth 12:34 SOURCE AAA 01 BBB CCC DDD Group Track

  1. Make sure that your phone is paired and connected to the system.

Phone Setup P. 346

  1. Select the Bluetooth® Audio mode.

If the phone is not recognized, another HFT-compatible phone, which is not compatible for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be connected.

■To pause or resume a file

Select the play icon or pause icon.

Searching for Music

Audio menu 12:34 Music Search Sound Change Source

  1. Select MENU

  2. Select Music Search.

  3. Select a search category (e.g., Albums).

  4. Select an item.

The selection begins playing.

To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files

To play the audio files, you may need to operate your phone. If so, follow the phone maker's operating instructions.

Switching to another mode pauses the music playing from your phone.

Searching for Music

Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect, some or all of the lists may not be displayed.

Playing a Video Using the HDMI™

Your audio system allows you to play videos from an HDMI™-compatible device. Connect the device, using an HDMI™ cable, then select the HDMI™ mode.

HDMI™ Port* P. 222

(Power) Button Press to turn the audio system on and off. Audio/Information Screen VOL (Volume) Icons Select to adjust the volume. (MENU) Icon Select to display the menu items. (Back) Icon Select to go back to the previous display.

Changing the Screen Aspect

Audio settings 12:34 Sound Source Popup Off Display Adjustment Aspect Adjustment RDS Settings Default OK

  1. Select HOME.
  2. Select Settings to go to the Settings screen.
  3. Select Audio.
  4. Select Aspect Adjustment.
  5. Select the setting you want.
  6. Select OK.

Playing a Video Using the HDMI™

This feature is limited while driving. To play videos, stop your vehicle and apply the parking brake.

On Board Apps

Honda Connect has the capability of On Board Apps which may be created by Honda or by 3rd parties. Apps may be already installed or can be downloaded through Honda App Center. Some Apps require internet access which can be established by Wi-Fi Connection.

Wi-Fi Connection P. 302

Please visit the below web address for further information: https://ivhs.os.ixonos.com/honda/help

On Board Apps

Make sure the GPS setting is turned on before using Honda App center.

Customized Features P. 313

Even if you change Background Colour on the System settings screen, it will not be reflected on the Honda App Center screen.

FM 875mm BC 12:34 Honda App Center

Honda App Center icon

Honda App Center provides access to a variety of App related services.

  • Using the Display Audio system while driving can take your attention away from the road, causing a crash in which you could be seriously injured or killed. Only operate system controls when the conditions permit you to safely do so. Please always adhere to the laws of the territory when operating this device.
  • Applications on the head unit are subject to change at anytime. This may mean that they are not available or operate differently. Honda shall not be liable to you in such instances.
  • Applications available on the device may be provided by parties other than Honda to which 3rd party software licences and charges may apply.
  • Data usage and roaming charges may result in using applications on the device in conjunction with your mobile phone and Honda is not liable for any costs you might incur from such use. Honda recommends you consult your mobile phone network provider in advance.
  • Downloading applications from the Honda App Center will be subject to Terms and Conditions which can be found at: https://ivhs.os.ixonos.com/honda/help, and may also incur charges.

Smartphone Connection

Some of your smartphone apps can be displayed and operated on the audio/information screen when the phone is connected to the audio system. You can connect your phone using a cable, or wirelessly.

Connecting Your iPhone P. 301
Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time) P. 302

Smartphone Connection

Park in a safe place before connecting your phone and while operating the displayed apps.

Not all phones are compatible with the system. The system does not display all the available apps on smartphone, and some apps need to be preinstalled. Ask a dealer for details.

You need to switch the Bluetooth® connection to your smartphone if another electronic device is connected.

To change the currently paired phone P. 369

The following may vary by phone type:

  • Connection methods
    • How to connect a smartphone to the system.
  • Apps that can be operated on the screen.
  • Display response time/update time

We do not support every app operation on the display audio.

Ask the app provider for any questions on the app's features.

Do not get drawn into the display while operating a vehicle.

Continued

To use smartphone connection, you need to first pair your smartphone to the audio system via Bluetooth®.

Phone Setup P. 368

Audio/Information Screen Microphone (Home) Icon Select to go back to home screen or to a previous display. (Menu) Icon Select to display the menu on the app you selected. (Not available on all apps.) (Back) Icon Select to go back to the previous display. (Not available on all phones.) Apps 12:34 Navigation Phone Info TA Audio Settings Ana Arrow Appears when the phone is connected to the system. Select to display available apps.

Connecting Your iPhone

USB Cable HDMI™ Cable Digital AV Adapter

  1. Connect your phone to the display audio via Bluetooth®.

Phone Setup P. 368

  1. Plug in the digital AV adapter to the HDMI™ jack.

  2. Connect the digital AV adapter to your iPhone.

▶Wait until an arrow appears on the home screen.

  1. Select the arrow to display the available smartphone apps on the audio/information screen.

▶You may need to operate from the phone.

  1. Select an app you want to operate from the audio/information screen.

▶ To go back to the previous screen, select

Connecting Your iPhone

Make sure to plug in the digital AV adapter to the HDMI™ jack first. If not, smartphone connection may not work properly.

To recharge your phone, connect it to the USB jack, too.

Contact a dealer for the digital AV adapter or HDMI™ cable purchasing information.

Wi-Fi Connection

You can connect the display audio system to the Internet using Wi-Fi and browse websites or use online services on the audio/information screen. If your phone has mobile hotspot capabilities, the system can be tethered to the phone. Go through the following steps for a setup.

Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time)

Bluetooth/Wi-Fi settings 12:34 Bluetooth Wi-Fi Bluetooth Device List Edit Pairing Code Wi-Fi On/Off Status On Wi-Fi Device List Wi-Fi Device Information Default OK

  1. Select HOME.
  2. Select Settings.
  3. Select Bluetooth / Wi-Fi.
  4. Select the Wi-Fi tab.
  5. Select Wi-Fi On/Off Status, then On.
  6. Select Wi-Fi Device List.

Make sure your phone's Wi-Fi setting is in access point (tethering) mode.
▶Select the phone you want to connect to the system.
▶If you do not find the phone you want to connect in the list, select Scan.

Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time)

You cannot go through the setting procedure while a vehicle is moving. Park in a safe place to set the audio system in Wi-Fi mode.

Some cell phone carriers charge for tethering and smartphone data use. Check your phone's data subscription package.

Check your phone manual to find out if the phone has Wi-Fi connectivity.

You can confirm whether Wi-Fi connection is on or off with the 📞 on Wi-Fi Device list. Transmission speed and others will not be displayed on this screen.

Wi-Fi device list 12:34 AAAAA BBBB CCCCC Connect Connect to Connect

7. Select Connect.

▶ Enter a password for your phone, and select Done.
▶If you cannot enter the password on the displayed keyboard, change the keyboard to the one in which you can enter from the Android setting.

Customized Features P. 313

When the connection is successful, the icon is displayed on the list.

  1. Select 📄 go back to the home screen.

■ Wi-Fi mode (after the initial setting has been made)

Make sure your phone's Wi-Fi setting is in access point (tethering) mode.

Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time)

If you cannot enter the password on the displayed keyboard, change the keyboard to the one in which you can enter from the following order:

Settings→Android→Language & input→select next to Android keyboard→Input

language→uncheck the box next to Use system language→select the keyboard languages that you can enter.

>>Wi-Fi mode (after the initial setting has been made)

iPhone users

You may need to go through an initial setup for Wi-Fi connection again after you boot your phone.

Siri® Eyes Free

You can talk to Siri using the □(Talk) button on the steering wheel when your iPhone is paired to the Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) System.

Phone Setup P. 368

Using Siri® Eyes Free
Appears when Siri is activated in Siri® Eyes Free While in Siri® Eyes Free: The display remains the same. No feedback or commands appear. (Talk) button: Press and hold until the display changes as shown. (Hang-up/back) button: Press to deactivate Siri.

Siri® Eyes Free

Siri is a trademark of Apple Inc.

Check Apple Inc, website for features available for Siri.

We recommend against using Siri other than in Siri® Eyes Free while operating a vehicle.

Using Siri® Eyes Free

Some commands work only on specific phone features or apps.

Audio Error Messages

CD Player

If a disc error occurs, you may see the following error messages.

Error Message Cause Solution
Unplayable file*1Unplayable File*2Track/file format not supportedCurrent track/file will be skipped. The next supported track/file plays automatically.
Bad discPlease check owners manualPush eject*1Bad DiscPlease Check Owner's ManualPush Eject*2Mechanical errorPress the ▲ject) button and remove the disc, and check that the error message is cleared.Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed, and insert the disc again. ➤Protecting CDs P. 309If the error message reappears, press the ▲button, and pull out the disc.Insert a different disc.If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc.If the error message repeats, or the disc cannot be removed, contact a dealer.Do not try to force the disc out of the player.
Mechanical error*1Mecha Error*2
Bad discPlease check owners manual*1Bad DiscPlease Check Owner's Manual*2Servo error
Check disc*1Check Disc*2Disc errorCheck that the disc is not damaged or deformed. ➤Protecting CDs P. 309
Heat error*1Heat Error*2High temperatureTurn the audio system off and allow the player to cool down until the error message is cleared.

*1: Colour audio system
*2: Display audio system

iPod/USB Flash Drive

If an error occurs while playing an iPod or USB flash drive, you may see the following error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.

Error Message Solution
USB error*1USB Error*2Appears when there is a problem with the USB adapter unit. Check if the device is compatible with the USB adapter unit.
Incompatible USB devicePlease check owner's manual*1Bad USB DevicePlease Check Owners Manual*2Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect the device. Then turn the audio system off, and turn it on again. Do not reconnect the device that caused the error.
Unsupported ver*1Unsupported Version*2Appears when an unsupported iPod is connected. If it appears when a supported iPod is connected, update the iPod software to the newer version.
Retry connection*1Connect Retry*2Appears when the system does not acknowledge the iPod. Reconnect the iPod.
Unplayable file*1Unplayable File*2Appears when the files in the USB flash drive are DRM or an unsupported format. This error message appears for about three seconds, then plays the next song.
No data*1No song*1No Data*2iPodAppears when the iPod is empty.USB flash driveAppears when the USB flash drive is empty or there are no MP3, WMA, or AAC files in the USB flash drive.iPod and USB flash driveCheck that compatible files are stored on the device.
UnsupportedAppears when an unsupported device is connected. If it appears when a supported device is connected, reconnect the device.

*1: Colour audio system
*2: Display audio system

Models with display audio system

Android/Apps

If an error occurs while using the audio system or apps, you may see the following error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.

Error Message*1Solution
Unfortunately, **** has stopped.Error has occurred within app, select OK on the screen to close the app. Unless it is a fatal error, it would return to normal if you startup the app.If it does not return to normal even after starting up the app, press and hold the (power) button to perform the forced reset. If it still does not get back to normal, you need Factory Data Reset.➤ Defaulting All the Settings P. 338
**** is not responding. Would you like to close it?App is in a busy state.Select Wait if you can wait for a response from app a little longer. If it does not respond even if you keep waiting, select OK to close the app and start it up. When it does not return to normal, press and hold the (power) button to perform the forced reset. You also need Factory Data Reset.➤ Defaulting All the Settings P. 338
Security warningOccurs if you open the browser when the system date is older than the certificate date information. It also occurs when you are in the area where GPS reception is unavailable or GPS setting of the Android setting is turned off.Turn on GPS setting of the Android setting.Move to the area where GPS reception is available.➤ Customized Features P. 313

*1: **** part is variable characters, and will change depending upon where an error occurs.

General Information on the Audio System

  • Use only high-quality CD-R or CD-RW discs labeled for audio use.
  • Use only CD-R or CD-RW discs on which the recordings are closed.
  • Play only standard round-shaped CDs.

The CD packages or jackets should have one of these marks.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Recommended CDs - 1

Honda Jazz (2018) - Recommended CDs - 2

Honda Jazz (2018) - Recommended CDs - 3

Honda Jazz (2018) - Recommended CDs - 4

Honda Jazz (2018) - Recommended CDs - 5

CDs with MP3, WMA, or AAC files

  • Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
  • Some versions of MP3, WMA, or AAC formats may be unsupported.

A Dual-disc cannot play on this audio unit. If recorded under certain conditions, a CD-R or CD-RW may not play either.

■Protecting CDs

Follow these precautions when handling or storing CDs:

  • Store a CD in its case when it is not being played.
  • When wiping a CD, use a soft clean cloth from the centre to the outside edge.
  • Handle a CD by its edge. Never touch either surface.
  • Never insert foreign objects into the CD player.
  • Keep CDs out of direct sunlight and extreme heat.
  • Do not place stabilizer rings or labels on the CD.
  • Avoid fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tip pens on the CD.

>>Protecting CDs

NOTICE

Do not insert a damaged CD. It may be stuck inside and damage the audio unit.

Examples:

Bubbled, wrinkled, labeled, and excessively thick CDs Bubbled/ Wrinkled With Label/ Sticker Using Printer Label Kit Sealed With Plastic Ring Damaged CDs Poor quality CDs Chipped/ Cracked Warped Burrs Small CDs 8-cm CD

Honda Jazz (2018) - Examples: - 2

Honda Jazz (2018) - Examples: - 3

Honda Jazz (2018) - Examples: - 4

Honda Jazz (2018) - Examples: - 5

Honda Jazz (2018) - Examples: - 6

Honda Jazz (2018) - Examples: - 7

Honda Jazz (2018) - Examples: - 8

Honda Jazz (2018) - Examples: - 9

Compatible iPod, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives

iPod and iPhone Model Compatibility

Model

iPod (5th generation)

iPod classic 80GB/160GB (launch in 2007)

iPod classic 120GB (launch in 2008)

iPod classic 160GB (launch in 2009)

iPod nano (1st to 6th generation) launch in 2010

iPod nano (7th generation) launch in 2012

iPod touch (1st to 4th generation) launch in 2010

iPod touch (5th generation) launch in 2012

iPhone 3G/iPhone 3GS/iPhone 4/iPhone 4s/iPhone 5/iPhone 5c*1/iPhone 5s*1

*1: Display audio system

iPod and iPhone Model Compatibility

This system may not work with all software versions of these devices.

USB Flash Drives

  • A USB flash drive of 256 MB or higher is recommended.
  • Some digital audio players may not be compatible.
  • Some USB flash drives (e.g., a device with security lockout) may not work.
  • Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
  • Some versions of MP3, WMA, AAC or WAV * formats may be unsupported.

Models with display audio system

Recommended Devices

Media CD-R/CD-RW/USB Flash Drive
Profile (MP4 version)Baseline Level 3 (MPEG4-AVC),Simple Level 5 (MPEG4)
File extension(MP4 version).mp4/.m4v
Compatible audio codec MPEG4-AVC (H.264)MPEG4(ISO/IEC 14496 Part.2)
Bit rate 10 Mbps (MPEG4-AVC) 8 Mbps (MPEG4)
Maximum image 720 X 576 pixels

* Not available on all models

USB Flash Drives

Files on the USB flash drive are played in their stored order. This order may be different from the order displayed on your PC or device.

▶▶General Information on the Audio System▶ About Open Source Licences

Models with display audio system

About Open Source Licences

To see the open source licence information, follow these steps.

  1. Select HOME.
  2. Select Settings
  3. Select Android.
  4. Select About device.
  5. Select Legal information.
  6. Select Open source licences.

About Open Source Licences

You can also go to step 4 when you:

- Swipe down from the top.

▶Select Appears on the screen.

- Select Ⓞ, then select Settings on the App tab.

Customized Features

Use the audio/information screen to customize certain features.

Models with colour audio system

How to customize

While the vehicle is at a complete stop with the ignition switch in ON Ⅱ, press the MENU/CLOCK button, then select Settings. To customize the phone settings, press the button, then select Phone setup.

Audio/Information Screen (Phone) Button 12:34 Settings Display change Wallpaper Colour theme MENU/CLOCK Button Selector Knob

Continued

>>Customized Features

When you customize settings:

• Make sure that the vehicle is at a complete stop.

Continuously variable transmission models

- Shift to P.

Manual transmission models

- Set the parking brake.

>>How to customize

These indications are used to show how to operate the selector knob.

Rotate to select.

Press to enter.

To customize other features, select Settings, rotate

, and press

→ List of customizable options P. 318

■Customization flow

Press the MENU/CLOCK button.

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■Customization flow - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Adjust clock"] --> B["Sound"]
    B --> C["BAS"]
    B --> D["TRE"]
    B --> E["FAD"]
    B --> F["BAL"]
    B --> G["SVC"]
    H["Play mode^1,2"] --> I["Normal play"]
    I --> J["Repeat one folder"]
    I --> K["Repeat one track"]
    I --> L["Random in folder"]
    I --> M["Random all"]
    I --> N["Shuffle album"]
    I --> O["Shuffle all"]
    I --> P["Scan folders"]
    I --> Q["Scan tracks"]
    R["Scan^3"] --> S

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■Customization flow - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Settings"] --> B["RDS settings"]
    B --> C["Radio text"]
    B --> D["AF"]
    B --> E["REG"]
    B --> F["NEWS*1"]
    B --> G["DAB settings^"]
    G --> H["Radio text"]
    G --> I["DAB-Link"]
    G --> J["FM-Link"]
    G --> K["Band select"]
    G --> L["Bluetooth Add new device"]
    L --> M["Connect an audio device"]
    L --> N["Display adjustment"]
    N --> O["Brightness"]
    N --> P["Contrast"]
    N --> Q["Black level"]

*1: Except AM/FM/DAB * mode
* Not available on all models

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■Customization flow - 3

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Display change Audio"] --> B["Wallpaper"]
    C["Wallpaper"] --> D["Select"]
    C --> E["Import"]
    C --> F["Delete"]
    G["Colour theme"] --> H["Blue"]
    G --> I["Red"]
    G --> J["Amber"]
    G --> K["Grey"]
    L["Language"] --> M["Clock format"]
    M --> N["12H"]
    M --> O["24H"]

Press the 📊 button and rotate 🔺 to select Phone setup, then press 😊.

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■Customization flow - 4

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Bluetooth setup Add new device"] --> B["Connect a phone"]
    A --> C["Connect an audio device"]
    A --> D["Disconnect all devices"]
    A --> E["Delete device"]
    A --> F["Pass-key"]
    G["Speed dial"] --> H["Mobile phone"]
    I["Ringtone Fixed"] --> J["Mobile phone"]
    K["Caller ID info Name priority"] --> L["Number priority"]
    M["System clear"] --> N["Mobile phone"]

■List of customizable options

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Adjust clockAdjust Clock. ➡Clock P. 140 —
SoundBAS
TREAdjusts the settings of the audio speaker's sound. ➡Adjusting the Sound P. 232 —
FAD
BAL
SVC
Play modeNormal play
CD/USB mode
Repeat one folder
CD/iPod/USB mode
Repeat one track
CD/USB mode
Random in folder
CD/USB modeSelects a play mode. ➡How to Select a Play Mode P. 247, 250, 253 —
Random all
iPod mode
Shuffle album
iPod mode
Shuffle all
CD/USB mode
Scan folders
CD/USB mode
Scan tracks

*1: Default Setting

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
AM/FM/DAB* mode ScanSelects the scan mode. ➤Scan P. 247, 253
SettingsRDS settingsRadio textTurns on and off the radio text information.On/Off*1
AF Turns on and off Alternative Frequency (AF). On*1/Off
REG Turns on and off Regional Programme (REG). On*1/Off
Except AM/FM/DAB* mode NEWSTurns on and off to automatically to tune to the news programme.On/Off*1
DAB settings*Radio textTurns on and off the radio text information.On/Off*1
DAB-LinkSelects whether the system automatically searches for the same station from Ensembles, and switches to it.On*1/Off
FM-LinkSelects whether the system finds the same station from an FM band, and automatically switches the band.On*1/Off
Band selectSelects specific bands to reduce the time to update the lists, and search for a station.Both*1/BandIII/L-Band
BluetoothAdd new devicePairs a new phone to HFT, edits and deletes a paired phone, and create a code for a paired phone. ➤Phone Setup P. 346
Connect an audio deviceConnects, disconnects or pairs a Bluetooth® Audio device to HFT.

*1: Default Setting

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
SettingsDisplay adjustmentBrightnessChanges the brightness of the audio/information screen.
ContrastChanges the contrast of the audio/information screen.
Black levelChanges the black level of the audio/information screen.
Display change Changes the display type. Audio ^*1 /Wallpaper
WallpaperSelect Changes the display type.Clock ^*1 /Image1/Image2/Image3
ImportImports an image file for a new wallpaper. →Wallpaper Setup P. 230
Delete Deletes an image file for a wallpaper. Image1 ^*1 /Image2/Image3
Colour themeChanges the background colour of the audio/information screen.Blue ^*1 /Red/Amber/Grey
Language Changes the display language.English ^*1 /Other selectable language is shown on the screen.
Clock formatSelects the digital clock display from 12H to 24H.12H ^*1 /24H

*1: Default Setting

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Phone setupBluetooth setupAdd new devicePairs a new phone to HFT. ➡Phone Setup P. 346
Connect a phonePairs a new phone or connects a paired phone to HFT. ➡Phone Setup P. 346
Connect an audio deviceConnects a Bluetooth® Audio device to HFT.
Disconnect all devices Disconnects a paired phone from HFT. —
Delete device Deletes a paired phone. —
Pass-key Inputs and changes a code for a paired phone. —
Speed dialEdits, adds or deletes a speed dial entry. ➡Speed Dial P. 355
Ringtone Selects the ring tone. Fixed*1/Mobile phone
Caller ID infoPrioritizes the caller's name or phone number as the caller ID.Name priority^1/Number priority
System clearCancels/Resets all customized items in the Phone setup group as default.

*1: Default Setting

Models with display audio system

How to customize

While the vehicle is at a complete stop with the ignition switch in ON ^*1 , select Settings, then select a setting item.

Audio/Information Screen FM 12:34 Phone Info Audio Camera Bluetooth / Wi-Fi System Android

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

>>Customized Features

When you customize settings:

  • Make sure that the vehicle is at a complete stop.
  • Continuously variable transmission models Shift to P.
  • Manual transmission models Set the parking brake.

>>How to customize

To customize other features, select Settings.

→ List of customizable options P. 328

If you press and hold the ☐(power) button when resetting the system, it may restore the customized value to its default value depending on the setting items.

Honda Jazz (2018) - >>How to customize - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Select"] --> B["Select Settings."]
    B --> C["FM 12:34"]
    C --> D["System"]
    D --> E["Home Home icon"]
    D --> F["Display Display Set"]
    D --> G["Sound/Beep Volume"]
    D --> H["Voice Recogn. Voice"]
    D --> I["Clock Clock/Wallp"]
    D --> J["Others Language"]
    D --> K["Default"]

    E --> L["Menu Icon Position*2"]
    F --> M["Brightness"]
    G --> N["Background Colour*1"]
    H --> O["Beep"]
    I --> P["Type*2"]
    P --> Q["Clock Adjustment"]
    P --> R["Time Zone"]
    P --> S["Clock Format"]
    P --> T["Daylight Saving"]
    P --> U["Clock Display"]
    P --> V["Clock Location"]
    P --> W["Clock Reset"]

    I --> X["Remember Last Screen*1"]
    I --> Y["Memory Refresh"]
    I --> Z["Refresh Time Adjustment"]
    I --> AA["Skin Change"]
    I --> AB["Factory Data Reset"]

    K --> AC["Features"]

    style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style B fill:#ccf,stroke:#333
    style C fill:#cfc,stroke:#333
    style D fill:#fcc,stroke:#333
    style E fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
    style F fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
    style G fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
    style H fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
    style I fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
    style J fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
    style K fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
    style L fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style M fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style N fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style O fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style P fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style Q fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style R fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style S fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style T fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style U fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style V fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style W fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style X fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style Y fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style Z fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style AA fill:#ccc,stroke:#333
    style AB fill:#ccc,stroke:#333

Continued

Honda Jazz (2018) - >>How to customize - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Features"] --> B["Audio"]
    B --> C["Sound"]
    C --> D["BASS"]
    C --> E["TREBLE"]
    C --> F["FADER"]
    C --> G["BALANCE"]
    C --> H["Speed Volume Compensation"]
    B --> I["Source Popup"]
    I --> J["[Your selected media"] Cover Art*1]
    B --> K["Display Adjustment*1"]
    K --> L["Display Brightness"]
    L --> M["Contrast"]
    L --> N["Black Level"]
    K --> O["Colour"]
    O --> P["Colour"]
    O --> Q["Tint"]
    B --> R["Aspect Adjustment*1"]
    R --> S["Connect Audio"]
    R --> T["Bluetooth Device List*1"]
    B --> U["RDS Settings*1"]
    U --> V["TA-Information"]
    U --> W["News"]
    U --> X["REG"]
    U --> Y["AF"]
    B --> Z["DAB Settings*"]
    B --> AA["Default"]

*1: May change depending on your currently selected source.

Honda Jazz (2018) - >>How to customize - 3

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Info"] --> B["Clock Clock/Wallp"]
    B --> C["Type Clock"]
    C --> D["Wallpaper"]
    B --> E["Clock Adjustment"]
    B --> F["Time Zone"]
    B --> G["Clock Format"]
    B --> H["Daylight Saving"]
    B --> I["Clock Reset"]
    B --> J["Clock Display"]
    B --> K["Clock Location"]
    B --> L["Other Info Screen"]
    L --> M["None"]
    A --> N["Default"]

Honda Jazz (2018) - >>How to customize - 4

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Phone"] --> B["Default"]
    A --> C["Connect Phone"]
    A --> D["Bluetooth Device List"]
    A --> E["Edit Speed Dial"]
    A --> F["Ring Tone"]
    A --> G["Automatic Phone Sync"]
    H["Camera"] --> I["Rear Camera"]
    H --> J["Fixed Guideline"]
    H --> K["Dynamic Guideline"]
    H --> L["Default"]
    M["Bluetooth/Wi-Fi"] --> N["Bluetooth"]
    M --> O["Bluetooth On/Off Status"]
    M --> P["Bluetooth Device List"]
    M --> Q["Edit Pairing Code"]
    M --> R["Wi-Fi Wi-Fi On/Off"]
    R -.-> S["Wi-Fi Device List"]
    R --> T["Wi-Fi Device Information"]
    U["Default"] --> V["Wi-Fi Wi-Fi On/Off"]

Honda Jazz (2018) - >>How to customize - 5

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Android"] --> B["Wi-Fi"]
    A --> C["Bluetooth"]
    A --> D["Data usage"]
    A --> E["More..."]
    A --> F["Sound"]
    A --> G["Display"]
    A --> H["Storage"]
    A --> I["Apps"]
    A --> J["Account & sync"]
    A --> K["Location services"]
    A --> L["Security"]
    A --> M["Language & input"]
    A --> N["Backup & reset"]
    A --> O["Date & time"]
    A --> P["Accessibility"]
    A --> Q["About device"]

■List of customizable options

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
SystemHOMEHome icon position Changes the home screen icon layout. —
Menu Icon Position*3Changes the home screen icon layout.
DisplayBrightnessChanges the brightness of the audio/information screen.
ContrastChanges the contrast of the audio/information screen.
Black LevelChanges the black level of the audio/information screen.
Background Colour*2Changes the background colour of the audio/information screenBlue *1/Amber/Red/Violet
Sound/BeepVolumeChanges the sound volume.Adjusts the guidance volume of thenavigation system*.0~6 *1~11
BeepChanges the beep volume.OFF/1/2 *1/3
Voice Recog.Voice Prompt Turns the voice prompt on and off. On*1/Off

*1: Default Setting

*2: Does not appear when you change the screen interface design.

*3: Appears only when you change the screen interface design.

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
System ClockClock/ Wallpaper Type*2/ Clock Type*3Clock Changes the clock display type.Analog/Digital*1/Small Digital/Off
Wallpaper*2Changes the wallpaper type Imports an image file for a new wallpaper. Deletes an image file for a wallpaper.Wallpaper Setup P. 262Blank/Galaxy*1/Metallic
Clock AdjustmentAdjusts Clock.Clock P. 140
Time ZoneChanges the time zones.WET/GMT*1
Clock FormatSelects the digital clock display from 12H to 24H.12H*1/24H
Daylight SavingAdjusts the clock automatically when a summer time change occurs.On*1/Off
Clock DisplaySelects whether the clock display comes on.On*1/Off
Clock Location Changes the clock display layout.Right upper*1/Left upper/Right lower/Left lower/Off
Clock ResetResets the clock settings to the factory default.

*1: Default Setting

*2: Does not appear when you change the screen interface design.

*3: Appears only when you change the screen interface design.

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
SystemOthersLanguage Changes the display language.English (United Kingdom) ^1 :See other selectable languages on the screen.
Remember Last ScreenSelects whether the device remembers the last screen.
Memory RefreshTurns on the audio system automatically and restores the fragmentation of a memory when the ignition switch is LOCK 0^*2 .
Refresh Time AdjustmentSets the time for Memory Fresh.
Skin Change Changes the screen interface design. —
Factory Data ResetResets all the settings to their factory default. ➤ Defaulting All the Settings P. 338
DefaultCancels/Resets all customized items in the System group as default.Yes/No
AudioSoundAdjusts the settings of the audio speaker's sound ➤ Adjusting the Sound P. 274-6 ~ 0 ^*1 ~ +6 (BASS and TREBLE), RR9~0 ^*1 ~FR9 (FADER), L9~0 ^*1 ~R9 (BALANCE), Off/Low/Mid ^*1 /High (SVC)
Source PopupSelects whether the list of selectable audio sources comes on or not when Audio is selected on the home screen.On/Off ^*1

*1: Default Setting
*2: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
AudioCD, iPod, or USB mode[Your selected media]Cover ArtTurns on and off the cover art display. On ^1 /Off
USB, HDMITMmodeDisplay AdjustmentBrightnessSystem P. 328
Contrast
BlackLevel
ColourChanges the colour of the audio/information screen.
TintChanges the tint of the audio/information screen.
USB, HDMITMmodeAspect AdjustmentChanges the aspect ratio and zoom settings of the audio/information screen.Original (only USB) ^* /Normal/Full ^** /Zoom
Bluetooth®Audio modeConnect AudioConnects, disconnects or pairs a Bluetooth®Audio device to HFT.
Bluetooth®Audio modeBluetooth Device ListPairs a new phone to HFT, edits or deletes a paired phone.Phone Setup P. 368

*1: Default Setting
* Not available on all models

Continued

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
AudioRDS Settings*TA-InformationTurns on and off the traffic announcement function.On/Off*1
NewsTurns on and off the interruption news function.On/Off*1
REG Turns on and off the regional function. On*1/Off
AFTurns on and off the alternative frequency function.On*1/Off
DAB Settings*DAB-DAB LinkSelects whether the system automatically searches for the same station from Ensembles, and switches to it.On*1/Off
DAB-FM LinkSelects whether the system finds the same station from an FM band, and automatically switches the band.On*1/Off
Band selectSelects specific bands to reduce the time to update the lists, and search for a station.BOTH*/BAND III/L-BAND
DefaultCancels/Resets all customized items in the Audio group as default.Yes/No

*1: Default Setting

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
InfoClockClock/ Wallpaper type*2/ Clock Type*3ClockSystem P. 328
Clock Adjustment
Time Zone
Clock Format
Daylight Saving
Clock Reset
Clock Display
Clock Location
OtherInfo Screen PreferenceChanges the Info screen type.Info Top/Info Menu/Off*1
DefaultCancels/Resets all customized items in the Info group as default.Yes/No

*1: Default Setting
*2: Does not appear when you change the screen interface design.
*3: Appears only when you change the screen interface design.

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
PhoneConnect PhonePairs a new phone to HFT, connects or disconnects a paired phone. ➡Phone Setup P. 368
Bluetooth Device ListPairs a new phone to HFT, edits or deletes a paired phone. ➡Phone Setup P. 368
Edit Speed DialEdits, adds or deletes a speed dial entry. ➡Speed Dial P. 374
Ring ToneSelects the ring tone.Fixed/Mobile Phone^^1
Automatic Phone SyncSets a phonebook and call history data to be automatically imported when a phone is paired to HFT.On/Off
DefaultCancels/Resets all customized items in the Phone group as default.Yes/No

*1: Default Setting

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Camera*Rear CameraFixed GuidelineSelects whether the fixed guidelines come on on the rear camera monitor. ➕Multi-View Rear Camera * P. 469On*1/Off
Dynamic GuidelineSelects whether the dynamic guidelines come on on the rear camera monitor. ➕Multi-View Rear Camera * P. 469On*1/Off
DefaultCancels/Resets all customized items in the Rear Camera group as default.Yes/No
Bluetooth /Wi-FiBluetoothBluetooth On/Off StatusChanges the Bluetooth® status.On*1/Off
Bluetooth Device ListPairs a new phone to HFT, edits or deletes a paired phone, or creates a security PIN. ➕Phone Setup P. 368
Edit Pairing CodeEdits Pairing Code. ➕To change the pairing code setting P. 369Random/Fixed*1

*1: Default Setting

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
Bluetooth /Wi-FiWi-Fi On/Off Status Changes the Wi-Fi mode. On ^1/Off
Wi-Fi- Device ListConnects, disconnects, or deletes the Wi-Fi device.
Wi-Fi Device InformationShows the Wi-Fi information of the device. —
DefaultCancels/Resets all customized items in the Bluetooth/Wi-Fi group as default.Yes/No
AndroidWi-FiShows the status of the Wi-Fi connection (On/Off) and adds new Wi-Fi networks.On ^1/Off
BluetoothShows the status of the Bluetooth® connection (On/Off) and adds new Bluetooth® devices.On ^1/Off
Data usage Shows the data usage of the system. —
More... Adds VPN (Virtual Private Network). —
SoundAdjusts the alarm volume and selects the favorite sound.
DisplaySets up the wallpaper and changes the font size.

*1: Default Setting

Setup GroupCustomizable Features Description Selectable Settings
AndroidStorageShows the storage capacity of the system and the USB capacity.
Apps Shows the status of the installed apps. —
Account & syncAdds the additional account information.
Location servicesTurn on/off the GPS setting before using apps.
Security Shows the security status of the system. —
Language & inputChanges the display language of the system and the input keyboard.
Backup & reset Resets the system. —
Date & timeChanges the date, the time zones, and the clock format.
AccessibilityChanges the display font of the system and the voice guidance of the password.
About deviceShows the status of the system, the Android version, the legal information, and so on.

*1: Default Setting

Defaulting All the Settings

Reset all the menu and customized settings as the factory defaults.

System settings 12:34 This will restore the system settings, such as brightness, volume and routing preferences to their default values. All personal data will also be cleared. Please see the owner's manual for more details. Would you like to continue? Yes No

  1. Select HOME
  2. Select Settings.
  3. Select System.
  4. Select the Others tab.
  5. Select Factory Data Reset.
    The confirmation message will appear.
  6. Select Yes to reset the settings.
  7. Select Yes again to reset the settings.
    The confirmation message will appear. Select OK.
    ▶ After selecting OK, the system will reboot.
  8. The confirmation message will appear. Select OK.
  9. After selecting OK, the system will reboot.

Defaulting All the Settings

When you transfer the vehicle to a third party, reset all settings to default and delete all personal data.

The following settings will be reset:

• Audio preset settings

- Phonebook entries

- Other display and personal settings.

- Audio preset settings - Phonebook entries - Other display and personal settings.

Hands-Free Telephone System

Models with colour audio system

The Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) System allows you to place and receive phone calls using your vehicle's audio system, without handling your mobile phone.

Using HFT

HFT Buttons
Volume up Volume down (Hang-up) Button (Pick-up) Button Microphone (Phone) Button Selector Knob 12:34

Continued

Hands-Free Telephone System

Place your phone where you can get good reception. To use HFT, you need a Bluetooth-compatible mobile phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing procedures, and special feature capabilities, ask a dealer or your local Honda.

Voice control tips

  • Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the windows, as noise coming from them may interfere with the microphone.
  • To change the volume level, use the audio system's volume knob or the remote audio controls on the steering wheel.

If you receive a call while using the audio system, the system resumes its operation after ending the call.

Up to 20 speed dial entries can be stored. If there is no entry in the system, Speed dial is disabled.

Speed Dial P. 355

Up to 20 call histories can be stored. If there is no call history, Call history is disabled.

▶▶ Hands-Free Telephone System▶ Using HFT

☐ (Phone) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen.
Selector knob: Rotate to select an item on the screen, then press.
(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen or to answer an incoming call.
(Hang-up) button: Press to end a call.

HFT Status Display

Battery Level Status Signal Strength Roam Status Bluetooth Indicator Appears when your phone is connected to HFT. HFT Mode Call Name Incoming call 12:34 John Answer Ignore

The audio/information screen notifies you when there is an incoming call.

Limitations for Manual Operation

Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion. You cannot select a greyed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.

Hands-Free Telephone System

Bluetooth® Wireless Technology

The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under licence. Other trademarks and trade names are those of their respective owners.

HFT Limitations

An incoming call on HFT will interrupt the audio system when it is playing. It will resume when the call is ended.

See the following URLs for Declaration of conformity (DoC) of Hands Free Telephone: http://www.ptc.panasonic.eu/

HFT Status Display

The information that appears on the audio/information screen varies between phone models.

You can change the system language.

Customized Features P. 313

HFT Menus

The ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY I or ON II to use the system.

Honda Jazz (2018) - HFT Menus - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Phone"] --> B["Speed dial*1"]
    B --> C["Add new"]
    C --> D["Call history"]
    D --> E["Phonebook"]
    E --> F["Phone number"]
    C --> G["(Existing entry list)"]
    G --> H["Call history*1"]
    H --> I["Dialed calls"]
    I --> J["Received calls"]
    J --> K["Missed calls"]
    K --> L["Phonebook*1"]
    L --> M["Dial*1"]
    M --> N["Enter a phone number to dial."]

HFT Menus

To use HFT, you must first pair your Bluetooth-compatible mobile phone to the system while the vehicle is parked.

Some functions are limited while driving. A message appears on the screen when the vehicle is moving and the operation is canceled.

Select a phone number from the call history to store as a speed dial number.

Select a phone number from the phonebook to store as a speed dial number.

Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial number.

*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to the system.

Honda Jazz (2018) - HFT Menus - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Redial*1"] --> B["Redial the last number dialed in the phone's history."]
    B --> C["Bluetooth setup"]
    C --> D["Phone set"]
    D --> E["Add new device"]
    E --> F["Connect a phone"]
    F --> G["Connect an audio device"]
    G --> H["Disconnect all device"]
    H --> I["Delete device"]
    I --> J["Pass-key Create a code for a paired phone."]
    E --> K["Pair a phone to the system."]
    K --> L["Connect a phone to the system."]
    L --> M["Connect a Bluetooth® Audio device to the system."]
    M --> N["Disconnect a paired phone from the system."]
    N --> O["Delete a previously paired phone."]

*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to the system.

*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to the system.

Honda Jazz (2018) - HFT Menus - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Speed dial*1"] --> B["Call history"]
    B --> C["Phonebook"]
    C --> D["Phone number"]
    D --> E["Change speed dial"]
    E --> F["Delete speed dial"]
    B --> G["Add New"]
    G --> H["Select a phone number from the call history to store as a speed dial number."]
    C --> I["Select a phone number from the phonebook to store as a speed dial number."]
    D --> J["Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial number."]
    E --> K["Change a previously stored speed dial number."]
    F --> L["Delete a previously stored speed dial number."]

Honda Jazz (2018) - HFT Menus - 3

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Ringtone"] --> B["Fixed"]
    B --> C["Mobile phone"]
    C --> D["Caller ID info"]
    D --> E["Number priority"]
    E --> F["Prioritize the caller's phone number as the caller ID."]
    F --> G["System clear"]
    style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style B fill:#ccf,stroke:#333
    style C fill:#cfc,stroke:#333
    style D fill:#fcc,stroke:#333
    style E fill:#cff,stroke:#333
    style F fill:#ffc,stroke:#333
    style G fill:#cfc,stroke:#333

Phone Setup

Honda Jazz (2018) - Phone Setup - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Confirmation\nWould you like to add a new phone now?"] --> B{No\nYes}
    B --> C["12:34\nSelect a phone\nPHONE#1\nPhone not found?"]
    C --> D["12:34\nPHONE#1\nEnter the pairing code "0000" into your phone."]

■To pair a mobile phone (No phone has been paired to the system)

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔊 to select Yes, then press 😊.
  3. Make sure your phone is in search or discoverable mode, then press 😊
    HFT automatically searches for a Bluetooth® device.

  4. When your phone appears on the list, select it by pressing 😊

If your phone doesn't appear, select Phone not found? and search for Bluetooth® devices using your phone. From your phone, select Honda HFT.

  1. The system gives you a pairing code on the audio/information screen.

▶ Confirm if the pairing code on the screen and your phone match. This may vary by phone.

  1. A notification appears on the screen if pairing is successful.

Phone Setup

Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to the system before you can make and receive hands-free calls.

Phone Pairing Tips:

  • You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is moving.
  • Up to six phones can be paired.
  • Your phone's battery may drain faster when it is connected to the system.
  • If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found by the system within three minutes, the system will time out and returns to idle.

Once you have paired a phone, you can see it displayed on the screen with one or two icons on the right side.

These icons indicate the following:

: The phone can be used with HFT.
: The phone is compatible with Bluetooth® Audio.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Phone Pairing Tips: - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Phone setup"] --> B["Bluetooth setup"]
    B --> C["Speed dial"]
    D["Bluetooth setup"] --> E["Add new device"]
    E --> F["Connect a phone"]
    G["Select a phone"] --> H["PHONE#2"]
    H --> I["2 (Add new)"]
    I --> J["Phone not found?"]

■To pair a mobile phone (when a phone has already been paired to the system)

  1. Press the button or the button.
    ▶ If a prompt appears asking to connect to a phone, select No and proceed with step 2.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Phone setup, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Bluetooth setup, then press 🔺.
  4. Rotate 🔒 to select Add New device, then press 🔒.
    The screen changes to device list.

  5. Rotate 🔒 to select Add new, then press 🔒.

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To pair a mobile phone (when a phone has already been paired to the system) - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Confirmation"] --> B["Turn on your phone's Bluetooth setting, and put it in discoverable mode."]
    B --> C{OK}
    C --> D["12:34"]
    D --> E["Select a phone"]
    E --> F["PHONE#2"]
    E --> G["PHONE#6"]
    E --> H["Phone not found?"]
    H --> I["12:34"]
    I --> J["PHONE#2"]
    J --> K["Enter the pairing code "0000" into your phone."]
  1. Make sure your phone is in search or discoverable mode, then press 😊

HFT automatically searches for a Bluetooth® device.

  1. When your phone appears on the list, select it by pressing 😊

If your phone does not appear, select Phone not found? and search for Bluetooth® devices using your phone. From your phone, select Honda HFT.

  1. The system gives you a pairing code on the audio display.

▶ Confirm if the pairing code on the screen and your phone match. This may vary by phone.

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To pair a mobile phone (when a phone has already been paired to the system) - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Phone setup 12:34"] --> B["Bluetooth setup"]
    B --> C["Add new device"]
    C --> D["Connect a phone"]
    D --> E["Connect an audio device"]
    E --> F["Select a phone"]
    F --> G["BBBB"]
    G --> H["Phone not found?"]

■To Change the currently paired phone

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Phone setup, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔒 to select Bluetooth setup, then press 🔒.

  4. Rotate 🔺 to select Connect a phone, then press 🔺

The screen changes to a device list.

  1. Rotate to select a desired device name, then press

The system disconnects the connected phone and starts searching for another paired phone.

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To Change the currently paired phone - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Phone setup 12:34"] --> B["Bluetooth setup"]
    B --> C["Speed dial"]
    D["Bluetooth setup 12:34"] --> E["Delete device"]
    E --> F["Pass-key"]
    G["Pass-key 12:34"] --> H["000"]
    H --> I["12:34"]

■To change the pairing code setting

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Phone setup, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔒 to select Bluetooth setup, then press 🔒.
  4. Rotate 🔺 to select Pass-key, then press 🔺.
  5. Input a new pairing code, then press 🌿

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To change the pairing code setting - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Bluetooth setup"] --> B["Disconnect all devices\nDelete device\nPass-key"]
    B --> C["12:34\nDelete device\n1 PHONE#3\n2 PHONE#4\n3 PHONE#5"]
    C --> D["12:34\nConfirmation\nWould you like to delete\n"PHONE#4"?\nNo\nYes"]

■To delete a paired phone

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 📞 to select Phone setup, then
    press
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Bluetooth setup, then
    press 📋.

  4. Rotate 🔺 to select Delete device, then

press

The screen changes to a device list.

  1. Rotate to select a phone you want to

delete, then press 😊

  1. A confirmation message appears on the

screen. Rotate to select Yes, then press

Ring Tone

You can change the ring tone setting.

RM 12:34 Ringtone Fixed Mobile phone

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔒 to select Phone setup, then press 🔒.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Ringtone, then press 🔺.
  4. Rotate 🔗 to select Fixed or Mobile phone, then press 😊

Caller's ID Information

You can select a caller's information to be displayed when you have an incoming call.

12:34 Caller ID info Name priority Number priority

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Phone setup, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔗 to select Caller ID info, then press 🔘.
  4. Rotate to select a mode you want, then press 😊.

>>Ring Tone

Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speakers.

Mobile phone: For certain connected phones, the ring tone stored in the phone sounds from the speakers.

»Caller's ID Information

Name priority: A caller's name is displayed if it is stored in the phonebook.

Number priority: A caller's phone number is displayed.

To Clear the System

Pairing codes, paired phones, all speed dial entries, all call history data, and all imported phonebook data are erased.

Honda Jazz (2018) - To Clear the System - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Confirmation\nWould you like to clear all information stored in the Hands-Free system?"] --> B["System clear\nAll information will be cleared. Would you like to proceed?"]
    B --> C["System clear\nThe Hands-Free system has been cleared."]
  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔒 to select Phone setup, then press 🔒.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select System clear, then press 🔺.
  4. Rotate 🔒 to select Yes, then press 😊.

  5. A confirmation message appears on the screen. Rotate to select Yes, then press 😊.

  6. A confirmation appears on the screen. Press 😊.

Automatic Import of Mobile Phonebook and Call History

When your phone is paired, the contents of its phonebook and call history are automatically imported to the system.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Automatic Import of Mobile Phonebook and Call History - 1

Automatic Import of Mobile Phonebook and Call History

When you select a person from the list in the mobile phonebook, you can see up to three category icons. The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored for that name.

Pref Home Mobile Work Pager Fax Car Other

If a name has four or more numbers, ... appears instead of category icons.

On some phones, it may not be possible to import the category icons to the system.

The phonebook is updated after every connection. Call history is updated after every connection or call.

Speed Dial

Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.

Speed dial 1 Home 2 (Add new) 3 (Add new) 12:34 Add new Call history Phonebook

To store a speed dial number:

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔒 to select Speed dial, then press 🔒.
  3. Rotate 🔒 to select Add new, then press 🔒.
  4. Rotate to select a place to choose a number from, then press From Call history:

▶Select a number from the call history.

From Phonebook:

Select a number from the connected cell phone's imported phonebook.
From Phone number:
▶ Input the number manually.

>>Speed Dial

You can use the audio preset buttons during a call to store a speed dial number:

  1. Press and hold the desired audio preset button during a call.
  2. The contact information for the active call will be stored for the corresponding speed dial.

Continued

1 Home 12:34 Change speed dial Delete speed dial

■To edit a speed dial

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Phone setup, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Speed dial, then press 🔺.
  4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
  5. Rotate 🔒 to select Change speed dial, then press 🔒
  6. Select a new speed dial number, then press ⚙.

1 Home 12:34 Change speed dial Delete speed dial

■To delete a speed dial number

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Phone setup, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Speed dial, then press 🔺.
  4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
  5. Rotate 🔒 to select Delete speed dial, then press 😊
    ▶ A confirmation message appears on the screen. Rotate to select Yes, then press 🔒.

Making a Call

You can make calls by inputting any phone number, or by using the imported phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or redial.

12:34 Phone Speed dial Call history Phonebook

Making a Call

The maximum range between your phone and vehicles is 10 metres (30 feet).

Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of the person you are calling through the audio speakers.

Continued

Phonebook Jane John Mat 12:34 12:34 11111### 222222### 333333###

■To make a call using the imported phonebook

When your phone is paired, the contents of its phonebook are automatically imported to the system.

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 📋 to select Phonebook, then press 😊.
  3. The phonebook is stored alphabetically. Rotate to select the initial, then press 🤔.
  4. Rotate to select a name, then press.
  5. Rotate to select a number, then press 🌿.
    ▶Dialing starts automatically.

To make a call using the imported phonebook

This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.

12:34 Dial 012345### ABC

■To make a call using a phone number

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Dial, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate to select a number, then press ⚙.
  4. Rotate to select, then press. ▶Dialing starts automatically.

To make a call using a phone number

This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.

12:34 Redialing... ((,,) 3 John Hang up Mule

■To make a call using redial

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔒 to select Redial, then press 😊.
    ▶Dialing starts automatically.

To make a call using redial

Press and hold the button to redial the last number dialed in your phone's call history.

12:34 Call history Dialed calls Received calls Missed calls

■To make a call using the call history

Call history is stored by Dialed calls, Received calls, and Missed calls.

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔺 to select Call history, then press 🔺.
  3. Rotate 🔺 to select Dialed calls, Received calls, or Missed calls, then press 🔺.
  4. Rotate to select a number, then press
    ▶Dialing starts automatically.

To make a call using the call history

The call history appears only when a phone is connected to the system, and displays the last 20 dialed, received, or missed calls.

Continued

Speed dial 14 John 15 (Add new) 16 (Add new) 12:34

■To make a call using a speed dial entry

  1. Press the button or the button.
  2. Rotate 🔒 to select Speed dial, then press

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To make a call using a speed dial entry - 1

  1. Rotate to select a number, then press

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■To make a call using a speed dial entry - 2

▶Dialing starts automatically.

To make a call using a speed dial entry

On the Phone screen, the first six speed dials on the list can be directly selected by pressing the corresponding audio preset buttons (1-6).

Receiving a Call
HFT Mode Incoming call 12:34 ( ) John 3 Answer Ignore Caller's Name

When there is an incoming call, an audible notification sounds and the Incoming call screen appears.

Press the button to answer the call. Press the button to decline or end the call.

>>Receiving a Call

Call Waiting

Press the ☐ button to put the current call on hold to answer the incoming call.

Press the button again to return to the current call.

Select Ignore to ignore the incoming call if you do not want to answer it.

Press the 📄 button if you want to hang up the current call.

You can select the icons on the audio/information screen instead of the 📄 and buttons. Rotate 🔗 to select the icon, then press 😊

Options During a Call

The following options are available during a call.

Swap call: Put the current call on hold to answer the incoming call.

Mute: Mute your voice.

Transfer call: Transfer a call from the system to your phone.

Dial tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menu-driven phone system.

12:34 In call 0°50" (<<) John 3 Hang up Mute 12:34 Mute 0°50" (<<) John 1 Mute Transfer call

  1. To view the available options, press the button.

  2. Rotate to select the option, then press ⚙.

The check box is checked when Mute is selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.

Options During a Call

Dial tones: Available on some phones.

Hands-Free Telephone System

Models with display audio system

The Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) System allows you to place and receive phone calls using your vehicle's audio system, without handling your mobile phone.

Using HFT

HFT Buttons

(MENU) Button Volume down Volume up SOURCE Button / Buttons Microphone (Talk) Button (Hang-up/Back) Button (Pick-up) Button (Home) Icon (Menu) Icon

(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen, or to answer an incoming call.
(Hang-up/Back) button: Press to end a call, go back to the previous command, or cancel a command.

Hands-Free Telephone System

Place your phone where you can get good reception. To use HFT, you need a Bluetooth-compatible mobile phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing procedures, and special feature capabilities, ask a dealer or your local Honda.

To use the system, the Bluetooth On/Off Status setting must be On.

→Customized Features P. 313

Voice control tips

  • Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the windows, as noise coming from them may interfere with the microphone.
  • Press and release the button when you want to call a number using a stored voice tag. Speak clearly and naturally after a beep.
  • If the microphone picks up voices other than yours, the command may be misinterpreted.
  • To change the volume level, select the audio system's VOL (Volume) or use the remote audio controls on the steering wheel.

Up to six speed dial entries can be displayed among a total of 20 that can be entered. If there is no entries in the system, Speed Dial is disabled.

→Speed Dial P. 374

Up to six call histories can be displayed. If there is no call histories, Call History is disabled.

(£) (Talk) button: Press to call a number with a stored voice tag.

(Menu) button: Press to display Speed Dial, Call History, or Redial on the Phone screen.

/ ▶ button: Press to select an item displayed on the Phone screen.

SOURCE button: Press to call a number listed in the selected item on the Phone screen.

To go to the Phone Menu screen:

  1. Select HOME.
  2. Select Phone to switch the display to the Phone screen.
  3. Select MENU

HFT Status Display

The audio/information screen notifies you when there is an incoming call.

Bluetooth Indicator Comes on when your phone is connected to HFT. HFT Mode Battery Level Status Signal Strength In coming call 12:34 12 AAAAA 08012345678 Answer Ignore Caller's Name Caller's Number

Continued

Hands-Free Telephone System

Bluetooth® Wireless Technology

The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under licence. Other trademarks and trade names are those of their respective owners.

HFT Limitations

An incoming call on HFT will interrupt the audio system when it is playing. It will resume when the call is ended.

HFT Status Display

The information that appears on the audio/information screen varies between phone models.

You can change the system language.

Customized Features P. 313

Limitations for Manual Operation

Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion. You cannot select a greyed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.

Only previously stored speed dial entries with voice tags, phonebook names, or numbers can be called using voice commands while the vehicle is in motion.

→Speed Dial P. 374

HFT Menus

The ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY Ⅰ or ON Ⅱ*1 to use the system.

■Phone settings screen
Phone settings 12:34 Connect Phone Bluetooth Device List Edit Speed Dial Ring Tone Automatic Phone Sync On Default On

  1. Select HOME
  2. Select Settings.
  3. Select Phone.

HFT Menus

To use HFT, you must first pair your Bluetooth-compatible mobile phone to the system while the vehicle is parked.

Some functions are limited while driving.

Honda Jazz (2018) - HFT Menus - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Connect Phone Add Bluetooth Device"] --> B["(Existing entry list)*2"]
    A --> C["Disconnect"]
    B --> D["Edit Device Name"]
    B --> E["Delete This Device"]
    F["Bluetooth Device List"] --> G["(Existing entry list)*2"]
    F --> H["Add Bluetooth Device"]
    G --> I["Edit a previously paired phone name."]
    G --> J["Delete a previously paired phone."]
    H --> K["Pair a phone to the system."]
    style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style F fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style G fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style H fill:#f9f,stroke:#333

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
*2: Appears only when a phone is connected to the system.

Continued

Honda Jazz (2018) - HFT Menus - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Edit Speed Dial New Entry"] --> B["Manual Input"]
    B --> C["Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial number."]
    B --> D["Import from Call History"]
    D --> E["Select a phone number from the call history to store as a speed dial number."]
    D --> F["Import from Phonebook"]
    F --> G["Select a phone number from the phonebook to store as a speed dial number."]
    A --> H["(Existing entry list)*"]
    H --> I["Edit Edit a previously stored speed dial number."]
    I --> J["Change a name."]
    I --> K["Change a number."]
    I --> L["Create or delete a voice tag."]
    H --> M["Delete"]
    M --> N["Delete all of the previously stored speed dial number."]
    A --> O["Delete All"]
    O --> P["Delete all of the previously stored speed dial number."]
    A --> Q["Ring Tone"]
    Q --> R["Select the ring tone."]
    A --> S["Automatic Phone Sync"]
    S --> T["Set phonebook and call history data to be automatically imported when a phone is paired to HFT."]
    A --> U["Default"]
    U --> V["Cancel/Reset all customized items in the Phone Settings group as default."]

*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to the system.

■Phone menu screen
Phone Menu 07a 12:34 Speed Dial Phonebook Redial Dial Call History

  1. Press 📄, or select 📋, then select Phone.
  2. Press (MENU) on the steering wheel, or select .

Honda Jazz (2018) - HFT Menus - 4

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Speed Dial"] --> B["New Entry"]
    B --> C["Manual Input"]
    C --> D["Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial number."]
    B --> E["(Existing entry list)^(1)"]
    E --> F["(Existing entry list)^(1)"]
    F --> G["Dial the selected number in the speed dial list."]
    H["Phonebook"] --> I["Display the paired phone's phonebook."]
    J["Redial"] --> K["Redial the last number dialed in the phone's history."]
    L["Dial"] --> M["Enter a phone number to dial."]
    N["Call History"] --> O["All Display the last 20 outgoing, incoming and missed calls."]
    O --> P["Dialed"]
    O --> Q["Received"]
    O --> R["Missed"]
    P --> S["Display the last 20 outgoing calls."]
    Q --> T["Display the last 20 incoming calls."]
    R --> U["Display the last 20 missed calls."]

*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to the system.

Phone Setup

No phone connected No phone is paired to the system. Would you like to add a phone now? Yes No Add Bluetooth device 12:34 Refresh AAAAA Phone not found Add Bluetooth device 12:34 Please compare the number "000000" with the number on your device. Cancel OK

■To pair a mobile phone (when there is no phone paired to the system)

  1. Select Phone.
  2. Select Yes.
  3. Make sure your phone is in search or discoverable mode, then select Continue.

▶HFT automatically searches for a Bluetooth device.

  1. Select your phone when it appears on the list.

▶If your phone does not appear, you can select Refresh to search again.
If your phone still does not appear, select Phone not found and search for Bluetooth devices using your phone. From your phone, search for Honda HFT.

  1. The system gives you a pairing code on the audio/information screen.

▶ Confirm if the pairing code on the screen and your phone match. This may vary by phone.

Phone Setup

Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to the system before you can make and receive hands-free calls.

Phone Pairing Tips:

  • You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is moving.
  • Up to six phones can be paired.
  • Your phone's battery may drain faster when it is paired to the system.
  • If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found by the system, the system will return to the previous screen.

Phone settings 12:34 Connect Phone Bluetooth Device List Edit Speed Dial Ring Tone Automatic Phone Sync On Default OK

■To change the currently paired phone

  1. Go to the phone settings screen.
    Phone settings screen P. 365
  2. Select Connect Phone.
  3. Select a phone to connect.
    ▶HFT disconnects the current phone and starts searching for another paired phone.

To change the currently paired phone

If no other phones are found or paired when trying to switch to another phone, HFT will inform you that the original phone is connected again.

To pair other phones, select Add Bluetooth Device from the Connect Phone screen.

Bluetooth/Wi-Fi settings 12:34 Bluetooth Wi-Fi Bluetooth On/Off Status On Bluetooth Device List Edit Pairing Code Wi-Fi On/Off Status On Wi-Fi Device List Default OK Edit pairing code 12:34 Random Fixed

■To change the pairing code setting

  1. Select HOME.
  2. Select Settings.
  3. Select Bluetooth/Wi-Fi.
  4. Select Bluetooth tab.
  5. Select Edit Pairing Code.
  6. Select Fixed or Random.

To change the pairing code setting

The default pairing code is 0000 until you change the setting. To create your own, select Fixed, and delete the current code, then enter a new one.

For a randomly generated pairing code each time you pair a phone, select Random.

Honda Jazz (2018) - To change the pairing code setting - 1

Phone settings 12-34 Connect Phone Bluetooth Device List Edit Speed Dial Ring Tone Automatic Phone Sync On Default OK Edit Bluetooth device 12-34 Edit Device Name Delete This Device

■To edit an already-paired phone name

  1. Go to the phone settings screen.
    Phone settings screen P. 365
  2. Select Bluetooth Device List
  3. Select a paired phone you want to edit.

  4. Select Edit Device Name.

  5. Edit the name and select OK.
  6. A notification appears if the change is successful.

Phone settings 12:34 Connect Phone Bluetooth Device List Edit Speed Dial Ring Tone Automatic Phone Sync On Default OK Edit Bluetooth device 12:34 Edit Device Name Delete This Device

■To delete a paired phone

  1. Go to the phone settings screen.
    Phone settings screen P. 365
  2. Select Bluetooth Device List.
  3. Select a phone you want to delete.

  4. Select Delete This Device.

  5. You will receive a confirmation message on the screen. Select Yes.

  6. A notification appears if the deletion is successful.

Ring Tone

You can change the ring tone setting.

Phone settings 12:34 Fixed Mobile phone

  1. Go to the phone settings screen.
    Phone settings screen P. 365
  2. Select Ring Tone.
  3. Select Fixed or Mobile Phone.

>>Ring Tone

Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speaker.

Mobile Phone: For certain connected phones, the ring tone stored in the phone sounds from the speakers.

Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History

Phonebook 0:34 12:34 MMMMM Search

■When Automatic Phone Sync is set to On:

When your phone is paired, the contents of its phonebook and call history are automatically imported to the system.

■Changing the Automatic Phone Sync setting

  1. Go to the phone settings screen. Phone settings screen P. 365

  2. Select Automatic Phone Sync.

  3. Select On or Off.

Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History

When you select a person from the list in the cellular phonebook, you can see up to three category icons. The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored for that name.

Pref Home Mobile Work Pager Fax Car Other Voice

On some phones, it may not be possible to import the category icons to the system.

The phonebook is updated after every connection. Call history is updated after every connection or call.

Speed Dial

Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Speed Dial - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Speed dial"] --> B["New entry"]
    B --> C["Manual Input Import from Phonebook<br>Import from Call History"]
    C --> D["Store voice tag"]

To store a speed dial number:

  1. Go to the phone menu screen. Phone menu screen P. 367
  2. Select Speed Dial.
  3. Select New Entry
  4. Select a place to choose a number. From Import from Call History:

▶Select a number from the call history.
From Manual Input:
▶ Input the number manually.
From Import from Phonebook:
Select a number from the connected mobile phone's imported phonebook.

  1. When the speed dial is successfully stored, you are asked to create a voice tag for the number. Select Yes or No.

  2. Select Record to store a voice tag for the speed dial entry.

▶ Using the button, follow the prompts to store a voice tag for the speed dial entry.

>>Speed Dial

When a voice tag is stored, press the button to call the number using the voice tag. Say the voice tag name.

Edit speed dial 12:34 AAAAA Add List Show List Show List Add List Edit Delete Edit speed dial 12:34 Name Phone No. Voice Tag Play Record Clear

Edit speed dial 12:34 Name Show No. Voice Tag Play Record Clear

■To add a voice tag to a stored speed dial number

  1. Go to the phone settings screen.
    Phone settings screen P. 365
  2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
  3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
    ▶ From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
  4. Select Voice Tag
    ▶ From the pop-up menu, select Record.
  5. Select Record to store the voice tag.
  6. Using the button, follow the prompts to complete the voice tag.

■To delete a voice tag

  1. Go to the phone settings screen.
    Phone settings screen P. 365
  2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
  3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
    ▶ From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
  4. Select Voice Tag
    ▶ From the pop-up menu, select Clear.
  5. A confirmation message appears on the screen. Select Yes.

>>Speed Dial

Avoid using duplicate voice tags.

Avoid using "home" as a voice tag.

It is easier for the system to recognize a longer name.

For example, use "John Smith" instead of "John."

Edit speed dial 12:34 AAAAA Edit Delete

■To edit a speed dial

  1. Go to the phone settings screen. Phone settings screen P. 365
  2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
  3. Select an existing speed dial entry. ▶ From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
  4. Select a setting you want.

■To delete a speed dial

  1. Go to the phone settings screen. Phone settings screen P. 365
  2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
  3. Select an existing speed dial entry. ▶ From the pop-up menu, select Delete.
  4. A confirmation message appears on the screen. Select Yes.

Making a Call

Phone Menu 12:34 Speed Dial Phonebook Redial Dial Call History

You can make calls by inputting any phone number, or by using the imported phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or redial.

Making a Call

Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by voice from most screens. Press the 📄 button and say the voice tag name.

Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of the person you are calling through the audio speakers.

Phonebook 12:34 MMMMM Search Search by keyword 12:34

■To make a call using the imported phonebook

  1. Go to the phone menu screen.
    Phone menu screen P. 367
  2. Select PhoneBook.
  3. Select a name.
    ▶You can also search by letter. Select Search.
    ▶ Use the keyboard on the touch screen for entering letters.
  4. Select a number.
    ▶Dialing starts automatically.

To make a call using the imported phonebook

This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving. However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed dial number using voice commands.

Limitations for Manual Operation P. 364
Speed Dial P. 374

Dialing 1 2 ABC 3 DEF - 4 GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO . 7 PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ * # 0+ .... Done

■To make a call using a phone number

  1. Go to the phone menu screen.
    Phone menu screen P. 367
  2. Select Dial.
  3. Select a number.

▶ Use the keyboard on the touch screen for entering numbers.

  1. Select Done.
    ▶Dialing starts automatically.

To make a call using a phone number

This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving. However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed dial number using voice commands.

Limitations for Manual Operation P. 364
→Speed Dial P. 374

Continued

Phone Menu 01/ 12:34 Speed Dial Phonebook Redial Dial Call History

■To make a call using redial

  1. Go to the phone menu screen. Phone menu screen P. 367
  2. Select Redial. ▶Dialing starts automatically.

To make a call using redial

Press and hold the 📄 button to redial the last number dialed in your phone's history.

Call History 04 12:34 Alt Dated Received Missed AAAA 09.16 10:22 AM BBBBB 09.16 10:21 AM CCCCC 09.16 9:42 AM DDDDD 09.10 4:28 PM EEEE 09.10 2:23 PM FFFFF 09.10 2:12 PM

■To make a call using the call history Call history is stored by All, Dialed, Received, and Missed.

  1. Go to the phone menu screen. Phone menu screen P. 367
  2. Select Call History.
  3. Select All, Dialed, Received, or Missed.
  4. Select a number.

▶Dialing starts automatically.

To make a call using the call history

The call history displays the last 20 dialed, received, or missed calls. (Appears only when a phone is connected to the system.)

Speed dial 074 12:34 AAAA 08012345678

■To make a call using a speed dial entry

  1. Go to the phone menu screen. Phone menu screen P. 367
  2. Select Speed Dial.
  3. Select a number. ▶Dialing starts automatically.

To make a call using a speed dial entry

When a voice tag is stored, press the 📋 button to call the number using the voice tag. ▶Speed Dial P. 374

Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by voice from any screen. Press the button and follow the prompts.

Receiving a Call

In coming call 0 0:37Cal 12:34 =12 AAAAA 08012345678 Answer Ignore

When there is an incoming call, an audible notification sounds and the Incoming call screen appears.

Press the button to answer the call. Press the button to decline or end the call.

Options During a Call

The following options are available during a call.

Mute: Mute your voice.

The mute icon appears when Mute is selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.

Transfer: Transfer a call from the system to your phone.

Touch Tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menu-driven phone system.

Mute Icon In Call 12:34 AAAAA 08012345678 09'04" Transfer Touch Tones Mute Hang Up

The available options are shown on the lower half of the screen.

Select the option.

The mute icon appears when Mute is selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.

>>Receiving a Call

Call Waiting

Press the button to put the current call on hold to answer the incoming call.

Press the 📄 button again to return to the current call.

Select Ignore to ignore the incoming call if you do not want to answer it.

Press the button if you want to hang up the current call.

You can select the icons on the touch screen instead of the and buttons.

>>Options During a Call

Touch Tones: Available on some phones.

You can select the icons on the touch screen.

Driving

This chapter discusses driving and refueling.

Before Driving 382

Towing a Trailer 386

When Driving

Models without keyless access system

Starting the Engine 392

Models with keyless access system

Starting the Engine 395

Precautions While Driving.... 399

Continuously Variable Transmission * ..... 401

Continuously variable transmission models

Shifting 402

Manual transmission models

Shifting 407

Continuously variable transmission models

Auto Idle Stop 410

Manual transmission models

Auto Idle Stop 415

Cruise Control 420

Adjustable Speed Limiter 423

Intelligent Speed Limiter 427

Forward Collision Warning* 434

Lane Departure Warning* 438

Traffic Sign Recognition System* ...... 442

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System...... 446

Agile Handling Assist 448

Deflation Warning System 449

Adjusting Headlight Distribution ..... 451

Braking

Brake System...... 453

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) 455

Brake Assist System 456

City-Brake Active system....457

Emergency Stop Signal 462

Parking Your Vehicle

When Stopped 463

Parking Sensor System ^* 464

Multi-View Rear Camera

About Your Multi-View Rear Camera....469

Refueling

Fuel Information....471

How to Refuel 472

Fuel Economy and CO₂ Emissions

Improving Fuel Economy and Reducing CO_2

Emissions....473

Before Driving

Driving Preparation

Check the following items before you start driving.

Exterior Checks

  • Make sure there are no obstructions on the windows, door mirrors, exterior lights, or other parts of the vehicle.
    ▶Remove any frost, snow, or ice.
    Remove any snow on the roof, as this can slip down and obstruct your field of vision while driving. If frozen solid, remove ice once it has softened.
    When removing ice from around the wheels, be sure not to damage the wheel or wheel components.
  • Make sure the bonnet is securely closed.
    ▶If the bonnet opens while driving, your front view will be blocked.
  • Make sure the tyres are in good condition.
    ▶ Check air pressures and check for damage and excessive wear.
    → Checking and Maintaining Tyres P. 515
    • Make sure there are no people or objects behind or around the vehicle.
    There are blind spots from the inside.

Exterior Checks

NOTICE

When doors are frozen shut, use warm water around the door edges to melt any ice. Do not try to force them open, as this can damage the rubber trim around the doors. When done, wipe dry to avoid further freezing.

Do not pour warm water into the key cylinder. You will be unable to insert the key if the water freezes in the hole.

Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite flammable materials left under the bonnet, causing a fire. If you've parked your vehicle for an extended period, inspect and remove any debris that may have collected, such as dried grass and leaves that have fallen or have been carried in for use as a nest by a small animal. Also check under the bonnet for leftover flammable materials after you or someone else has performed maintenance on your vehicle.

Interior Checks

  • Store or secure all items on board properly.
    Carrying too much luggage, or improperly storing it, can affect your vehicle's handling, stability, stopping distance, and tyres, and make it unsafe.
    Load Limit P. 385
  • Do not pile items higher than the seat height.
    They can block your view and may be thrown forward in the event of sudden braking.
  • Do not place anything in the front seat footwells. Make sure to secure the floor mat ^* .
    An object or unsecured floor mat can interfere with your brake and accelerator pedal operation while driving.
  • If you have any animals on board, do not let them move around in the vehicle.
    ▶They may interfere with driving and a crash could occur.
  • Securely close all doors and the tailgate.
  • Adjust your seating position properly.
    ▶Adjust the head restraint, too.
    Adjusting the Seats P. 187
    Adjusting the front head restraint positions P. 193
  • Adjust the mirrors and steering wheel properly for your driving.
    ▶Adjust them while sitting in the proper driving position.
    Adjusting the Mirrors P. 185
    Adjusting the Steering Wheel P. 184

* Not available on all models

Continued

»Interior Checks

The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry heavy items in the luggage area or tow a trailer, have the aiming readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified technician.

Models with halogen type headlights

You can adjust the low beam headlight angle by your self.

Headlight Adjuster * P. 174

Models with LED type headlights

Your vehicle is equipped with the automatic headlight adjusting system that automatically adjusts the vertical angle of the low beam headlights.

  • Be sure items placed on the floor behind the front seats cannot roll under the seats.
    They can interfere with the driver's ability to operate the pedals, or the operation of the seats.
  • Everyone in the vehicle must fasten their seat belt.
    Fastening a Seat Belt P. 42
  • Make sure that the indicators in the instrument panel come on when you start the vehicle, and go off soon after.
    ▶ Always have a dealer check the vehicle if a problem is indicated.
    Indicators P. 86

Load Limit

When you load luggage, the total weight of the vehicle, all passengers, and luggage must not exceed the maximum permissible weight.

Specifications P. 590

The load for the front and rear axles also must not exceed the maximum permissible axle weight.

Specifications P. 590

Load Limit

WARNING

Overloading or improper loading can affect handling and stability and cause a crash in which you can be hurt or killed.

Follow all load limits and other loading guidelines in this manual.

Towing a Trailer

Towing Preparation

Towing Load Limits

Your vehicle can tow a trailer if you carefully observe the load limits, use the proper equipment, and follow the towing guidelines. Check the load limits before driving.

Total Load

■Total trailer weight

Do not exceed the maximum towing weight of the trailer and towbar (with/without brakes), luggage and everything in or on it.

Towing loads in excess of the maximum towing weight can seriously affect vehicle handling and performance and can damage the engine and drivetrain.

Each weight limit is calculated based on the following conditions:

- Occupants fill seats from the front of the vehicle to the back Any additional weight, luggage or accessories reduce the maximum trailer weight and maximum tongue load.

Towing Load Limits

WARNING

Exceeding any load limit or improperly loading your vehicle and trailer can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed.

Check the loading of your vehicle and trailer carefully before starting to drive.

Check if all loads are within limits at a public scale. If a public scale is not available, add the estimated weight of your luggage load to the weight of your trailer (as quoted by the manufacturer), and the trailer nose load.

Break-in Period

Avoid towing a trailer during your vehicle's first 1,000 km (625 miles).

Never exceed the maximum towing weight and any specified load limit.

Specifications P. 593

If you tow a trailer in mountainous conditions, remember to reduce 10% of the combined vehicle and trailer weights from the maximum towing weight for every 1,000 metres (300 feet) of elevation.

Trailer Nose Load

■Towbar down load

The trailer nose load should never exceed 95 kg (209 lbs). This is the amount of weight the trailer puts on the towbar when it is fully-loaded. As a rule of thumb for trailer weights of less than 450 kg (992 lbs), the trailer nose load should be 10 percent of the total trailer package.

  • Excessive trailer nose load reduces front tyre traction and steering control. Too little trailer nose load can make the trailer unstable and cause it to sway.
  • To achieve a proper trailer nose load, start by loading 60% of the load toward the front of the trailer and 40% toward the rear. Readjust the load as needed.

Towing Equipment and Accessories

Towing equipment varies by the size of your trailer, how much load you are towing, and where you are towing.

Towbars

The towbar must be of an approved type and properly bolted to the underbody.

■Safety chains

Always use safety chains when you tow a trailer. Leave enough slack to allow the trailer to turn corners easily, but do not allow the chains to drag on the ground.

■Trailer brakes

If you are thinking of getting a trailer that has brakes, be sure they are electronically actuated. Do not attempt to tap into your vehicle's hydraulic system. No matter how successful it may seem, any attempt to attach trailer brakes to your vehicle's hydraulic system will lower braking effectiveness and create a potential hazard.

■Additional towing equipment

There may be laws requiring special outside mirrors when towing a trailer. Even if mirrors are not required in your locale, you should install special mirrors if visibility is restricted in any way.

■Trailer light

Trailer lights and equipment must comply with the regulations of the country where you are driving. Check with your local trailer sales or rental agency for the requirements in the area where you plan to tow.

Towing Equipment and Accessories

Make sure that all equipment is properly installed and maintained, and that it meets the regulations of the country where you are driving.

Consult your trailer maker for proper installation and setup of the equipment. Improper installation and setup can affect the handling, stability, and braking performance of your vehicle.

Consult your trailer sales or rental agency if any other items are recommended or required for your towing situation.

The lighting and wiring of trailers can vary by type and brand. If a connector is required, it should only be installed by a qualified technician.

Driving Safely with a Trailer

Things You Need To Know Before Towing a Trailer

  • Have the trailer properly serviced and keep it in good condition.
  • Make sure that all the weights and load in the vehicle and trailer are within limits. ▶Towing Load Limits P. 386
  • Securely attach the towbar, safety chains, and other necessary parts to the trailer.
  • Securely store all the items in and on the trailer so that they do not shift while driving.
  • Check if the lights and brakes on the trailer are working properly.
  • Check the pressure of the trailer tyres, including the spare.
  • Check regulations concerning the maximum speed or driving restrictions for vehicles towing trailers. If you are driving across several countries, check each country's requirements before leaving home, because regulations may vary.
  • Turn off the Auto Idle Stop system using the Auto Idle Stop OFF button. The trailer weight can affect your vehicle's brake effectiveness if Auto Idle Stop is activated on a hill while towing a trailer.

>>Driving Safely with a Trailer

Operating speed when towing a trailer must not exceed 100 km/h (62 mph).

Parking

In addition to the normal precautions, place wheel chocks at each of the trailer's tyres.

We recommend you drive uphill or less than 12% slope. Follow the trailer association's recommendations for suitable roads.

Winds caused by passing large vehicles can sway your trailer, keep a constant speed and steer straight ahead.

Always drive slowly and have someone guide you when reversing.

Continued

Towing Speeds and Gears

  • Drive slower than normal.
  • Obey posted speed limits for vehicles with trailers.
  • Use the D position when towing a trailer on level roads.

Continuously variable transmission models

Manual transmission models

- Either shift up or shift down indicator will come on at the best time to shift to a higher or lower gear for the better fuel economy.

Towing Speeds and Gears

When towing a fixed-sided trailer (e.g., camper), do not exceed 88 km/h (55 mph). At higher speeds, the trailer may sway or affect vehicle handling.

Manual transmission models

The shift down indicator will not prompt to downshift to 1st gear. It is up to you to downshift to 1st gear to increase engine braking. Avoid sudden engine braking.

Road and traffic conditions may require you to shift at times other than those indicated.

Turning and Braking

  • Turn more slowly and with a wider turning arc than normal.
  • Allow more time and distance for braking.
  • Do not brake or turn suddenly.

Driving in Hilly Terrain

- Closely watch your high temperature indicator. If the indicator remains on, turn off the heating and cooling system*/climate control system* and reduce speed. Pull to the side of the road safely to cool down the engine if necessary.

Continuously variable transmission models

- Shift to the [S] position and use the paddle shifter to shift down when driving down hills. This helps to increase engine braking efficiently and prevent the brake system from overheating.

When Driving

Models without keyless access system

Starting the Engine

Honda Jazz (2018) - Starting the Engine - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car seatbelt with a black plastic component being lifted by an arrow (no text or symbols visible)

Brake Pedal P

Clutch Pedal Brake Pedal

  1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.

Continuously variable transmission models

  1. Check that the transmission is in P, then depress the brake pedal.

Although it is possible to start the vehicle in N, it is safer to start it in P.

Manual transmission models

  1. Check that the transmission is in N. Then depress the brake pedal with your right foot, and the clutch pedal with your left foot.

The clutch pedal must be fully depressed to start the engine.

Starting the Engine

Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when starting the engine.

The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in thinner air found at altitudes above 2,400 metres (8,000 feet).

When starting the engine in cold weather, turn off all electrical accessories such as the lights, heating and cooling system */climate control system*, and rear demister in order to reduce battery drain.

If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with the engine or exhaust system.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Starting the Engine - 1

natural_image Close-up of a mechanical component with a circular dial and a magnified inset showing a device (no text or symbols visible)

All models

  1. Turn the ignition switch to START III without depressing the accelerator pedal.

■Stopping the Engine

You can turn the engine off when the vehicle is completely stopped.

Starting to Drive

Continuously variable transmission models

  1. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, release the parking brake. Check that the parking brake and brake system indicator has gone off.
    →Parking Brake P. 453
  2. Put the shift lever in D. Select R when reversing.
  3. Gradually release the brake pedal and gently depress the accelerator pedal to pull away.

Starting the Engine

Do not hold the key in START [III] for more than 10 seconds.

  • If the engine does not start right away, wait for at least 30 seconds before trying again.
  • If the engine starts, but then immediately stops, wait at least 30 seconds before repeating step 3 while gently depressing the accelerator pedal. Release the accelerator pedal once the engine starts.

The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from theft. If an improperly coded device is used, the engine's fuel system is disabled.

Immobilizer System P. 159

Starting to Drive

Manual transmission models

If the engine stalls, fully depress the clutch pedal within three seconds.

The engine may automatically restart under certain conditions.

Otherwise, follow the standard procedure.

Continued

■Hill start assist system

Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly to help to prevent the vehicle from rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.

Manual transmission models

Depress the clutch pedal, and shift to one of the forward gears when facing uphill, or R when facing downhill, then release the brake pedal.

Continuously variable transmission models

Move the shift lever to D or S when facing uphill, or R when facing downhill, then release the brake pedal.

Hill start assist system

Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and does not operate on small inclines.

Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking brake.

Hill start assist will operate even when VSA is switched off.

Models with keyless access system

Starting the Engine

Honda Jazz (2018) - Starting the Engine - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car gear shift lever mechanism (no text or symbols visible)

Brake Pedal P

Clutch Pedal Brake Pedal

  1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.

Continuously variable transmission models

  1. Check that the transmission is in , then depress the brake pedal.

Although it is possible to start the vehicle in N, it is safer to start it in P.

Manual transmission models

  1. Check that the transmission is in N. Then depress the brake pedal with your right foot, and the clutch pedal with your left foot.

The clutch pedal must be fully depressed to start the engine.

Starting the Engine

Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when starting the engine.

The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in thinner air found at altitudes above 2,400 metres (8,000 feet).

When starting the engine in cold weather, turn off all electrical accessories such as the lights, climate control system, and rear demister in order to reduce battery drain.

If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with the engine or exhaust system.

The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from theft. If an improperly coded device is used, the engine's fuel system is disabled.

Immobilizer System P. 159

Continued

ENGINE START STOP

All models

  1. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button without depressing the accelerator pedal.

Starting the Engine

Bring the keyless remote close to the ENGINE START/STOP button if the battery in the keyless remote is weak.

If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak P. 560

The engine may not start if the keyless remote is subjected to strong radio waves.

Do not hold the ENGINE START/STOP button to start the engine.

If the engine does not start, wait at least 30 seconds before trying again.

Stopping the Engine

You can turn the engine off when the vehicle is completely stopped.

Continuously variable transmission models

  1. Put the transmission into P.
  2. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button.

Manual transmission models

  • If the transmission is in N, press the ENGINE START/STOP button.
  • If the transmission is in any gear other than N, depress the clutch pedal, then press the ENGINE START/STOP button.

Starting to Drive

Continuously variable transmission models

  1. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, release the parking brake. Check that the parking brake and brake system indicator has gone off.
    Parking Brake P. 453
  2. Put the shift lever in D. Select R when reversing.
  3. Gradually release the brake pedal and gently depress the accelerator pedal to pull away.

Starting to Drive

Manual transmission models

If the engine stalls, fully depress the clutch pedal within three seconds.
The engine may automatically restart under certain conditions.
Otherwise, follow the standard procedure.

Continued

■Hill start assist system

Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly to help to prevent the vehicle from rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.

Continuously variable transmission models

Move the shift lever to D or S when facing uphill, or R when facing downhill, then release the brake pedal.

Manual transmission models

Depress the clutch pedal, and shift to one of the forward gears when facing uphill, or R when facing downhill, then release the brake pedal.

Hill start assist system

Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and does not operate on small inclines.

Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking brake.

Hill start assist will operate even when VSA is switched off.

Precautions While Driving

In Rain

Avoid driving in deep water and on flooded roads. This can damage the engine or driveline, or cause electrical component failure.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Continued

>>Precautions While Driving

CAUTION: Do not drive on the road where water is deep. Driving through deep water will cause damage to the engine and electrical equipment and the vehicle will break down.

NOTICE

Do not operate the shift lever while pressing the accelerator pedal. You could damage the transmission.

NOTICE

If you repeatedly turn the steering wheel at an extremely low speed, or hold the steering wheel in the full left or right position for a while, the electric power steering (EPS) system heats up. The system goes into a protective mode, and limits its performance. The steering wheel becomes harder and harder to operate. Once the system cools down, the EPS system is restored. Repeated operation under these conditions can eventually damage the system.

If the ignition switch is turned to ACCESSORY 1 while driving, the engine will shut down and all steering and brake power assist functions will stop, making it difficult to control the vehicle.

Do not put the transmission into N, as you will lose engine braking (and acceleration) performance.

Other Precautions

If there is a strong impact with something under the vehicle, stop in a safe location. Check the underside of the vehicle for damage or any fluid leaks.

Precautions While Driving

During the first 1,000 km (625 miles) of operation, avoid sudden acceleration or full throttle operation so as not to damage the engine or powertrain.

Avoid hard braking for the first 300 km (200 miles). You should also follow this when the brake pads are replaced.

NOTICE

The following can damage the under spoiler:

  • Parking the vehicle by a parking block
    • Parallel parking along the road shoulder
  • Driving towards the bottom of a hill
  • Driving up or down to a different surface level (such as a road shoulder)
  • Driving on a rutted or bumpy road
  • Driving on a road with potholes.

Continuously Variable Transmission\*

Creeping

The engine runs at a higher idle speed and creeping increases. Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed when stopped.

Kickdown

Quickly depressing the accelerator pedal while driving uphill may cause the transmission to drop to a lower gear, unexpectedly increasing vehicle speed. Depress the accelerator pedal carefully, especially on slippery roads and curves.

Continuously variable transmission models

Shifting

Change the shift position in accordance with your driving needs.

Shift lever positions
P Park Used when parking or starting the engine R Reverse Used when reversing N Neutral Transmission is not locked D Drive Used: • For normal driving • When temporarily driving in the 7-speed manual shift mode S Drive (S) Used: • For better acceleration • To increase engine braking • When going up or down hills • When driving in the 7-speed manual shift mode Release Button

>>Shift lever positions

Models without keyless access system

You cannot turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0 and remove the key unless the shift lever is in [P].

Models with keyless access system

You cannot change the power mode from ON to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) unless the shift lever is in [P].

The vehicle may move forward very slightly even in N while the engine is cold.

Depress the brake pedal firmly and, when necessary, apply the parking brake.

When shifting positions in extremely low temperatures ( -30^ ), there may be a short delay before the shift position is displayed. Always confirm you are in the correct shift position before driving.

Shift Lever Operation
Tachometer's red zone x1000e/min Shift Lever Position Indicator M (7-Speed Manual Shift Mode) Indicator/Shift Indicator P R N D S Depress the brake pedal and press the shift lever release button to shift. Shift without pressing the shift lever release button. Press the shift lever release button and shift.

Shift Lever Operation

NOTICE

When you change the shift lever from D to R and vice versa, come to a complete stop and keep the brake pedal depressed.

Operating the shift lever before the vehicle has come to a complete standstill can damage the transmission.

Use the shift lever position indicator to check the lever position before pulling away.

If the transmission indicator blinks when driving, in any shift position, there is a problem with the transmission.

Avoid sudden acceleration and have the transmission checked by a dealer as soon as possible.

The fuel supply may be cut off if you drive at engine speeds in or over the tachometer's red zone (engine speed limit). If this happens, you may experience a slight jolt.

It may not be possible to operate the shift lever if the brake pedal is applied while the shift lever release button is held down.

Depress the brake pedal first.

Continued

7-Speed Manual Shift Mode

Use the paddle shifters to change between 1st and 7th speeds without releasing your hands from the steering wheel. The transmission switches to the 7-speed manual shift mode when you pull a paddle shifter while driving. This mode is useful when engine braking is needed.

■ When the shift lever is in D:

The shift mode goes into the 7-speed manual shift mode temporarily, and the number is displayed in the shift indicator. The 7-speed manual shift mode is cancelled automatically if you drive at constant speed or accelerate, and the number in the shift indicator goes off. You can cancel this mode by pulling the paddle shifter for a few seconds. The 7-speed manual shift mode is especially useful when reducing the vehicle speed temporarily before making a turn.

■ When the shift lever is in S:

The shift mode goes into the 7-speed manual shift mode. The M indicator and the speed number are displayed in the shift indicator. As the vehicle speed slows down, the transmission automatically shifts down accordingly. When the vehicle comes to a stop, it automatically shifts down into 1st. You can cancel this mode by pulling the paddle shifter for a few seconds.

If the vehicle speed increases and the engine speed reaches near the tachometer's red zone, the transmission automatically shifts up.

7-Speed Manual Shift Mode

In the 7-speed manual shift mode, the transmission shifts up or down by operating either paddle shifter under the following conditions: Shift Up: The engine speed reaches the lowest threshold of the higher speed position. Shift Down: The engine speed reaches the highest threshold of the lower speed position.

When the engine speed reaches near the tachometer's red zone, the transmission shifts up automatically. When the engine speed reaches the lowest threshold of the selected speed position, the transmission shifts down automatically.

Operating the paddle shifters on slippery surfaces may cause the tyres to lock up. In this case, the 7-speed manual shift mode is cancelled and goes back to the normal driving mode.

7-Speed Manual Shift Mode Operation

You can only pull away in 1st gear.

When cancelling the 7-speed manual shift mode, move the shift lever from S to D. When the 7-speed manual shift mode is cancelled, the M indicator and shift indicator will turn off.

You can cancel this mode by pulling the + paddle shifter for a few seconds.

Paddle Shifter (Shift down) Paddle Shifter (Shift up) Downshifting when pulling the paddle shifter (Changes to lower speed number) Upshifting when pulling the paddle shifter (Changes to higher speed number)

7-Speed Manual Shift Mode Operation

Each paddle shift operation makes a single gear change.

To change continuously, release the paddle shifter before pulling it again for the next speed.

The shift indicator blinks when you cannot shift up or down. It indicates that your vehicle speed is not in its allowable shifting range.

Slightly accelerate to shift up and decelerate to shift down while the indicator is blinking.

Continued

Shift Up Indicator

Shift Up Indicator

Comes on while the vehicle is in the 7-speed manual shift mode to indicate when a shift change is appropriate to maintain the most fuel efficient driving style.

The shift up indicator: Comes on when shifting up is recommended.

Shift Up Indicator

WARNING

The shift indicator is only a guide to help you achieve better fuel economy. Never refer to the Shift Indicators when road and traffic conditions are unsuitable or when it may distract you.

Ambient meter colour may change if you do not change transmission when a shift indicator illuminates. This can result in a change in fuel economy.

Road and traffic conditions may require you to shift at times other than those indicated.

Manual transmission models

Shifting

Shift Lever Operation

Fully depress the clutch pedal to operate the shift lever and change gears, then slowly release the pedal.

Depress the clutch pedal, and pause for a few seconds before shifting into R, or shift into one of the forward gears for a moment. This stops the gears so they do not "grind."

1 3 5 2 4 6 R

When you are not shifting, do not rest your foot on the clutch pedal. This can cause your clutch to wear out faster.

Continued

>>Shifting

NOTICE

Do not shift to before the vehicle comes to a complete stop. Shifting to before stopping can damage the transmission.

NOTICE

Before downshifting, make sure the engine will not go into the tachometer's red zone. Should this occur, it can severely damage your engine.

There is a metallic part on the shift lever. If you leave the vehicle parked outside for a long time on a hot day, be careful before moving the shift lever. Because of heat, the shift lever may be extremely hot. If the outside temperature is low, the shift lever may feel cold.

If you exceed the maximum speed for the gear you are in, the engine speed will enter into the tachometer's red zone. When this happens, you may experience a slight jolt.

Shift Up/Down Indicators

UP DOWN

Come on to indicate when a gear change is appropriate to maintain the most fuel efficient driving style.

The shift up indicator: Comes on when shifting up is recommended.

The shift down indicator: Comes on when shifting down is recommended.

Shift Up/Down Indicators

WARNING

The shift indicator is only a guide to help you achieve better fuel economy. Never refer to the Shift Indicators when road and traffic conditions are unsuitable or when it may distract you.

This indicator will not prompt you to downshift to increase engine braking. It is up to you to downshift to increase engine braking when driving downhill.

Always shift down at the appropriate vehicle speed.

The shift down indicator does not come on when downshifting from 2 to 1.

Ambient meter colour may change if you do not change gears when a shift indicator illuminates. This can result in a change in fuel economy.

Road and traffic conditions may require you to shift at times other than those indicated.

Reverse Lockout

The manual transmission has a lockout mechanism that stops you from accidentally shifting into R from a forward gear while the vehicle is moving above a certain speed.

If you cannot shift to R when the vehicle is stopped, do the following:

① N ② R ③

  1. Depress the clutch pedal, move the shift lever all the way to the left, and shift to R.
  2. If you still cannot shift into R, apply the parking brake, and turn the ignition switch to ACCESSORY I or LOCK 0*1.
  3. Depress the clutch pedal and shift into R.
  4. Keep depressing the clutch pedal and start the engine.

Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if you have to go through this procedure repeatedly.

Continuously variable transmission models

Auto Idle Stop

To help to maximise fuel economy, the engine automatically stops when the vehicle comes to a stop, depending on environmental and vehicle operating conditions. The indicator (green) comes on.

Auto Idle Stop Indicator (green)

The engine then restarts once the vehicle is about to move again, or depending on environmental and vehicle conditions, and the indicator (green) goes off.

The Engine Automatically Restarts When: P. 414

If the driver's door is opened while the indicator (green) is on, a buzzer sounds to notify you that the Auto Idle Stop function is in operation.

A message associated with Auto Idle Stop appears on the multi-information display.

Indicators P. 102, 103
Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages P. 111
Customized Features P. 131

Auto Idle Stop

The 12-volt battery installed in this vehicle is specifically designed for a model with Auto Idle Stop. Using a battery other than this specified type may shorten the battery life, and prevent Auto Idle Stop from activating. If you need to replace the battery, make sure to select the specified type. Ask a dealer for more details.

Specifications P. 590

Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF

Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car gear shift lever with a highlighted key (no text or symbols visible)

To turn the Auto Idle Stop system off, press this button. The Auto Idle Stop system stops.

▶ Auto Idle Stop system will stop and the indicator (amber) will come on.

The Auto Idle Stop system is turned on every time you start the engine, even if you turned it off the last time you drove the vehicle.

Auto Idle Stop Indicator (Amber)

Continued

Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF

Pressing the Auto Idle Stop OFF button restarts the engine from the idling stop.

Auto Idle Stop Activates When:

The vehicle stops with the shift lever in D and the brake pedal depressed.

■Auto Idle Stop does not activate when:

  • The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
  • The engine coolant temperature is low or high.
  • The transmission fluid temperature is low or high.
  • The vehicle comes to a stop again before the vehicle speed reaches 5 km/h (3 mph) after the engine starts.
  • Stopped on a steep incline.
  • The transmission is in a position other than D.
    • The engine is started with the bonnet open.

▶ Turn off the engine. Close the bonnet before you restart the engine to activate Auto Idle Stop.

• The Auto Idle Stop OFF button is pressed.
• The battery charge is low.
- The internal temperature of the battery is 5^ C or less.

Models with capacitor unit

• The capacitor unit condition is not good.
The capacitor unit is used for a condenser to charge or discharge in a short time.

Models with climate control system

  • The climate control system is in use, and the outside temperature is below -20°C or over 40°C.
    • The climate control system is in use, and the temperature is set to Hi or Lo.
    • ISON (indicator on).

Models with heating and cooling system

- The fan is turned on and the mode control dial is turned to 📄.

Auto Idle Stop Activates When:

Do not open a bonnet while the Auto Idle Stop function is activated. If the bonnet is opened, the engine will not restart automatically.

In this case, restart the engine with the ignition switch or the ENGINE START/STOP button.

Starting the Engine P. 392, 395

Models with keyless access system

Pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button changes the power mode to ACCESSORY even while Auto Idle Stop is in operation. Once in ACCESSORY, the engine no longer restarts automatically. Follow the standard procedure to start the engine.

Starting the Engine P. 395

Models without keyless access system

Even if you turn the ignition switch to START III during the Auto Idle Stop activated, the engine does not start.

■Auto Idle Stop may not activate when:

• The steering wheel is operated.
- Altitude is high.
• The vehicle is stopped by braking suddenly.
- The vehicle is repeatedly accelerated and decelerated at a low speed.

Models with climate control system

  • The climate control system is in use, and there is a significant difference between the set temperature and the actual interior temperature.
    • Humidity in the interior is high.
    • The fan speed is high.

The Engine Automatically Restarts When:

The brake pedal is released.

■The engine restarts even if the brake pedal is depressed when:

• The Auto Idle Stop OFF button is pressed.
• A steering wheel is operated.
- The transmission is put into or , or taken out of and put into .
- The pressure to the brake pedal is reduced and the vehicle starts moving while stopped on an incline.
- The pressure on the brake pedal is repeatedly applied and released slightly during a stop.
• The battery charge becomes low.
• The accelerator pedal is depressed.
- The driver's seat belt is unlatched.

Models with climate control system

• ISON (indicator on).
- The climate control system is in use, and the difference between the set temperature and actual interior temperature becomes significant.
- The climate control system is being used to dehumidify the interior.

Models with heating and cooling system

- The fan is turned on and the mode control dial is turned to 📄.

Starting Assist Brake Function

Briefly keeps the brake applied after releasing the brake pedal to restart the engine. This can keep your vehicle from unexpectedly moving while on an incline.

The Engine Automatically Restarts When:

If you are using an electronic device during Auto Idle Stop, the device may temporarily be turned off when the engine restarts.

Manual transmission models

Auto Idle Stop

To help to maximise fuel economy, the engine automatically stops when the vehicle comes to a stop, depending on environmental and vehicle operating conditions. The indicator (green) comes on.

Auto Idle Stop Indicator (green)

The engine then restarts once the vehicle is about to move again, or depending on environmental and vehicle conditions, and the indicator (green) goes off.

The Engine Automatically Restarts When: P. 414

If the driver's door is opened while the indicator (green) is on, a buzzer sounds to notify you that the Auto Idle Stop function is in operation.

A message associated with Auto Idle Stop appears on the multi-information display.

Indicators P. 102, 103
Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages P. 111
Customized Features P. 131

Auto Idle Stop

The 12-volt battery installed in this vehicle is specifically designed for a model with Auto Idle Stop. Using a battery other than this specified type may shorten the battery life, and prevent Auto Idle Stop from activating. If you need to replace the battery, make sure to select the specified type. Ask a dealer for more details.

Specifications P. 590

Continued

Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF

Honda Jazz (2018) - Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car gear shift lever with a highlighted sensor component (no text or symbols visible)

To turn the Auto Idle Stop system off, press this button. The Auto Idle Stop system stops.

▶ Auto Idle Stop system will stop and the indicator (amber) will come on.

The Auto Idle Stop system is turned on every time you start the engine, even if you turned it off the last time you drove the vehicle.

Auto Idle Stop Indicator (Amber)

Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF

Pressing the Auto Idle Stop OFF button restarts the engine during the Auto Idle Stop activated.

Auto Idle Stop Activates When:

After the vehicle moves forward, stopping with the brake, the clutch pedal fully depressed, the shift lever in N, and then the clutch pedal is released.

▶ To restart the engine automatically, keep the shift lever in N.

■Auto Idle Stop does not activate when:

  • The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
    • The engine coolant temperature is low or high.
  • The vehicle comes to a stop again before the vehicle speed reaches 3 km/h (2 mph) after the engine starts.
  • The shift lever is in any position except N.
    • The engine is started with the bonnet open.

▶ Turn off the engine. Close the bonnet before you restart the engine to activate Auto Idle Stop.

• The Auto Idle Stop OFF button is pressed.
• The battery charge is low.
• The internal temperature of the battery is 5^ C or less.

Models with climate control system

  • The climate control system is in use, and the outside temperature is below -20°C or over 40°C.
  • The climate control system is in use, and the temperature is set to Hi or Lo.
    • S On (indicator on).

Models with heating and cooling system

- The fan is turned on and the mode control dial is turned to 📄.

Auto Idle Stop Activates When:

Do not open a bonnet while the Auto Idle Stop function is activated. If the bonnet is opened, the engine will not restart automatically.

In this case, restart the engine with the ignition switch or the ENGINE START/STOP button.

Starting the Engine P. 392, 395

Models with keyless access system

Pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button changes the power mode to OFF even while Auto Idle Stop is in operation. The engine no longer restarts automatically. Follow the standard procedure to start the engine.

Starting the Engine P. 395

Models without keyless access system

Even if you turn the ignition switch to START III during the Auto Idle Stop activated, the engine does not start.

■Auto Idle Stop may not activate when:

• The steering wheel is operated.
- Altitude is high.

Models with climate control system

  • The climate control system is in use, and there is a significant difference between the set temperature and the actual interior temperature.
    • Humidity in the interior is high.
    • The fan speed is high.

Engine Automatically Restarts When:

The clutch pedal is depressed.

■ The engine automatically restarts even if the clutch pedal is not depressed with the transmission in N when:

  • The Auto Idle Stop OFF button is pressed.
  • The pressure on the brake pedal is reduced and the vehicle starts moving while stopped on an incline.
  • The pressure on the brake pedal is repeatedly applied and released slightly during a stop.
    • The battery charge becomes low.
    • The steering wheel is operated.

Engine Automatically Restarts When:

The engine does not restart automatically when there is a problem in the system. Follow the normal procedure to start the engine.

Starting the Engine P. 392, 395

If you are using an electronic device during Auto Idle Stop, the device may temporarily be turned off when the engine restarts.

During Auto Idle Stop, the engine does not restart automatically if:

• The driver's seat belt is unlatched.
To keep Auto Idle Stop activated, fasten your seat belt immediately.
- The transmission is put into a position other than . Put the transmission into .

Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages P. 114

When the system stops operating, follow the normal procedure to start the engine.

Starting the Engine P. 392, 395

Fully depress the clutch pedal.

▶The engine automatically restarts.

When indicator light (Green) blinks in Auto Idle Stop

The indicator starts blinking rapidly under the following conditions:

Models with climate control system

• (Windscreen demister) is touched.
- When the climate control system is in use and moisture builds up inside the vehicle.
- When the climate control system is in use and the difference between the set temperature and the actual temperature inside the vehicle becomes significant.

Models with heating and cooling system

- is on with the fan operating.

Cruise Control

Maintains a constant vehicle speed without having to keep your foot on the accelerator. Use cruise control on motorways or open roads where you can travel at a constant speed with little acceleration or deceleration.

When to use

■ Vehicle speed for cruise control: Desired speed in a range from about 30 km/h (18 mph) to about 200 km/h (125 mph)

Always keep sufficient distance between you and the vehicle in front of you.

Continuously variable transmission models

Shift positions for cruise control: In D or S

Honda Jazz (2018) - Continuously variable transmission models - 1

Cruise Control

WARNING

Improper use of the cruise control can lead to a crash.

Use the cruise control only when travelling on open motorways in good weather.

It may not be possible to maintain a constant speed when driving uphill or downhill.

When not using cruise control: Turn off cruise control by pressing the MAIN button.

Manual transmission models

When the engine speed slows down, try to downshift.

You can maintain the set speed if you change gear within five seconds.

Setting the power mode to ACCESSORY or VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) turns off cruise control automatically.

You cannot use cruise control and the adjustable speed limiter at the same time.

To Set the Vehicle Speed

The set speed appears when cruise control begins Press and release -/SET Button

Take your foot off the pedal and press the -/SET button when you reach the desired speed.

The moment you release the -/SET button, the set speed is fixed, and cruise control begins. The set speed is displayed.

Continued

To Adjust the Vehicle Speed

Increase or decrease the vehicle speed using the RES/+ or -/SET buttons on the steering wheel.

To increase speed To decrease speed

• Each time you press the button, the vehicle speed is increased or decreased by about 1 km/h or 1 mph accordingly.
- If you keep the button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or decreases by about 10 km/h or 10 mph accordingly.

To Cancel

MAIN Button LIM Button CANCEL Button

To cancel cruise control, do any of the following:

  • Press the CANCEL button.
  • Press the MAIN button.
  • Press the LIM button.
  • Depress the brake pedal.

Manual transmission models

- Depress the clutch pedal for five seconds or more.

The cruise control indicator and displayed set speed go off.

To Adjust the Vehicle Speed

You can set the vehicle speed using the -/SET button on the steering wheel when adjusting the speed with the accelerator and brake pedals.

To Cancel

Resuming the prior set speed:

After cruise control has been cancelled, you can still resume the prior set speed by pressing the RES/+ button while driving at a speed of at least 30 km/h (18 mph) or more.

You cannot set or resume in the following situations:
- When vehicle speed is less than 30 km/h (18 mph)
- When the MAIN button is turned off

At vehicle speeds of 25 km/h (16 mph) or less, cruise control is cancelled automatically.

Adjustable Speed Limiter

This system enables you to set a maximum speed that cannot be exceeded even if you are depressing the accelerator pedal.

The vehicle speed limit can be set from about 30 km/h (18 mph) to about 250 km/h (156 mph).

How to use

The indicator is on in the instrument panel.

Adjustable speed limiter is ready to use.

Honda Jazz (2018) - How to use - 1

■Press the MAIN button on the steering wheel

SAC MAX MIN MAX

If a different indicator comes on, press the LIM button to switch to the adjustable speed limiter.

Honda Jazz (2018) - How to use - 3

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)

Adjustable Speed Limiter

WARNING

Adjustable Speed Limiter has limitations.

It is always your responsibility to adjust the vehicle speed to obey the actual speed limit, and safely operate the vehicle.

WARNING

Do not depress the accelerator pedal more than necessary.

Maintain an appropriate accelerator pedal position depending on the vehicle speed.

The adjustable speed limiter may not hold the set speed limit when driving downhill. If this occurs, slow down by depressing the brake pedal.

When not using the adjustable speed limiter: Turn off the adjustable speed limiter by pressing the MAIN button.

You cannot use the adjustable speed limiter and cruise control or intelligent speed limiter* at the same time.

Manual transmission models

When the engine speed slows down, try to downshift.

▶▶ When Driving▶ Adjustable Speed Limiter

■ To Set the Speed Limit

On when the adjustable speed limiter is set

To Set the Speed Limit

If you set the speed limit while travelling at less than 30 km/h (18 mph), the speed limit is set to 30 km/h (18 mph).

The beeper sounds and the displayed speed limit blinks if the vehicle speed exceeds the limit by 3 km/h (2 mph) or more on a steep descent.

The adjustable speed limiter is set to the current speed if it is higher than the previously set speed limit when you press the RES/+ button.

RES/+

Button

-/SET

Button

Press and release

  • Take your foot off the pedal and press the -/SET button when you reach the desired speed.
    The moment you release the -/SET button, the speed limit is fixed, and the adjustable speed limiter is set. The speed limit is displayed.
  • You can set the previously set speed limit by pressing the RES/+ button.

To Adjust the Speed Limit

Increase or decrease the speed limit by using the RES/+ or -/SET buttons on the steering wheel.

To increase speed To decrease speed

• Each time you press the button, the speed limit increases or decreases by about 1 km/h or 1 mph accordingly.
- If you keep the button pressed, the speed limit increases or decreases in increments of 10 km/h or 10 mph every 0.5 second until system limit is reached.
- The vehicle may accelerate or decelerate until the set speed is reached.

Exceeding the Speed Limit Temporarily

The speed limit can be exceeded by depressing the accelerator pedal completely.

The displayed speed limit blinks. The beeper sounds once the speed limit has been exceeded.

Continued

Exceeding the Speed Limit Temporarily

The beeper sounds when the vehicle speed goes higher than the set speed limit with the acceleration pedal depressed completely.

The adjustable speed limiter resumes working once the vehicle speed goes lower than the set speed limit.

To Cancel

MAIN Button LIM Button CANCEL Button

To cancel the adjustable speed limiter, do any of the following:

  • Press the CANCEL button.
  • Press the MAIN button.
  • Press the LIM button.

To Cancel

The adjustable speed limiter changes into cruise control if the LIM button is pressed.

Models with intelligent speed limiter

The adjustable speed limiter changes into intelligent speed limiter if the LIM button is pressed.

OFF 23℃ 002300元/时 000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000

If there is a problem with the system when you are using the adjustable speed limiter, the beeper sounds and OFF comes on. The adjustable speed limiter will be turned off.

Models with traffic sign recognition system

Intelligent Speed Limiter

Automatically sets the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects. And the speed limit cannot be exceeded even if you are depressing the accelerator pedal. If you fully depress the accelerator the speed limit can be exceeded.

Traffic Sign Recognition System * P. 442

Intelligent Speed Limiter

WARNING

Intelligent Speed Limiter has limitations. The Intelligent Speed Limiter may set itself to a speed above or below the actual speed limit, or may not work, particularly where the traffic sign recognition system does not operate correctly or where a road has no speed limit signs. It is always your responsibility to adjust the speed to obey the actual speed limit and to safely operate the vehicle.

Depending on the amount of depression of the accelerator pedal, the vehicle will accelerate until it reaches the speed identified by the traffic sign recognition system.

* Not available on all models

Continued

How to use

The indicator is on in the instrument panel. Intelligent speed limiter is ready to use. ■Press the MAIN button on the steering wheel

If a different indicator comes on, press the LIM button to change it to the intelligent speed limiter.

Intelligent Speed Limiter

The system is designed to detect signs that follow the Vienna Convention standards. Not all signs may be detected, but any signs posted on roadsides should not be ignored. The system does not work on the designated traffic signs of all the countries you travel, nor in all situations.

Traffic Sign Recognition System \* P. 442

If the intelligent speed limiter is set to the wrong speed limit, try one of the following:

To cancel

  • Press the CANCEL button.
  • Press the MAIN button.
  • Press the LIM button.
    To exceed the speed limit temporarily
    • Depressing the accelerator pedal fully.

The intelligent speed limiter may not hold the set speed limit when driving downhill. If this occurs, slow down by depressing the brake pedal.

When not using the intelligent speed limiter, turn off the intelligent speed limiter by pressing the MAIN button.

You cannot use the intelligent speed limiter and cruise control or adjustable speed limiter at the same time.

To Set the Speed Limit

On when the intelligent speed limiter is set to the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects. RES/+ Button -/SET Button Press and release

  • The moment you release the -/SET button or RES/+ button, the intelligent speed limiter is set to the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects. The speed limit is displayed.

Intelligent Speed Limiter

Manual transmission models

When the engine speed slows down, try to downshift.

Do not use the intelligent speed limiter in areas of different units from the display unit of the intelligent speed limiter.

Right-hand drive type

Change the displayed measurement of the set vehicle speed to the same units as the driving areas.

Customized Features P. 131

To Set the Speed Limit

If you set the intelligent speed limiter when the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects is less than 30 km/h (20 mph), the speed limitation function and warning function may switch to pause.

If your vehicle speed is higher than the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects, your vehicle decelerates slowly to the speed limit or less. If necessary, slow down by depressing the brake pedal. And the beeper sounds and the displayed speed limit blinks if the vehicle speed exceeds the limit by 3 km/h (2 mph) or more.

Continued

■ When the traffic sign recognition system detects the new speed limit sign The intelligent speed limiter is set to the new speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects.

9LM 80km/h 80 23°C 002300km 011111111111111111111111111111111111111111 → 9LM 60km/h 60 23°C 002300km 011111111111111111111111111111

■ The speed limitation function and warning function may switch to pause if there is no speed limit sign in the screen of the traffic sign recognition system when:

  • The end of speed limit or other designated limit is detected.
  • Your vehicle enters/exits motorway or highway.
  • You make a turn with a turn signal to change direction at an intersection.

90M 60km/h 60 23°C 002300km 01.1 → 90M ---km/h 23°C 002300km 01.1

To Set the Speed Limit

The intelligent speed limiter may also switch to pause when the traffic sign recognition system detects only additional speed limit signs.

%IM --- km/h 30 23°C 002300km 0 1

■ When the traffic sign recognition system detects the speed limit sign while the intelligent speed limiter is paused

The speed limitation function and warning function will be resumed automatically.

9LM --- km/h 23°C 002300km 01 1 → 9LM 60km/h 60 23°C 002300km 01 1

■ When the traffic sign recognition system does not detect the speed limit sign for a time while the intelligent speed limiter is activated

While driving, in addition to when the traffic sign recognition system detects no speed limit sign, the traffic sign recognition system may display no speed limit. But, intelligent speed limiter functions continue.

60km/h 60 23°C 002300km 01 1 → 60km/h 23°C 002300km 01 1

To Adjust the Speed Limit

Increase or decrease the speed limit by using the RES/+ or -/SET buttons on the steering wheel.

To increase speed To decrease speed

  • Each time you press the button, the speed limit is increased or decreased by about 1 km/h or 1 mph accordingly.
  • You can increase the speed limit until +10 km/h or +5 mph on the basis of the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects.
  • You can decrease the speed limit until -10 km/h or -5 mph on the basis of the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects.
  • You can accelerate until the set speed is reached. If your vehicle speed is higher than the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects, your vehicle decelerates slowly to the speed limit.

Exceeding the Speed Limit Temporarily

The speed limit can be exceeded by depressing the accelerator pedal fully.

▶The displayed speed limit blinks.

The beeper sounds once the speed limit has been exceeded.

To Adjust the Speed Limit

A negative or positive offset with respect to the speed limit will be reset automatically when the traffic sign recognition system detects the new speed limit sign.

You cannot decrease the speed limit less than 30 km/h (18 mph).

Exceeding the Speed Limit Temporarily

The beeper sounds when the vehicle speed goes higher than the set speed limit with the acceleration pedal depressed completely.

The intelligent speed limiter resumes working once the vehicle speed goes lower than the set speed limit.

To Cancel

MAIN Button LIM Button CANCEL Button

To cancel the intelligent speed limiter, do any of the following:

  • Press the CANCEL button.
  • Press the MAIN button.
  • Press the LIM button.

To Cancel

The intelligent speed limiter changes into cruise control if the LIM button is pressed.

Honda Jazz (2018) - To Cancel - 1

If there is a problem with the system or traffic sign recognition system when you are using the intelligent speed limiter, the beeper sounds and OFF comes on. The intelligent speed limiter will be turned off.

Traffic Sign Recognition System * P. 442

▶▶ When Driving▶ Forward Collision Warning *

Forward Collision Warning\*

Alerts you when it determines that there is a possibility that your vehicle may collide with a vehicle detected in front of yours.

If the system determines a collision is possible, it gives both visual and audible alerts.

▶ Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply the brakes, change lanes, etc.).

■How the system works

The system may give warnings of potential collisions when your vehicle speed is above 15 km/h (9 mph).

You can set Far, Normal or Near for when warnings start: Far Normal Near Your Vehicle Vehicle Ahead

Forward Collision Warning *

Important Safety Reminder

Forward Collision Warning cannot detect all objects ahead and may not detect a given object; accuracy of the system will vary based on weather, speed and other factors. Forward Collision Warning does not include a braking function. It is always your responsibility to safely operate the vehicle and avoid collisions.

You can change the Forward Collision Warning Distance setting or turn the system on and off.

Customized Features P. 131

The camera is shared with Lane Departure Warning, Traffic Sign Recognition System and High beam Support System.

The camera is located behind the rearview mirror. The beeper sounds and appears in the multi-information display until a possible collision is avoided.

* Not available on all models
Continued

Forward Collision Warning \*

Never apply a film or attach any objects to the windscreen that could obstruct the Forward Collision Warning camera's field of vision.

Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the windscreen within the Forward Collision Warning camera's field of vision can cause the system to operate abnormally. If this occurs, we recommend that you replace the windscreen with a genuine Honda replacement windscreen. Making even minor repairs within the camera's field of vision or installing an aftermarket replacement windscreen may also cause the system to operate abnormally.

After replacing the windscreen, have a dealer recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the Forward Collision Warning camera is necessary for the system to operate properly.

For the system's proper operation:

  • Do not impact the camera or the area around the camera when you clean the windscreen.
  • Keep the upper windscreen clean. Wipe away any debris including ice and frost.

Consult a dealer in the following cases.

  • The camera or the area around the camera is severely impacted.
  • The area around the windscreen needs repair.

■Automatic shutoff

Forward Collision Warning may automatically shut itself off and the indicator comes and stays on when:

- The temperature inside the system is high.

- The windscreen is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.

Once the conditions that caused Forward Collision Warning to shut off improve or are addressed (e.g., cleaning), the system comes back on.

>>Automatic shutoff

To help to reduce the likelihood that high interior temperatures will cause the camera system to shut off, when parking, find a shady area or face the front of the vehicle away from the sun.

If you use a reflective sun shade, do not allow it to cover the camera housing. Covering the camera can concentrate heat on the camera.

Honda Jazz (2018) - &gt;&gt;Automatic shutoff - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard and steering wheel (no visible text or symbols)

If the system cannot operate: 📄 appears:

  • Use the heating and cooling system*/climate control system* to cool down the interior and, if necessary, the demister mode when windows are fogged.
  • Start driving the vehicle to lower the windscreen temperature, which cools down the area around the Forward Collision Warning camera.

If the system cannot operate: 📄 appears: Park your vehicle in a safe place. Wipe away debris blocking the windscreen, then start driving again. If the symbol remains on even after driving for a while with the clean windscreen, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.

Forward Collision Warning Limitations

Forward Collision Warning may not activate or may not detect a vehicle in front of your vehicle, and may activate even when you are aware of a vehicle ahead of you, or when there is no vehicle ahead, under the following conditions.

Condition

  • The distance between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead of you is too short.
  • A vehicle cuts in front of you at a slow speed, and it brakes suddenly.
  • A vehicle suddenly crosses in front of you.
  • When either your vehicle or the vehicle ahead of you accelerates rapidly.
  • The vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle, a small vehicle, or a unique vehicle such as a tractor.
  • When you drive off-road or on a mountain road, or curved and winding road for an extended period that makes it difficult for the camera to properly detect a vehicle in front of you.
  • When there are pedestrians or animals in front of your vehicle.
  • When you drive in bad weather (rain, fog, etc.).
  • A heavy load in the rear or modifications to the suspension tilts your vehicle.
  • An abnormal tyre condition is detected (wrong tyre size, flat tyre, etc.).
  • When the windscreen is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
  • When the temperature inside the system is high.
  • A sudden change between light and dark such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
  • You drive into the sunlight (e.g. at dawn or dusk).
  • When the windscreen is dirty or cloudy.
  • When streetlights are perceived as the taillight of a vehicle in front of yours.
  • When driving at night, the vehicle ahead of you is running with either taillight bulb burned out.
  • When you drive in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
  • When your vehicle is towing a trailer.

Lane Departure Warning\*

Alerts you when the system determines a possibility of your vehicle unintentionally crossing over detected lane markings.

How the System Works
Diagram showing car navigation and traffic signal flow with a circular warning sign and directional arrow

If your vehicle is getting too close to detected left or right side lane markings without a turn signal activated, Lane Departure Warning will give audible and visual alerts.

The beeper sounds and 📋 appears on the multi-information display, letting you know that you need to take appropriate action.

How the System Activates

The system begins to search for lane markings when all the following conditions are met:

• The vehicle is travelling above 72 km/h (45 mph).
- The vehicle is on a straight or slightly curved road.
• The turn signals are off.
• The brake pedal is not depressed.

Lane Departure Warning \*

Important Safety Reminder

Like all assistance systems, Lane Departure Warning has limitations.

Over-reliance on Lane Departure Warning may result in a collision. It is always your responsibility to keep the vehicle within your driving lane.

Lane Departure Warning only alerts you when lane drift is detected without a turn signal in use. Lane Departure Warning may not detect all lane markings or lane departures; accuracy will vary based on weather, speed and lane marker condition. It is always your responsibility to safely operate the vehicle and avoid collisions.

The Lane Departure Warning may not work properly or may work improperly under the certain conditions:

Lane Departure Warning Conditions and Limitations P. 440

How the System Activates

Lane Departure Warning may automatically shut off and the indicator comes and stays on.

Indicators P. 105

Lane Departure Warning Camera

Camera

The camera is located behind the rearview mirror.

Lane Departure Warning On and Off

Indicator Button

Press the Lane Departure Warning button to turn the system on and off.

The indicator in the button comes on when the system is on.

Lane Departure Warning Camera

Never apply a film or attach any objects to the windscreen that could obstruct the Lane Departure Warning camera's field of vision.

Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the windscreen within the Lane Departure Warning camera's field of vision can cause the system to operate abnormally. If this occurs, we recommend that you replace the windscreen with a genuine Honda replacement windscreen. Making even minor repairs within the camera's field of vision or installing an aftermarket replacement windscreen may also cause the system to operate abnormally.

After replacing the windscreen, have a dealer recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the Lane Departure Warning camera is necessary for the system to operate properly.

Do not place an object on the top of the instrument panel. It may reflect onto the windscreen and prevent the system from detecting lane lines properly.

To help to reduce the likelihood that high interior temperatures will cause the camera system to shut off, when parking, find a shady area or face the front of the vehicle away from the sun.

If you use a reflective sun shade, do not allow it to cover the camera housing. Covering the camera can concentrate heat on the camera.

Continued

Lane Departure Warning Conditions and Limitations

Lane Departure Warning may not activate or may not recognize lanes, and may activate even when keeping in the middle of a lane, under certain conditions. Some examples of these conditions are listed below.

■Environmental conditions

  • Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
  • Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
  • There is little contrast between lane lines and the roadway surface.
  • Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
    • Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
  • Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
  • Shadows of adjacent objects are parallel to lane markings.
  • Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as lane markers.
    • Reflections on the interior of the front windscreen.

Lane Departure Warning Camera

If the message appears:

  • Use the heating and cooling system */climate control system* to cool down the interior and, if necessary, the demister mode when windows are fogged.
  • Start driving the vehicle to lower the windscreen temperature, which cools down the area around the Lane Departure Warning camera.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Lane Departure Warning Camera - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car dashboard with a highlighted car component (no text or symbols visible)

If the message appears:

Park your vehicle in a safe place. Wipe away debris blocking the windscreen, then start driving again. If the message remains on even after driving for a while with the clean windscreen, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.

Roadway conditions

  • Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks, reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
  • Driving on a road with temporary lane markings.
  • Faint, multiple, or varied lane markings are visible on the roadway due to road repairs or old lane markings.
  • The roadway has merging, split, or crossing lines (e.g., such as at an intersection or crosswalk).
  • The lane markings are extremely narrow, wide, or changing.
  • The vehicle in front of you is driving near the lane lines.
  • The road is hilly or the vehicle is approaching the crest of a hill.
  • Driving on rough or unpaved roads, or over bumpy surfaces.
  • When objects on the road (curb, guard rail, pylons, etc.) are recognised as white lines (or yellow lines).
  • When driving on roads with double lines.

■Vehicle conditions

  • Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
  • The outside of the windscreen is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
  • The inside of the windscreen is fogged.
  • The camera temperature gets too hot.
  • An abnormal tyre or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction, improperly inflated, compact spare tyre ^^ , etc.).
  • The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
  • When tyre chains are installed.

Traffic Sign Recognition System\*

Reminds you of road sign information, such as the current speed limit and that overtaking is prohibited, your vehicle has just passed through, showing it on the multi-information display.

How the System Works

When the camera located behind the rearview mirror captures traffic signs while driving, the system displays the ones that are recognised as designated for your vehicle. The sign icon will be displayed for a while until the vehicle reaches a predetermined time and distance.

RR 50 23°C 002300km 0 1

The sign icon also may switch to another one or disappear when:

  • The end of speed limit or other designated limit is detected.
  • Your vehicle enters/exists motorway or highway.
  • You make a turn with a turn signal to change direction at an intersection.

Traffic Sign Recognition System \*

The system is designed to detect signs that follow the Vienna Convention standards. Not all signs may be displayed, but any signs posted on roadsides should not be ignored.

The Traffic Sign Recognition System is designed to merely provide driving assistance. The driver must still be aware of the road conditions and comply with all road regulations. Certain conditions, such as below, may disrupt the system's proper operations.

  • The upper part of the windscreen is fogged or frosted, or is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
  • Dew condensation is formed on the windscreen.

If the system does not detect any traffic signs while you are driving, the image below may appear.

23°C 002300km 01 1

Condition

• The sign is covered with dirt, snow, or frost.
• The ambient brightness is too dark.
- In bad weather (heavy rain, fog, snow, etc.)
- Faded signs
• Signs positioned on bends
- Rotated or damaged signs
- Concealed or poorly positioned signs
- When the temperature inside the system is high.
- You drive into the sunlight (e.g. at dawn or dusk).
- When the windscreen is dirty or cloudy.
- When you drive in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.

- When the windscreen is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.

- A sudden change between light and dark such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.

»Traffic Sign Recognition System \*

If the system cannot operate: 📄 appears:
- Use the heating and cooling system * /climate control system* to cool down the interior and, if necessary, the demister mode when windows are fogged.
- Start driving the vehicle to lower the windscreen temperature, which cools down the area around the system camera.

If the system cannot operate: Park your vehicle in a safe place. Wipe away debris blocking the windscreen, then start driving again. If the symbol remains on even after driving for a while with the clean windscreen, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.

If 📄 appears in amber on the multi-information display while driving, the system may have malfunctioned.

Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.

In a situation above, you may also see this icon. The system is temporarily cancelled.

23°C 002300km 0 1

* Not available on all models

Continued

Signs Displayed on the Multi-Information Display

Two traffic signs can be simultaneously displayed next to each other when detected. The speed limit sign icon is displayed on the right half of the screen. The overtaking prohibition sign icon appears on the left. Any additional sign that indicates speed limit based on weather (rain, snow, etc.) or specific period of time can appear on either side.

■When main mode is selected
Overtaking Prohibition Sign*1 23°C 002300km 50 Speed Limit Sign 1 23°C 002300km 70 Speed Limit Sign Additional Speed Limit Sign Based on Conditions*2

■When main mode is not selected
Overtaking Prohibition Sign*1 23°C 002300km 0 1° 50 Speed Limit Sign

Depending on situation, *1 can be replaced with *2, or *2 can appear on the right side.

■Selecting to display traffic signs when main mode is off

You can continue displaying reduced-size traffic sign icon on the multi-information display even while the main mode is not selected.

Customized Features P. 131

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System

VSA helps to stabilise the vehicle during cornering if the vehicle turns more or less than what was intended. It also assists in maintaining traction on slippery surfaces. It does so by regulating engine output and selectively applying the brakes.

VSA Operation

VSA System Indicator

When VSA activates, you may notice that the engine does not respond to the accelerator. You may also notice some noise from the hydraulic system. You will also see the indicator blink.

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System

The VSA may not function properly if tyre type and size are mixed. Make sure to use the same size and type of tyre, and the air pressures as specified.

When the VSA system indicator comes on and stays on while driving, there may be a problem with the system. While this may not interfere with normal driving, have your vehicle checked by a dealer immediately.

VSA cannot enhance stability in all driving situations and does not control the entire braking system. You still need to drive and corner at speeds appropriate for the conditions and always leave a sufficient margin of safety.

The Main function of the VSA system is generally known as Electronic Stability Control (ESC). The system also includes a traction control function.

VSA On and Off

VSA OFF Indicator OFF

This button is on the driver side control panel. To partially disable VSA functionality/features, press and hold it until you hear a beep.

Your vehicle will have normal braking and cornering ability, but traction control function will be less effective.

To restore VSA functionality/features, press the (VSA OFF) button until you hear a beep.

VSA is turned on every time you start the engine, even if you turned it off the last time you drove the vehicle.

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System

In certain unusual conditions when your vehicle gets stuck in shallow mud or fresh snow, it may be easier to free it with the VSA temporarily switched off.

When the button is pressed, the traction control function becomes less effective. This allows for the wheels to spin more freely at low speed. You should only attempt to free your vehicle with the VSA off if you are not able to free it when the VSA is on.

Immediately after freeing your vehicle, be sure to switch VSA on again. We do not recommend driving your vehicle with the VSA system switched off.

You may hear a motor sound coming from the engine compartment while system checks are being performed immediately after starting the engine or while driving. This is normal.

Agile Handling Assist

Lightly brakes each of the front and rear wheels, as needed, when you turn the steering wheel, and helps support the vehicle's stability and performance during cornering.

Agile Handling Assist

The agile handling assist cannot enhance stability in all driving situations. You still need to drive and corner at speeds appropriate for the conditions and always leave a sufficient margin of safety.

When the VSA system indicator comes on and stays on while driving, the agile handling assist does not activate.

You may hear a sound coming from the engine compartment while the agile handling assist is activated. This is normal.

Deflation Warning System

Instead of directly measuring the pressure in each tyre, the deflation warning system on this vehicle monitors and compares the rolling radius and rotational characteristics of each wheel and tyre while you are driving to determine if one or more tyres are significantly under-inflated. This will cause the low tyre pressure/deflation warning system indicator to come on and a message to appear on the multi-information display.

Deflation Warning System Calibration

You must start deflation warning system calibration every time you:

- Adjust the pressure in one or more tyres.

- Rotate the tyres.

- Replace one or more tyres.

Before calibrating the deflation warning system:

- Set the cold tyre pressure in all four tyres.

Make sure:

- The vehicle is at a complete stop.

Manual transmission models

• The parking brake is applied.

Continuously variable transmission models

- The shift lever is in P.

All models

- The ignition switch is in ON ^*1 .

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Deflation Warning System

The system does not monitor the tyres when driving at low speed.

Conditions such as low ambient temperature and altitude change directly affect tyre pressure and can trigger the low tyre pressure/deflation warning system indicator to come on.

Tyre pressure checked and inflated in:

  • Warm weather can become under-inflated in colder weather.
  • Cold weather can become over-inflated in warmer weather.
    The low tyre pressure indicator will not come on as a result of over inflation.

The deflation warning system may not function properly if tyre type and size are mixed.

Make sure to use the same size and type of tyre.

→ Checking and Maintaining Tyres P. 515

The low tyre pressure/deflation warning system indicator may come on with a delay or may not come on at all when:

  • You rapidly accelerate, decelerate, or turn the steering wheel.
  • You drive on snowy or slippery roads.
  • Snow chains are used.

The low tyre pressure/deflation warning system indicator may come on under the following conditions:

  • A compact spare tyre ^ is used.
  • There is a heavier and uneven load on the tyres, such as when towing a trailer, than the condition at calibration.
  • Snow chains are used.

Honda Jazz (2018) - → Checking and Maintaining Tyres P. 515 - 1

flowchart
graph TD
    A["DEL: ← 1 → Deflation Warning System\n6/8"] --> B["↓"]
    B --> C["DEL: ← 1 → Deflation Warning System\n2/2"]

You can calibrate the system from the customized features on the multi-information display.

  1. Press the button until (customize settings) appears on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.
  2. Press the button until Deflation Warning System appears on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.

The display switches to the customization setup screen, where you can select Cancel or Initialise.

  1. Press the button and select Initialise, then press the SEL/RESET button.

Completed screen appears, then the display returns to the customization menu screen.

  1. Press the button until (Exit) appears on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.

• The display returns to the normal screen.
- The calibration process finishes automatically.

Deflation Warning System Calibration

  • Deflation Warning System cannot be calibrated if a compact spare tyre * is installed.
  • The calibration process requires approximately 30 minutes of cumulative driving at speeds between 40–100 km/h (25–62 mph).
  • During this period, if the ignition switch ^1 is turned on and the vehicle is not moved within 45 seconds, you may notice the low tyre pressure indicator comes on briefly. This is normal and indicates that the calibration process is not yet complete.

If the snow chains are installed, remove them before calibrating the deflation warning system.

If the low tyre pressure/deflation warning system indicator comes on even when the properly inflated specified regular tyres are installed, have the vehicle checked by a dealer.

We recommend that the tyres be replaced with the same brand, model, and size as the originals. Ask a dealer for details.

Adjusting Headlight Distribution

Driving the right-hand type vehicle in right-hand traffic, or the left-hand type vehicle in left-hand traffic causes headlight glare to oncoming vehicles. You need to alter the headlight beam distribution using masking tape.

Models with halogen headlights
Honda Jazz (2018) - Adjusting Headlight Distribution - 1

  1. Prepare for two rectangular pieces of masking tape, measuring 24 mm (0.9 in) wide and 113 mm (4.4 in) long, and 28 mm (1.1 in) wide and 143 mm (5.6 in) long.
    ▶ Use masking tape that can shut out light, such as seal type waterproof vinyl.
  2. Affix the tape to the lens as shown.
    The label is inclined downward at 19°.

Continued

Adjusting Headlight Distribution

Be careful not to adhere the tape to an incorrect location. If the headlight beam is distributed incorrectly, it may not comply with your country's legal requirements. Ask your dealer for details.

Models with LED headlights

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with LED headlights - 1

  1. Prepare for two rectangular pieces of masking tape, measuring 89 mm (3.5 in) wide and 103 mm (4.1 in) long.
    ▶ Use masking tape that can shut out light, such as seal type waterproof vinyl.

  2. Affix the tape to the lens as shown.

Braking

Brake System

Parking Brake

Use the parking brake to keep the vehicle stationary when parking.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Parking Brake - 1

To apply:

Pull the lever fully up without pressing the release button.

To release:

  1. Pull the lever slightly, and press and hold the release button.
  2. Lower the lever down all the way, then release the button.

Parking Brake

NOTICE

Release the parking brake fully before driving. The rear brakes and axle can be damaged if you drive with the parking brake applied.

If you start driving without fully releasing the parking brake, a buzzer sounds as a warning, and 📅 appears on the multi-information display.

Always apply the parking brake when parking.

Continued

Foot Brake

Your vehicle is equipped with disc brakes at all four wheels. A vacuum power assist helps to reduce the effort needed on the brake pedal. The brake assist system increases the stopping force when you depress the brake pedal hard in an emergency situation. The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps you to retain steering control when braking very hard.

Brake Assist System P. 456
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 455

Foot Brake

Check the brakes after driving through deep water, or if there is a buildup of road surface water. If necessary, dry the brakes by lightly depressing the pedal several times.

If you hear a continuous metallic friction sound when applying the brakes, the brake pads need to be replaced. Have the vehicle checked by a dealer.

Constantly using the brake pedal while going down a long hill builds up heat, which reduces the brake effectiveness. Apply engine braking by taking your foot off the accelerator pedal and downshifting to a lower gear/speed position. With manual transmission use a lower gear for greater engine braking.

Do not rest your foot on the brake pedal while driving, as it will lightly apply the brakes and cause them to lose effectiveness over time and reduce pad life. It will also confuse drivers behind you.

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)

ABS

Helps to prevent the wheels from locking up, and helps you retain steering control by pumping the brakes rapidly, much faster than you.

The electronic brake distribution (EBD) system, which is part of the ABS, also balances the front-to-rear braking distribution according to vehicle loading.

You should never pump the brake pedal. Let the ABS work for you by always keeping firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. This is sometimes referred to as "stomp and steer."

■ABS operation

The brake pedal may pulsate slightly when the ABS is working. Keep holding the pedal firmly down. On dry pavement, you will need to press on the brake pedal very hard before the ABS activates. However, you may feel the ABS activate immediately if you are trying to stop on snow or ice.

When the vehicle speed goes under 10 km/h, the ABS stops.

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)

NOTICE

The ABS may not function if you use a tyre of the wrong size or type.

If the ABS indicator comes on while driving, there may be a problem with the system. While normal braking will not be affected, there is a possibility that the ABS will not operating. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer immediately.

The ABS is not designed for the purpose of reducing the time or distance it takes for a vehicle to stop: It is designed to limit brake lockup which can lead to skidding and loss of steering control.

In the following cases, your vehicle may need more distance to stop than a vehicle without the ABS:

- You are driving on rough or uneven road surfaces, such as gravel or snow.

- The tyres are equipped with tyre chains.

You may hear a motor sound coming from the engine compartment while system checks are being performed immediately after starting the engine or while driving. This is normal.

Brake Assist System

Brake Assist System

Is designed to assist the driver by generating greater braking force when you depress the brake pedal hard during emergency braking.

■Brake assist system operation

Press the brake pedal firmly for more powerful braking.

When brake assist operates, the pedal may wiggle slightly and an operating noise may be heard. This is normal. Keep holding the brake pedal firmly down.

City-Brake Active system

Can assist you when driving at a low speed, and there is a possibility of your vehicle colliding with a vehicle detected right in front of yours. The City-Brake Active system is designed to alert you when a potential collision is determined, as well as to reduce your vehicle speed when a collision is deemed unavoidable to help to minimise collision severity.

How the System Works

A laser sensor starts to monitor if there is a vehicle in front of you when your vehicle speed is between about 5 km/h (3 mph) and about 32 km/h (20 mph).

Laser Sensor The laser sensor is behind the rearview mirror.

The system activates when the speed difference between your vehicle and a vehicle detected in front of you is about 5 km/h (3 mph) to 32 km/h (20 mph) with a high chance of collision.

The system don't activate when shift position is R.

City-Brake Active system

WARNING

Do not rely on the city-brake active system to avoid every possible frontal collision.

Failure to pay close attention to a vehicle ahead of you, and to operate the brake pedal appropriately according to the situation can cause serious injury or death.

For the system to work properly:

• Always keep the upper part of the windscreen clean. Wipe away any dirt, ice, frost, etc.
- Do not impact the area around the laser sensor when cleaning the windscreen.
- Do not remove the laser sensor form the unit.

Manual transmission models

When the vehicle comes to a stop with the system's automatic braking, the engine may stop. To start the engine again, follow the standard procedure.

Starting the Engine P. 392, 395

Collision Alert Stages

Car dashboard screenshot with a warning sign and car icon, likely indicating vehicle safety or hazard.

The beeper sounds, and a CTBA warning blinks on the multi-information display, and hard braking is applied when a possible collision becomes likely unavoidable.

This automatic braking with the system activated is cancelled after the vehicle comes to a complete stop.

Apply the brakes accordingly.

A symbol indicating that the system has activated appears on the multi-information display after the vehicle is stopped.

Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages P. 110

The system may be cancelled if you operate the brake pedal, the accelerator pedal, or the steering wheel to avoid the collision.

City-Brake Active system

The system may not activate or may not detect a vehicle in front of your vehicle under the following conditions:

  • A vehicle in front of you is diagonally, horizontally, or frontally positioned.
  • The distance between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead of you is too short.
  • The speed difference between your vehicle and a vehicle ahead of you is large.
  • A vehicle cuts in front of you, and brakes suddenly.
  • You rapidly accelerate your vehicle, getting closer to a vehicle ahead.
  • An oncoming vehicle suddenly drifts in front of you.
  • Your vehicle suddenly drifts into the oncoming lane.
  • A vehicle suddenly crosses in front of you at intersections.
  • When driving in bad weather (heavy rain, fog, snow, etc.).
  • When driving on a curved or winding road.
  • A vehicle in front of you is extremely dirty, making it difficult to reflect radio waves well.
  • You depress the brake pedal or turn the steering wheel to avoid a collision.
  • A vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle or other small vehicle the sensor cannot detect properly.
  • The upper part of the windscreen around the laser sensor is covered with dirt, ice frost, etc.

The system may not activate while you are fully depressing the accelerator pedal.

The System On and Off

CTBA ON 1/3

You can turn the system on and off using the multi-information display.

→Customized Features P. 131

When the system is off, the CTBA indicator in the instrument panel comes on.

The City-Brake Active system is turned on every time you start the engine, even if you turned it off the last time you drove the vehicle.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Continued

City-Brake Active system

The system may automatically shut off, and the CTBA indicator can come on and the message can appear on the multi-information display when:

  • The temperature around the laser sensor on the upper part of the windscreen becomes high.
  • The area around the laser sensor, which is located in the upper part of the windscreen, is covered with obstacles, such as dirt, ice and frost.
  • The bonnet is covered with obstacles such as snow.

Stop your vehicle in a safe place, and

  • Use the air conditioning system to cool down the interior if the laser sensor temperature is high.
  • Remove any obstacles such as dirt and snow from the windscreen and bonnet.

Indicators P. 106

Once the conditions that caused the system to shut off improve, the system comes back on.

Turn off the system when:

  • You use a dynamometer or put the wheels on a roller.
  • Driving off road or on a mountainous road obstructed with branches and leaves.

With Little Chance of a Collision

The system may activate even when you are aware of a vehicle ahead of you, or when there is no vehicle ahead. Some examples of this are:

■When passing

Your vehicle approaches another vehicle ahead of you and you change lanes to pass.

■At an intersection

Your vehicle approaches or passes another vehicle that is making a left or right turn.

■Through a low bridge

You drive under a low or narrow bridge.

■ Speed bumps, road work sites, train tracks, roadside objects, etc.

You drive over speed bumps, steel road plates, etc., or your vehicle approaches train tracks or roadside objects, such as a traffic sign and guard rail, on a curve.

■When parking

Your vehicle approaches a stationary vehicle or wall.

City-Brake Active system

Take your vehicle to a dealer if you need the laser sensor or area around it to be repaired, or removed, or the area around the laser sensor is strongly impacted.

Do not alter your vehicle's suspension. Changing the vehicle height prevents the system to work properly.

Make sure to use the same size and type of tyre for all four wheels. Use the tyres that are all in about the same condition with adequate tread. If not, the system may operate abnormally.

The system may not work properly if:

  • Your vehicle has heavy load in the rear.
  • Tyres are over- or underinflated.

About the Laser Equipped in the System

Laser Sensor

The City-Brake Active system unit, including the laser sensor, is located behind the rearview mirror.

Following lists the classified specifications of the laser used in this system according to the IEC requirements. The same information can be found in the IEC60825-1 standard labels.

Laser classification

Max average power: 45 mW

Pulse duration: 33 ns

Wavelength: 905 nm

Average power angle 28 × 12

(horizontal × vertical)

Laser Classification Label Laser Explanation Label

INVISIBLE LASER RADIATION

DO NOT VIEW DIRECTLY WITH

OPTICAL INSTRUMENTS (MAGNIFIERS)

CLASS 1M LASER PRODUCT

Max average power: 45 mW

Pulse duration: 33 ns

Wavelength: 905 nm

IEC 60825-1:2007

Complies with FDA performance standards for laser products

except for deviations pursuant to Laser Notice No. 50, dated

July 26 ^th , 2001

About the Laser Equipped in the System

WARNING

Handling the laser sensor improperly can lead to eye injury.

To avoid eye injury, Keep the following:

  • Do not take the sensor apart from the unit.
  • Never look at the sensor within a 100 mm distance using an optical device, such as a magnified glass, microscopes, and an object lens.

Emergency Stop Signal

Activates when you brake hard while driving at 60 km/h (37 mph) or above to alert drivers behind you about sudden braking by rapidly flashing hazard warning lights. This may help to alert drivers behind you to take appropriate means to avoid a possible collision with your vehicle.

■When the system activates:
① Hard Braking ① Brake Lights Come On ② Hazard Warning Lights Flash ② Hazard Warning Indicators Blink

The hazard warning lights stop flashing when:

  • You release the brake pedal.
    • The ABS is deactivated.
  • Your vehicle's decelerating speed becomes moderate.
  • You press the hazard warning button.

Emergency Stop Signal

The emergency stop signal is not a system that can prevent a possible rear-end collision caused by your hard braking. It flashes the hazard warning lights at the time you are braking hard. It is always recommended to avoid hard braking unless it is absolutely necessary.

The emergency stop signal does not activate with the hazard warning button pressed in.

If the ABS stops working for a certain period during braking, the emergency stop signal may not activate at all.

Parking Your Vehicle

When Stopped

  1. Depress the brake pedal firmly.
  2. Firmly apply the parking brake.
    Continuously variable transmission models
  3. Move the shift lever from D to P.

Manual transmission models

  1. Move the shift lever to R or 1.

  2. Turn off the engine.

Always set the parking brake firmly, in particular if you are parked on an incline.

Parking Your Vehicle

Do not park your vehicle near flammable objects, such as dry grass, oil, or timber. Heat from the exhaust can cause a fire.

When Stopped

NOTICE

Continuously variable transmission models

The following can damage the transmission

  • Depressing the accelerator and brake pedals simultaneously.
  • Holding the vehicle in place when facing uphill by depressing the accelerator pedal.
  • Moving the shift lever into P before the vehicle stops completely.

Raise the wiper arms when snow is expected.

In extremely cold temperatures, the parking brake may freeze up if applied. If such temperatures are expected, do not apply the parking brake but, if parking on a slope, either turn the front wheels so they will contact the curb if the vehicle rolls down the slope or block the wheels to keep the vehicle from moving. If you do not take either precaution, the vehicle may roll unexpectedly, leading to a crash.

Parking Sensor System\*

The corner and centre sensors monitor obstacles around your vehicle, and the beeper and multi-information display and audio/information screen * let you know the approximate distance between your vehicle and the obstacle.

■The sensor location and range
Front Corner Sensors Rear Corner Sensors Rear Centre Sensors Within about 60 cm (24 in) or less Within about 110 cm (43 in) or less

Parking Sensor System \*

Even when the system is on, always confirm if there is no obstacle near your vehicle before parking.

The system may not work properly when:

  • The sensors are covered with snow, ice mud or dirt.
  • The vehicle is on uneven surface, such as grass, bumps, or a hill.
    • The vehicle has been out in hot or cold weather.
  • The system is affected by devices that emit ultrasonic waves.
  • Driving in bad weather.

The system may not sense:

  • Thin or low objects.
  • Sonic-absorptive materials, such as snow, cotton, or sponge.
  • Objects directly under the bumper.

Do not put any accessories on or around the sensors.

■Parking sensor system on and off

Peta

With the ignition switch in ON [Ⅱ]^*1 , press the parking sensor system button to turn on or off the system. The indicator in the button comes on when the system is on.

The front corner sensors start to detect an obstacle when the shift lever is in any position other than P or R, and the vehicle speed is less than 8 km/h (5 mph).

The front corner, rear corner and rear centre sensors start to detect an obstacle when the shift lever is in [R], and the vehicle speed is less than less than 8 km/h (5 mph).

Manual transmission models

You also need to release the parking brake.

Parking sensor system on and off

The parking sensor system is in the previously selected on or off setting each time you start the engine.

■ When the distance between your vehicle and obstacles becomes shorter

Models with multi-view rear camera

Length of the intermittent beepDistance between the Bumper and ObstacleIndicator Audio/information screen
Corner Sensors Centre Sensors
Moderate —About 110-60 cm (43-24 inches)Blinks in Yellow*1Honda Jazz (2018) - ■ When the distance between your vehicle and obstacles becomes shorter - 1
ShortAbout 60-45 cm (24-18 inches)About 60-45 cm (24-18 inches)Blinks in Amber
Very shortAbout 45-35 cm (18-14 inches)About 45-35 cm (18-14 inches)
ContinuousAbout 35 cm (14 inches) or lessAbout 35 cm (14 inches) or lessBlinks in RedHonda Jazz (2018) - ■ When the distance between your vehicle and obstacles becomes shorter - 2

*1: At this stage, only the centre sensors detect obstacles.

Models without multi-view rear camera

Length of the intermittent beepDistance between the Bumper and ObstacleIndicator Multi-information display
Corner Sensors Centre Sensors
Moderate*1About 110-60 cm (43-24 inches)
ShortAbout 60-45 cm (24-18 inches)About 60-45 cm (24-18 inches)
Very shortAbout 45-35 cm (18-14 inches)About 45-35 cm (18-14 inches)
ContinuousAbout 35 cm (14 inches) or lessAbout 35 cm (14 inches) or less

Indicators: Where the sensor detects an obstacle lights.
*1: At this stage, only the centre sensors detect obstacles.

■Rearview screen with parking sensor

When the distance between your vehicle and obstacle behind becomes shorter, the audio/information screen, and display audio screen ^* displays the parking sensor indicators.

Turning off All Rear Sensors

  1. Make sure that the parking sensor system is not activated. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0 ^4 .
  2. Press and hold the parking sensor system button, and turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 .
  3. Keep pressing the button for 10 seconds. Release the button when the indicator in the button flashes.
  4. Press the button again. The indicator in the button goes off. ▶ The beeper sounds twice. The rear sensors are now turned off.

To turn the rear sensors on again, follow the above procedure. The beeper sounds three times when the rear sensors come back on.

>>Turning off All Rear Sensors

When you shift to R, the indicator in the parking sensor system button blinks as a reminder that the rear sensors have been turned off.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Multi-View Rear Camera\*

About Your Multi-View Rear Camera

The audio/information screen can display your vehicle's rear view. The display automatically changes to the rear view when the transmission is put into R.

Multi-View Rear Camera Display Area
Tailgate open range Approx. 3 m (9.8 ft.) Approx. 2 m (6.6 ft.) Approx. 1 m (3.3 ft.) Approx. 50 cm (1.7 ft.) Guidelines BumperCamera Wide View Mode Normal View Mode Top Down View Mode

»About Your Multi-View Rear Camera

The rear camera view is restricted. You cannot see the corner ends of the bumper or what is underneath the bumper. Its unique lens also makes objects appear closer or farther than they actually are.

Visually confirm that it is safe to drive before backing up. Certain conditions (such as weather, lighting, and high temperatures) may also restrict the rear view. Do not rely on the rearview display which does not give you all information about conditions at the back of your vehicle.

If the camera lens is covered with dirt or moisture, use a soft, moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free of debris.

You can change the Fixed Guideline and Dynamic Guideline settings.

Customized Features P. 313

Fixed Guideline

On: Guidelines appear when you put the transmission into [R].

Off: Guidelines do not appear.

Dynamic Guideline

On: Guidelines move according to the steering wheel direction.

Off: Guidelines do not move.

You can view three different camera angles on the rearview display. Touch the appropriate icon to switch the angle.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Dynamic Guideline - 1

Wide view

Normal view

: Top down view

  • If the last used viewing mode was Wide or Normal, the same mode is selected the next time you put the transmission into .
  • If Top down view was last used before you turned off the engine, Wide View mode is selected next time you set the power mode to ON and put the transmission into R.
  • If Top down view was last used more than 10 seconds after you put the transmission out of , Wide View mode is selected the next time you put the transmission into .

You can also change the rear camera setting by selecting [Menu] when your vehicle's rear view is displayed. When you select [Menu] (Menu) and select Display, the following items are available in additional:

  • Display tab: Adjusts Brightness, Contrast, and Black Level of the rear camera screen.
  • Colour tab: Adjusts Colour and Tint of the rear camera screen.

Refueling

Fuel Information

■Fuel recommendation

Unleaded premium petrol/gasohol up to E10 (90% petrol and 10% ethanol), research octane number 95 or higher

Your vehicle is designed to operate on premium unleaded petrol with a research octane of 95 or higher. If this octane grade is unavailable, regular unleaded petrol with a research octane of 91 or higher may be used temporarily.

The use of regular unleaded petrol can cause metallic knocking noises in the engine and will result in decreased engine performance. The long-term use of regular-grade petrol can lead to engine damage.

■Fuel tank capacity: 40 litres (8.8 Imp gal)

»Fuel Information

NOTICE

Use of petrol that contains lead presents the following risks:

  • Damage to the exhaust system including the catalytic converter
    • Damage to the engine and fuel system
  • Detrimental effects on the engine and other systems

RON ROZ 95 MINIMUM E5 E10

Oxygenated Fuels

Oxygenated fuels are blended with petrol and ethanol or other compounds. Your vehicle is also designed to operate on oxygenated fuels containing up to 10% ethanol by volume and up to 22% ETBE by volume, based on the EN 228 standards. For more information, ask your dealer.

How to Refuel

Fuel Fill Door Release Handle Pull

Cap

Cap Holder

  1. Stop your vehicle with the service station pump on the left side of the vehicle in the rear.
  2. Turn off the engine.
  3. Pull on the fuel fill door release handle under the dashboard at the driver's side.

The fuel fill door opens.

  1. Remove the fuel fill cap slowly. If you hear a release of air, wait until this stops, then turn the knob slowly to open the fuel fill cap.

  2. Place the fuel fill cap in the holder.

  3. Insert the fuel filler nozzle fully.

When the tank is full, the filler nozzle will click off automatically. This leaves space in the fuel tank in case the fuel expands with a change in the temperature.

  1. After filling, replace the fuel fill cap, tightening it until you hear it click at least once.

▶Shut the fuel fill door by hand.

How to Refuel

WARNING

Petrol is highly flammable and explosive. You can be burned or seriously injured when handling fuel.

  • Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks, and flame away.
  • Handle fuel only outdoors.
  • Wipe up spills immediately.

Do not continue to add fuel after the filler nozzle has automatically stopped. Additional fuel can exceed the full tank capacity.

The filler nozzle automatically stops to leave space in the fuel tank so that fuel does not overflow as a result of changes in air temperature.

Fuel Economy and CO₂ Emissions

Improving Fuel Economy and Reducing CO₂ Emissions

Achieving fuel economy and reducing CO_2 emissions is dependent on several factors, including driving conditions, load weight, idling time, driving habits, and vehicle condition. Depending on these and other factors, you may not achieve the rated fuel economy of this vehicle.

Maintenance and Fuel Economy

You can optimize your fuel economy with proper maintenance of your vehicle. Follow the maintenance schedule and, if necessary, consult your warranty booklet. On vehicles without service reminder system, follow the Maintenance schedule.

→Maintenance Schedule \* P. 484

  • Use engine oil with the viscosity recommended by the ACEA or API Certification Seal.
  • Maintain the specified tyre pressure.
  • Do not load the vehicle with excess luggage.
  • Keep your vehicle clean. A buildup of snow or mud on your vehicle's underside adds weight and increases wind resistance.

Improving Fuel Economy and Reducing CO₂ Emissions

Direct calculation is the recommended method to determine actual fuel consumed while driving.

100 × Litres of fuel ÷ Kilometres driven = L per 100 km Miles driven ÷ Gallons of fuel = Miles per Gallon

Maintenance

This chapter discusses basic maintenance.

Before Performing Maintenance

Inspection and Maintenance 476

Safety When Performing Maintenance..... 477

Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance

Service 478

Service Reminder System 479

Maintenance Schedule ^* 484

Maintenance Record (On vehicles without

Service Book) 487

Maintenance Under the Bonnet

Maintenance Items Under the Bonnet..... 488

Opening the Bonnet 489

Recommended Engine Oil 490

Oil Check 492

Adding Engine Oil 493

Engine Coolant 494

Transmission Fluid 496

Brake/Clutch * Fluid 497

Refilling Window Washer Fluid...... 498

Fuel Filter 498

Replacing Light Bulbs 499

Checking and Maintaining Wiper

Blades 511

Checking and Maintaining Tyres

Checking Tyres 515

Wear Indicators.... 517

Tyre Service Life 517

Tyre and Wheel Replacement..... 518

Tyre Rotation 519

Snow Traction Devices 520

Battery 522

Remote Transmitter Care

Replacing the Button Battery ..... 527

Heating and Cooling System ^* /Climate Control

System * Maintenance....529

Cleaning

Interior Care 532

Exterior Care.... 534

Accessories and Modifications ..... 537

Accessories 537

Modifications.... 537

Before Performing Maintenance

Inspection and Maintenance

For your safety, perform all listed inspections and maintenance to keep your vehicle in good condition. If you become aware of any abnormality (noise, smell, insufficient brake fluid, oil residue on the ground, etc.), have your vehicle inspected by a dealer. Refer to the Service Book that came with your vehicle/maintenance schedule in this owner's manual for detailed maintenance and inspection information.

→Maintenance Schedule * P. 484

Types of Inspection and Maintenance

■Daily inspections

Perform inspections before long distance trips, when washing the vehicle, or when refueling.

■Periodic inspections

  • Check the brake fluid level monthly.
    Brake/Clutch * Fluid P. 497
  • Check the tyre pressure monthly. Examine the tread for wear and foreign objects.
    → Checking and Maintaining Tyres P. 515
  • Check the operation of the exterior lights monthly.
    → Replacing Light Bulbs P. 499
  • Check the condition of the wiper blades at least every six months.
    ▶ Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 511

Safety When Performing Maintenance

Some of the most important safety precautions are given here.

However, we cannot warn you of every conceivable hazard that can arise in performing maintenance. Only you can decide whether you should perform a given task.

Maintenance Safety

  • To reduce the possibility of fire or explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks, and flames away from the battery and all fuel related parts.
  • Never leave rags, towels, or other flammable objects under the bonnet.
    ▶ Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite them, causing a fire.
  • To clean parts, use a commercially available degreaser or parts cleaner, not petrol.
  • Wear eye protection and protective clothing when working with the battery or compressed air.
    • Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide, which is poisonous and can kill you.
    ▶ Only operate the engine if there is sufficient ventilation.

Vehicle Safety

  • The vehicle must be in a stationary condition.
    ▶ Make sure your vehicle is parked on level ground, the parking brake is set, and the engine is off.
  • Be aware that hot parts can burn you.
    ▶ Make sure to let the engine and exhaust system cool thoroughly before touching vehicle parts.
  • Be aware that moving parts can injure you.
    ▶ Do not start the engine unless instructed, and keep your hands and limbs away from moving parts.
    ▶ Do not open the bonnet while the Auto Idle Stop function is activated.

Safety When Performing Maintenance

WARNING

Improperly maintaining this vehicle or failing to correct a problem before driving can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed.

Always follow the inspection and maintenance recommendations and schedules in this owner's manual/Service Book.

WARNING

Failure to properly follow maintenance instructions and precautions can cause you to be seriously hurt or killed.

Always follow the procedures and precautions in this owner's manual.

Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service

The use of Honda genuine parts and fluids is recommended when maintaining and servicing your vehicle. Honda genuine parts are manufactured according to the same high quality standards used in Honda vehicles.

About Your Maintenance Service

If the service reminder system is available in your vehicle, you are informed by the multi-information display when your vehicle's maintenance services are due. Refer to Service Book that came with your vehicle for an explanation of the service item codes that appear on the display.

Service Reminder System P. 479

If the service reminder system is not available, follow the maintenance schedules in the Service Book that came with your vehicle.

If your vehicle is without the Service Book, follow the maintenance schedule in this owner's manual.

→Maintenance Schedule * P. 484

About Your Maintenance Service

Models with service reminder system

If you are planning to take your vehicle outside the service reminder system applied countries, consult a dealer for how to record your service reminder information and schedule your maintenance service under the conditions of that country.

Service Reminder System

Provides information of which service items are to be performed. Service items are represented by a code and icon. The system tells you when to take your vehicle to a dealer by days remaining.

When the next maintenance service timing is near, coming or passed, a warning icon will also appear on the multi-information display every time you turn the ignition switch to ON [Ⅲ]^*1 .

Service Reminder System

You can choose to have a corresponding warning message displayed with the warning icon on the multi-information display.

The maintenance schedule may not display correct information if you disconnect the battery for an extended period. If this occurs, see a dealer.

Continued

Displaying the Service Reminder Information

  1. Turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1 .
  2. Press the ▲i/▼ (information) button repeatedly until the maintenance item(s) appears on the multi-information display.

Maintenance Item Code(s) 2 150 °★ 823 29 °★ ▲①/▼ Button: Changes the customize menus and items. SEL/RESET Button: Enters the selected item.

The system message indicator (① comes on along with the service reminder Information.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

▶ Displaying the Service Reminder Information

Based on engine operating conditions and engine oil conditions, the system calculates the remaining days before the next service is to be performed.

823 15 % Remaining Days Day Icon

Warning Icons and Service Reminder Information on the Multi-Information Display

Warning Icon (Amber)Service Reminder InformationExplanationInformation
SERVICE DUE SOON Honda Jazz (2018) - ▶ Displaying the Service Reminder Information - 2One or more of the service items Honda Jazz (2018) - ▶ Displaying the Service Reminder Information - 3are required in less than 30 days. The remaining days are estimated based on your driving conditions.The remaining days will be counted down per day.
SERVICE DUE NOW Honda Jazz (2018) - ▶ Displaying the Service Reminder Information - 4One or more of the service items Honda Jazz (2018) - ▶ Displaying the Service Reminder Information - 5are required in less than 10 days. The remaining days are estimated based on your driving conditions.Have the indicated service performed as soon as possible.
SERVICE OVER DUE Honda Jazz (2018) - ▶ Displaying the Service Reminder Information - 6The indicated maintenance Honda Jazz (2018) - ▶ Displaying the Service Reminder Information - 7service is still not done after the remaining days reach 0.Your vehicle has passed the service required point. Immediately have the service performed and make sure to reset the service reminder system.

Service Reminder Items

Service items displayed on the multi-information display are in code and icon. For an explanation of the service reminder codes and icons, refer to the Service Book that came with your vehicle.

■Availability of the Service Reminder System

Even if the service reminder information appears on the multi-information display while pressing the Information) button, this system is not available in some countries. Refer to Service Book that came with your vehicle, or ask a dealer if you can use the service reminder system.

Availability of the Service Reminder System

If you are planning to take your vehicle outside the service reminder system applied countries, consult a dealer on how to record your service reminder information and schedule your maintenance service under the conditions of that country.

Resetting the Display

Reset the service reminder information display if you have performed the maintenance service.

Maintenance Info. 6/18 Maintenance Reset All Due Items 10:12:45:705 2/15 ▲/▼ Button: Changes the customize menus and items. SEL/RESET Button: Enters the selected item.

  1. Turn the ignition switch to ON ^*1
  2. Press the ▲①/▼ button until □ (customize settings) appears on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.
  3. Press the ▲/▼ button until Maintenance Info. appears on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.
  4. Press the ▲①/▼ button and select the reset information on the display, then press the SEL/RESET button.
    ▶The service code will disappear.

To cancel the service reminder information reset mode, select Cancel, then press the SEL/RESET button.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

>>Resetting the Display

NOTICE

Failure to reset the service reminder information after a maintenance service results in the system showing incorrect maintenance intervals, which can lead to serious mechanical problems.

The dealer will reset the service reminder information display after completing the required maintenance service. If someone other than a dealer performs maintenance service, reset the service reminder information display yourself.

Maintenance Schedule\*

If your vehicle comes with the Service Book, the maintenance schedule for your vehicle is available in the book. For vehicles without the Service Book, refer to the following maintenance schedule.

The maintenance schedule outlines the minimum required maintenance that you should perform to ensure the troublefree operation of your vehicle. Due to regional and climatic differences, some additional servicing may be required. Please consult your warranty booklet for a more detailed description.

Maintenance work should be performed by properly trained and equipped technicians. Your authorised dealer meets all of these requirements.

Models without Service Book

Service at the indicated distance or time - whichever comes first.km x 1,00020406080100120140160180200
miles x 1,00012.525.037.550.062.575.087.5100.0112.5125.0
months 12 24 36 4860728496108120
Replace engine oil*1Normal Every 10,000 km (6,000 miles) or 1 year
Severe*3Every 5,000 km (3,000 miles) or 6 months
Replace engine oil filter*1Normal Every 20,000 km (12,500 miles) or 2 years
Severe*3Every 10,000 km (6,000 miles) or 1 year
Replace air cleaner element Every 30,000 km (18,500 miles)
Inspect valve clearance*4Every 120,000 km (75,000 miles)
Replace fuel filter*2
Replace spark plugsEvery 100,000 km (62,500 miles)
Inspect drive belts

*1: Only severe schedule is required in some countries: refer to the local warranty booklet that came with your vehicle.
*2:Refer to page 498 for replacement information under severe driving conditions.
*3:Refer to page 486 for replacement information under severe conditions.
*4:Sensory Method. Adjust the valves during services 120,000 km if there are noisy.

Service at the indicated distance or time - whichever comes first.km x 1,00020406080100120140160180200
miles x 1,00012.525.037.550.062.575.087.5100.0112.5125.0
months 12 24 36 4860728496108120
Replace engine coolant At 200,000 km (125,000 miles) or 10 years,thereafter every 100,000 km (62,500 miles) or 5 years
Replace transmission fluidMT NormalEvery 120,000 km (75,000 miles) or 6 years
Severe*1
CVT
Inspect front and rear brakesEvery 10,000 km (6,000 miles) or 6 months
Replace brake fluidEvery 3 years
Check parking brake adjustment
Replace dust and pollen filter
Check expiry date for TRK bottle*Every year
Rotate tyres (Check tyre inflation and condition at least once per month)Every 10,000 km (6,000 miles)
Visually inspect the following items:
Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and bootsSuspension componentsDriveshaft bootsEvery 10,000 km (6,000 miles) or 6 months
Brake hoses and lines (including ABS)All fluid levels and condition of fluidExhaust systemFuel lines and connections

*1:Refer to page 486 for replacement information under severe conditions.

If you drive your vehicle under severe conditions, you must have the following items served to the maintenance schedule indicated as Severe.

Items Condition

Engine oil and filter A, B, C, D and E

Transmission fluid B and D

>>Maintenance Schedule\*

The condition is considered as severe when you drive:

A. Less than 8 km (5 miles), or less than 16 km (10 miles) in freezing temperatures per trip.
B. In extremely hot temperature above 35°C.
C. With extensive idling or long periods of stop-and-go.
D. Towing trailer, loaded roof rack, or in mountains.
E. On muddy, dusty or de-iced roads.

Maintenance Record (On vehicles without Service Book)

Have your servicing dealer record all required maintenance below. Keep receipts for all work done on your vehicle.

Km (Mi.) or Month Date Sign or Stamp
20,000 km12,500 Mi. (or 12 Mo.)
40,000 km25,000 Mi. (or 24 Mo.)
60,000 km37,500 Mi. (or 36 Mo.)
80,000 km50,000 Mi. (or 48 Mo.)
100,000 km62,500 Mi. (or 60 Mo.)
120,000 km75,000 Mi. (or 72 Mo.)
140,000 km87,500 Mi. (or 84 Mo.)
160,000 km100,000 Mi. (or 96 Mo.)
180,000 km112,500 Mi. (or 108 Mo.)
200,000 km125,000 Mi. (or 120 Mo.)

Maintenance Under the Bonnet

Maintenance Items Under the Bonnet
Engine Oil Fill Cap Left-hand drive type Brake/Clutch* Fluid (Black Cap) Engine Oil Dipstick (Orange) Right-hand drive type Brake/Clutch* Fluid (Black Cap) Battery Washer Fluid (Blue Cap) Engine Coolant Reserve Tank Radiator Cap

Opening the Bonnet

Pull Bonnet Release Handle

Lever

Grip Support Rod Clamp

  1. Park the vehicle on a level surface, and set the parking brake.

  2. Pull the bonnet release handle under the driver's side lower outside corner of the dashboard.

▶The bonnet will pop up slightly.

  1. Push the bonnet latch lever (located under the front edge of the bonnet to the centre) to the side and raise the bonnet. Once you have raised the bonnet slightly, you can release the lever.

  2. Remove the support rod from the clamp using the grip. Mount the support rod in the bonnet.

When closing, remove the support rod, and stow it in the clamp, then gently lower the bonnet. Remove your hand at a height of approximately 30 cm (12 inches) and let the bonnet close.

Opening the Bonnet

NOTICE

Do not open the bonnet when the wiper arms are raised.

The bonnet will strike the wipers, resulting in damage to the bonnet and/or the wipers.

When closing the bonnet, check that the bonnet is securely latched.

If the bonnet latch lever moves stiffly, or if you can open the bonnet without lifting the lever, the latch mechanism should be cleaned and lubricated.

Do not open the bonnet while the Auto Idle Stop function is activated.

Oil is a major contributor to your engine's performance and longevity. If you drive the vehicle with insufficient or deteriorated oil, the engine may fail or be damaged.

European models

  • Honda ENG Oil #1.0
  • Honda Green Oil
  • ACEA A5/B5

★HONDA ENG OIL #1.0, Honda Green oil. 0W-20 Ambient Temperature

Use a Genuine Honda Motor oil or another commercial engine oil of suitable viscosity for the ambient temperature as shown.

Honda ENG Oil #1.0 oil is formulated to improve fuel economy.

If Honda ENG Oil #1.0, Honda Green Oil, or 0W-20 is not available, use 5W-30 or 0W-30.

Engine Oil Additives

Your vehicle does not require oil additives. In fact, they may adversely affect the engine performance and durability.

ACEA viscosity oil is available for European models only.

Except European models

• Genuine Honda Motor Oil

- API service SM or higher grade fuel-efficient oil

0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-30 10W-30 Ambient Temperature -30 -20 0 10 20 30 40°C

Use a Genuine Honda Motor oil or another commercial engine oil of suitable viscosity for the ambient temperature as shown.

OW-20 oil is formulated to improve fuel economy.

Oil Check

We recommend that you check the engine oil level every time you refuel. Park the vehicle on level ground.

Wait approximately three minutes after turning the engine off before you check the oil.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Oil Check - 1

natural_image Close-up mechanical assembly showing internal components and a highlighted valve (no visible text or symbols)
  1. Remove the dipstick (orange).
  2. Wipe the dipstick with a clean cloth or paper towel.
  3. Insert the dipstick back all the way into its hole.

Upper Mark Lower Mark

  1. Remove the dipstick again, and check the level. It should be between the upper and lower marks. Add oil if necessary.

Oil Check

If the oil level is near or below the lower mark, slowly add oil, being careful not to overfill.

The amount of oil consumed depends on how the vehicle is driven and the climatic and road conditions encountered. The rate of oil consumption can be up to 1 litre per 1,000 km/625 miles.

Consumption is likely to be higher when the engine is new.

Adding Engine Oil

Engine Oil Fill Cap

  1. Unscrew and remove the engine oil fill cap.
  2. Add oil slowly.
  3. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, and tighten it securely.
  4. Wait for three minutes and recheck the engine oil dipstick.

>>Adding Engine Oil

NOTICE

Do not fill the engine oil above the upper mark. Overfilling the engine oil can result in leaks and engine damage.

If any oil spills, wipe it up immediately. Spilled oil may damage the engine compartment components.

Engine Coolant

Specified coolant: Honda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2

This coolant is premixed with 50% antifreeze and 50% water. Do not add any straight antifreeze or water.

We recommend you check the engine coolant level every time you refuel. Check the reserve tank first. If it is completely empty, also check the coolant level in the radiator. Add the engine coolant accordingly.

Reserve Tank
Honda Jazz (2018) - Specified coolant: Honda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2 - 1

  1. Make sure the engine and radiator are cool.
  2. Check the amount of coolant in the reserve tank.

▶ If the coolant level is below the MIN mark, add the specified coolant until it reaches the MAX mark.

  1. Inspect the cooling system for leaks.

Engine Coolant

WARNING

Removing the radiator cap while the engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray out, seriously scalding you.

Always let the engine and radiator cool down before removing the radiator cap.

If temperatures consistently below -30°C are expected, the coolant mixture should be changed to a higher concentration. Consult your Honda dealer for details about a suitable coolant mixture.

If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may use another major brand non-silicate coolant as a temporary replacement. Check that it is a high quality coolant recommended for aluminium engines. Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result in corrosion, causing the cooling system to malfunction or fail. Have the cooling system flushed and refilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as possible.

Do not add rust inhibitors or other additives to your vehicle's cooling system. They may not be compatible with the coolant or with the engine components.

Radiator

Radiator Cap

  1. Make sure the engine and radiator are cool.
  2. Turn the radiator cap 1/8 turn anticlockwise and allow any pressure in the cooling system to release. Do not push the cap down when turning.
  3. Push down and turn the radiator cap anticlockwise to remove it.
  4. The coolant level should be up to the base of the filler neck. Add coolant if it is low.
  5. Put the radiator cap back on, and tighten it fully.

>>Radiator

NOTICE

Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill any. Clean up any spills immediately; they can damage components in the engine compartment.

Transmission Fluid

Continuously variable transmission models

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) Fluid

Specified fluid: Honda HCF-2 Transmission Fluid

Have a dealer check the fluid level and replace if necessary.

Follow your vehicle's maintenance service timing of when to change continuously variable transmission (CVT) fluid.

Service Reminder System P. 479

→Maintenance Schedule * P. 484

Do not attempt to check or change the continuously variable transmission (CVT) fluid yourself.

Manual transmission models

Manual Transmission Fluid

Specified fluid: Honda Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF)

Have a dealer check the fluid level and replace if necessary.

Follow your vehicle's maintenance service timing of when to change manual transmission fluid.

Service Reminder System P. 479

→Maintenance Schedule * P. 484

Do not attempt to check or change the manual transmission fluid yourself.

Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT) Fluid

NOTICE

Do not mix Honda HCF-2 transmission fluid with other transmission fluids.

Using a transmission fluid other than Honda HCF-2 transmission fluid may adversely affect the operation and durability of your vehicle's transmission, and damage the transmission.

Any damage caused by using a transmission fluid that is not equivalent to Honda HCF-2 transmission fluid is not covered by Honda's new vehicle limited warranty.

Manual Transmission Fluid

If Honda MTF is not available, you may use the API certificated SAE 0W-20 or 5W-20 viscosity motor oil as a temporary measure.

Replace with MTF as soon as possible. Motor oil does not contain the proper additives for the transmission and continued use can cause decreased shifting performance and lead to transmission damage.

Brake/Clutch\* Fluid

Specified fluid: Brake Fluid with DOT 3 or DOT 4

Use the same fluid for both the brakes and clutch.

Checking the Brake Fluid
Reserve Tank MAX MIN MIN

The fluid level should be between the MIN and MAX marks on the side of the reserve tank.

Manual transmission models

The brake fluid reserve tank is also used for your vehicle's clutch fluid. As long as you keep the brake fluid level as instructed above, there is no need for checking the clutch fluid level.

Brake/Clutch \* Fluid

NOTICE

Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not compatible with your vehicle's braking system and can cause extensive damage.

We recommend using a genuine product.

If the brake fluid level is at or below the MIN mark, have a dealer inspect the vehicle for leaks or worn brake pads as soon as possible.

Refilling Window Washer Fluid

Check the amount of window washer fluid by looking at the reservoir. If the level is low, fill the washer reservoir.

Window Washer Reservoir

Pour the washer fluid carefully. Do not overflow the reservoir.

Fuel Filter

Replace fuel filter according to the time and distance recommendations in the maintenance schedule.

Models without Service Book

It is recommended to replace the fuel filter every 40,000 km (25,000 miles), or two years, if you suspect the fuel you are using is contaminated. In a dusty environment, the filter may become clogged sooner.

All models

Have a qualified technician change the fuel filter. Fuel in the system can spray out and create a hazard if all fuel line connections are not handled correctly.

Refilling Window Washer Fluid

NOTICE

Do not use engine antifreeze or a vinegar/water solution in the windscreen washer reservoir. Antifreeze can damage your vehicle's paint. A vinegar/water solution can damage the windscreen washer pump.

Use only commercially available windscreen washer fluid. Avoid prolonged use of hard water to prevent lime scale build up.

Replacing Light Bulbs

Headlight Bulbs

When replacing, use the following bulbs.

Models with halogen high beam and low beam headlights

High/Low beam headlight: 60/55 W (H4LL/HB2LL*, H4 LL, H4 for halogen bulb type)

Models with LED high beam and low beam headlights

High beam headlight: LED type Low beam headlight: LED type

High/Low Beam Headlight\*

Coupler Rubber Weather Seal

  1. Remove the coupler.
  2. Remove the rubber weather seal.

Hold-Down Wire

  1. Remove the hold-down wire, then remove the bulb.
  2. Insert a new bulb.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Headlight Bulbs

NOTICE

Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on the glass can cause the bulb to overheat and shatter.

The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry heavy items in the luggage area or tow a trailer, have the aiming readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified technician.

When replacing a halogen bulb, handle it by its base, and protect the glass from contact with your skin or hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.

Models with LED high beam and low beam headlights

High beam and low beam headlights are LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.

Hold-Down Wire Inspection Window

  1. Reinstall the hold-down wire. Hook the end of the wire on the knob in the slot.

▶You can see if the hold-down wire is in the right place from the inspection window.

  1. Reinstall the rubber weather seal.

  2. Insert the coupler into the connector of the bulb.

Front Fog Light Bulbs\*

When replacing, use the following bulbs.

Front Fog Light: 35 W (H8 for halogen bulb type)

Clip Screw Cover

  1. Remove the screws using a Phillips-head screwdriver and remove the holding clips using a flat-tip screwdriver.
  2. Pull the under part of the inner fender cover down.

Front Fog Light Bulbs \*

NOTICE

Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on the glass can cause the bulb to overheat and shatter.

When replacing a halogen bulb, handle it by its plastic case, and protect the glass from contact with your skin or hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.

Holding clip

Insert a flat-tip screwdriver, lift and remove the central pin to remove the clip.

Central Pin

* Not available on all models

Continued

Bulbs Coupler Tab

  1. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
  2. Rotate the old bulb to the left to remove.
  3. Insert a new bulb into the fog light assembly and turn it to the right.
  4. Insert the coupler into the connector of the bulb.

Front Fog Light Bulbs \*

Insert the clip with the central pin raised, and push until it is flat.

Push until the pin is flat.

Front Turn Signal Light Bulbs

When replacing, use the following bulbs.

Front Turn Signal Light: 21 W (Amber)

Bulb Socket

  1. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
  2. Pull the bulb straight out of its holder.
  3. Insert a new bulb.

Models with bulb type position lights

Position Light Bulbs

When replacing, use the following bulbs.

Position Light: 5 W

Bulb Socket

  1. Turn the socket to the left and remove it, then remove the old bulb.
  2. Insert a new bulb.

Models with LED type position lights

Position Lights

Position lights are LED type. Have an authorised Honda dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.

Side Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator Lights

Door mirrors have side turn signal lights. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light bulbs.

Daytime Running Lights

Daytime running lights are the LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.

Back-Up Light, Rear Turn Signal Light and Rear Fog Light Bulbs

When replacing, use the following bulbs.

Back-Up Light: 16 W Rear Turn Signal Light: 21 W (Amber) Rear Fog Light: 21 W

Bolt

  1. Use a Phillips-head screwdriver to remove the bolts.
  2. Pull the light assembly out of the rear pillar.

Bulb Socket

  1. Turn the socket to the left and remove it. Remove the old bulb.
  2. Insert a new bulb.
  3. Slide the light assembly onto the guide on the body.

Brake/Taillights

Brake/taillights are the LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.

Rear Licence Plate Light Bulbs

When replacing, use the following bulbs.

Rear Licence Plate Light: 5 W

Lens

  1. Push the lens on the left and pull out the lens and the socket attached to it.

Bulb

  1. Remove the licence plate light assembly by squeezing the tabs on both sides of the socket.
  2. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.

High-Mount Brake Light

High-mount brake light is LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.

Other Light Bulbs

Ceiling Light Bulb

When replacing, use the following bulb.

Ceiling Light: 8 W

Honda Jazz (2018) - Ceiling Light Bulb - 1

natural_image Simple line drawing of a pair of gloves, one with a cloth and the other with a paper towel, against a plain background (no text or symbols)
  1. Pry on the edge of the cover using a flat-tip screwdriver to remove the cover.

▶ Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth to prevent scratches.

Bulb

  1. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.

Map Light Bulbs

Models with display audio system

When replacing, use the following bulbs.

Map Light: 8 W

Honda Jazz (2018) - Map Light Bulbs - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing the dashboard and seat area with a flag, no visible text or symbols
  1. Pry on the edge of the cover using a flat-tip screwdriver to remove the cover.

▶ Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth to prevent scratches.

Bulb

  1. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.

Models with colour audio system
Honda Jazz (2018) - Map Light Bulbs - 3

natural_image Simple line drawing of a car interior with ventilation grilles and a cloth (no text or symbols)
  1. Pry on the edge of the cover using a flat-tip screwdriver to remove the cover.

▶ Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth to prevent scratches.

Bulb Bulb

  1. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.

Luggage Area Light Bulb

When replacing, use the following bulbs.

Luggage Area Light: 5 W

Honda Jazz (2018) - Luggage Area Light Bulb - 1

natural_image Diagram of a car interior showing a door panel and a close-up of a textured object (no text or symbols visible)
  1. Pry on the edge of the cover using a flat-tip screwdriver to remove the cover.

▶ Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth to prevent scratches.

Bulb

  1. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.

Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades

Checking Wiper Blades

If the wiper blade rubber has deteriorated, it will leave streaks and the hard surfaces of the blade may scratch the window glass.

Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber

Honda Jazz (2018) - Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber - 1

natural_image Close-up of a car's side profile showing two curved blades with directional arrows (no text or symbols)
  1. Lift the driver side wiper arm first, then the passenger side.

Lock Tab

  1. Press and hold the tab, then slide the holder off the wiper arm.

Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber

NOTICE

Avoid dropping the wiper arm onto the windscreen, it may damage the wiper arm and/or the windscreen.

Continued

Blade

Tab Blade

  1. Slide the wiper blade out of the holder by pulling the tabbed end out.

  2. Slide the new wiper blade onto the holder from the bottom end.

The tab on the blade should fit in the indent of the top of the wiper holder.

  1. Slide the holder onto the wiper arm securely.

  2. Lower the passenger side wiper arm first, then the driver side.

Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber

Wiper Arm

Blade

  1. Raise the wiper arm off.
  2. Pivot the bottom end of the wiper blade up until it comes off from the wiper arm.
  3. Slide the wiper blade out from the end with the indent.

Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber

NOTICE

Avoid dropping the wiper arm; it may damage the rear window.

Continued

Retainer

  1. Remove the retainers from the wiper blade that has been removed, and mount to a new rubber blade.

Holder

  1. Slide the wiper blade onto the holder. ▶ Make sure it is engaged correctly, then install the wiper blade assembly onto the wiper arm.

Checking and Maintaining Tyres

Checking Tyres

To safely operate your vehicle, your tyres must be of the proper type and size, in good condition with adequate tread, and properly inflated.

Inflation guidelines

Properly inflated tyres provide the best combination of handling, tread life, and comfort. Refer to the driver's doorjamb label for the specified pressure.

Underinflated tyres wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and are more likely to fail from overheating.

Overinflated tyres make your vehicle ride harshly, are more prone to road hazards, and wear unevenly.

Every day before you drive, look at each of the tyres. If one looks lower than the others, check the pressure with a tyre gauge.

At least once a month or before long trips, use a gauge to measure the pressure in all tyres, including the spare*. Even tyres in good condition can lose 10-20 kPa (0.1-0.2 kgf/cm², 1-2 psi) per month.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Checking Tyres

WARNING

Using tyres that are excessively worn or improperly inflated can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed.

Follow all instructions in this owner's manual regarding tyre inflation and maintenance.

Measure the air pressure when tyres are cold. This means the vehicle has been parked for at least three hours, or driven less than 1.6 km (1 mile). If necessary, add or release air until the specified pressure is reached.

If checked when hot, tyre pressure can be as much as 30–40 kPa (0.3–0.4 kgf/cm ^2 , 4–6 psi) higher than if checked when cold.

Have a dealer check the tyres if you feel a consistent vibration while driving. New tyres and any that have been removed and reinstalled should be properly balanced.

Whenever tyre pressure is adjusted, you must calibrate the Deflation Warning System.

☑Deflation Warning System Calibration P. 449

■Inspection guidelines

Every time you check inflation, also examine the tyres and valve stems. Look for:

  • Bumps or bulges on the side or in the tread. Replace the tyre if you find any cuts, splits, or cracks in the side of the tyre. Replace it if you see fabric or cord.
  • Remove any foreign objects and inspect for air leaks.
  • Uneven tread wear. Have a dealer check the wheel alignment.
  • Excessive tread wear.

Wear Indicators P. 517

- Cracks or other damage around valve stem.

>>Checking Tyres

High speed driving

Models with 185/55 R16 tyres

We recommend that you do not drive faster than the posted speed limits and conditions allow. If you drive at sustained high speeds (over 160 km/h/100 mph), adjust the cold tyre pressures as shown below to avoid excessive heat build up and sudden tyre failure.

Tyre Size 185/55R16 83H

Pressure Front240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm ^2 , 35 psi)
Rear: 230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm ^2 , 33 psi)

Wear Indicators

Example of a Wear Indicator mark

The groove where the wear indicator is located is 1.6 mm (1/16 inch) shallower than elsewhere on the tyre. If the tread has worn so that the indicator is exposed, replace the tyre. Worn out tyres have poor traction on wet roads.

Tyre Service Life

The life of your tyres is dependent on many factors, including driving habits, road conditions, vehicle loading, inflation pressure, maintenance history, speed, and environmental conditions (even when the tyres are not in use).

In addition to regular inspections and inflation pressure maintenance, it is recommended that you have annual inspections performed once the tyres reach five years old. All tyres, including the spare*, should be removed from service after 10 years from the date of manufacture, regardless of their condition or state of wear.

Tyre and Wheel Replacement

Replace your tyres with radials of the same size, load range, speed rating, and maximum cold tyre pressure rating (as shown on the tyre's sidewall). Using tyres of a different size or construction can cause certain vehicle systems such as the ABS and Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) ^* system to work incorrectly.

It is best to replace all four tyres at the same time. If that isn't possible, replace the front or rear tyres in pairs.

Make sure that the wheel's specifications match those of the original wheels.

▶Tyre and Wheel Replacement

WARNING

Installing improper tyres on your vehicle can affect handling and stability. This can cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed.

Always use the size and type of tyres recommended in the tyre information label on your vehicle.

Tyre Rotation

Rotating tyres according to the maintenance schedule helps to distribute wear more evenly and increase tyre life.

■Tyres without rotation mark
Honda Jazz (2018) - Tyre Rotation - 1

Rotate the tyres as shown here.

■Tyres with rotation mark
Honda Jazz (2018) - Tyre Rotation - 2

flowchart
graph TD
    A["Component 1"] --> B["Component 2"]
    B --> C["Component 3"]
    C --> D["Component 4"]
    D --> E["Component 5"]
    E --> F["Component 6"]
    F --> G["Component 7"]
    G --> H["Component 8"]
    H --> I["Component 9"]
    I --> J["Component 10"]
    J --> K["Front"]
    style A fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style B fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style C fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style D fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style E fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style F fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style G fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style H fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style I fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style J fill:#f9f,stroke:#333
    style K fill:#f9f,stroke:#333

Rotate the tyres as shown here.

»Tyre Rotation

Tyres with directional tread patterns should only be rotated front to back (not from one side to the other). Directional tyres should be mounted with the rotation indication mark facing forward, as shown below.

Front ROTATION Rotation Mark

When the tyres are rotated, make sure the air pressures are checked.

Whenever tyre pressure is adjusted, you must calibrate the Deflation Warning System.

Deflation Warning System Calibration P. 449

Snow Traction Devices

If driving on snowy or frozen roads, mount winter tyres, or tyre chains; reduce speed; and maintain sufficient distance between vehicles when driving.

Be particularly careful when operating the steering wheel or brakes to prevent skidding.

Use tyre chains, winter tyres, or all season tyres when necessary or according to the law.

When mounting, refer to the following points.

For winter tyres:

  • Select the size and load ranges that are the same as the original tyres.
  • Mount the tyres to all four wheels.

Snow Traction Devices

WARNING

Using the wrong chains, or not properly installing chains, can damage the brake lines and cause a crash in which you can be seriously injured or killed.

Follow all instructions in this owner's manual regarding the selection and use of tyre chains.

NOTICE

Traction devices that are the wrong size or improperly installed can damage your vehicle's brake lines, suspension, body, and wheels. Stop driving if they are hitting any part of the vehicle.

According to the EEC Directive for tyres, when winter tyres are used, it is necessary to affix a sticker with the allowable max. speed of the winter tyres clearly in the field of view of the driver, if the designed max. speed of vehicle is higher than the allowed max. speed of winter tyre. A sticker is obtainable from your tyre dealer. If you have any question, consult a dealer.

When tyre chains are mounted, follow the chain manufacturer's instructions regarding vehicle operational limits.

Use tyre chains only in an emergency or when they are legally required for driving through a certain area.

Use greater caution when driving with tyre chains on snow or ice. They may have less-predictable handling than good winter tyres without chains.

If your vehicle is equipped with summer tyres, be aware that these tyres are not designed for winter driving conditions. For more information, contact a dealer.

For tyre chains:

  • Consult a dealer before purchasing any type of chains for your vehicle.
    • Install them on the front tyres only.
  • Because your vehicle has limited tyre clearance, we strongly recommend using the chains listed below:

Original Tyre Size*1

Chain Type

185/60R15 84H RUD-matic classic 48478

185/55R16 83H RUD-matic classic 48479

*1: Original tyre size is mentioned on the tyre information label on the driver's doorjamb.
- Follow the chain manufacturer's instruction when installing. Mount them as tightly as you can.
- Check that the chains do not touch the brake lines or suspension.
- Drive slowly.

Battery

Checking the Battery

Test Indicator Window*

On the battery with test indicator

Check the battery condition monthly. Look at the test indicator window and check the terminals for corrosion.

The battery condition is monitored by the sensor on the negative terminal. If there is a problem with the sensor, the warning message on multi-information display will let you know. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.

On the battery without the test indicator

The condition of the battery is monitored by a sensor located on the negative terminal of the battery. If there is a problem with the sensor, the warning message on multi-information display will let you know. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.

Check the battery terminals for corrosion monthly.

All models

If your vehicle's battery is disconnected or goes dead:

• The clock resets.

Clock P. 140

• The audio system is disabled.

→ Reactivating the audio system P. 223

- The navigation system is disabled. A PIN code will be required.

Refer to the navigation system manual

* Not available on all models

Battery

WARNING

The battery gives off explosive hydrogen gas during normal operation.

A spark or open flame can cause the battery to explode with enough force to kill or seriously hurt you.

Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking materials away from the battery.

Wear protective clothing and a face shield, or have a skilled technician do any battery maintenance.

WARNING

The battery contains sulfuric acid (electrolyte) which is highly corrosive and poisonous.

Getting electrolyte in your eyes or on your skin can cause serious burns. Wear protective clothing and eye protection when working on or near the battery.

Swallowing electrolyte can cause fatal poisoning if immediate action is not taken.

KEEP OUT OF THE REACH OF CHILDREN

Charging the Battery

Disconnect both battery cables to prevent damaging your vehicle's electrical system. Always disconnect the negative (-) cable first, and reconnect it last.

>>Battery

Models with test indicator window on the battery

The test indicator's colour information is on the battery.

The location of the test indicator window may vary depending on the model.

Emergency Procedures

Eyes: Flush with water from a cup or other container for at least 15 minutes. (Water under pressure can damage the eye.) Call a physician immediately. Skin: Remove contaminated clothing. Flush the skin with large quantities of water. Call a physician immediately.

Swallowing: Drink water or milk. Call a physician immediately.

When you find corrosion, clean the battery terminals by applying a baking powder and water solution. Clean the terminals with a damp towel. Cloth/towel dry the battery. Coat the terminals with grease to help prevent future corrosion.

When replacing the battery, the replacement must be of the same specifications. Consult a dealer for more information.

The battery installed in this vehicle is specifically designed for a model with Auto Idle Stop. Using a battery other than this specified type may shorten the battery life, and prevent Auto Idle Stop from activating. If you need to replace the battery, make sure to select the specified type. Ask a dealer for more details.

Replacing Battery

When you remove and replace the battery, always follow the maintenance safety and the warnings for when checking the battery to prevent potential hazards.

Maintenance Safety P. 477

→Checking the Battery P. 522

Cover Nuts Nut

Stays Nuts

  1. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0*1. Open the bonnet.
  2. Loosen the nut on the negative battery cable, then disconnect the cable from the negative (-) terminal.
  3. Open the positive battery terminal cover. Loosen the nut on the positive battery cable, then disconnect the cable from the positive (+) terminal.
  4. Loosen the nut on each side of the battery bracket with a wrench.
  5. Pull the bottom end of each battery stay out of the hole on the battery base, and remove the combination of the battery bracket and the stays.

>>Replacing Battery

NOTICE

An improperly disposed of battery can be harmful to the environment and human health. Always confirm local regulations for battery disposal.

This symbol on the battery means that this product must not be treated as household waste.

Honda Jazz (2018) - NOTICE - 1

Battery Cover

  1. Remove the battery cover.

Honda Jazz (2018) - NOTICE - 3

natural_image Interior view of a car showing engine and dashboard components with an upward arrow indicating a component (no text or symbols present)
  1. Take out the battery carefully.

>>Replacing Battery

Always disconnect the negative (-) cable first, and reconnect it last.

To install a new battery, reverse this procedure.

Battery Label

Example

>>Battery Label

DANGER

  • Keep flames and sparks away from the battery. The battery produces explosive gas that can cause an explosion.
  • Wear eye protection and rubber gloves when handling the battery to avoid risk of burns or loss of eyesight if exposed to battery electrolyte.
  • Do not allow children to handle the battery, under any circumstance. Ensure that anyone handling the battery has a proper understanding of the hazards and correct handling procedures involved.
  • Handle battery electrolyte with extreme care, as it contains dilute sulfuric acid. Exposure to eyes or skin can cause burns or loss of eyesight.
  • Read this manual carefully, and understand it before handling the battery. Failure to do so can cause personal injury and damage to the vehicle.
  • Do not use the battery if the level of electrolyte is at or below the recommended level. Using the battery with low electrolyte can cause it to explode, causing serious injury.

Remote Transmitter Care

Replacing the Button Battery

If the indicator does not come on when the button is pressed, replace the battery.

Retractable Key*
Honda Jazz (2018) - Replacing the Button Battery - 1

natural_image 3D illustration of a mechanical component with a highlighted section showing internal components (no text or symbols)

Battery type: CR2032

  1. Remove the upper half of the cover by carefully prying on the edge with a coin.

▶ Wrap a coin with a cloth to prevent scratching the retractable key.

  1. Remove the button battery with the small flat-tip screwdriver.

  2. Make sure to replace the battery with the correct polarity.

Battery

* Not available on all models

  1. Remove the button battery with the small flat-tip screwdriver.

Continued

Replacing the Button Battery

WARNING

CHEMICAL BURN HAZARD

The battery that powers the remote transmitter can cause severe internal burns and can even lead to death if swallowed. Keep new and used batteries away from children.

If you suspect that a child has swallowed the battery, seek medical attention immediately.

A warning mark is located adjacent to the button battery*.

NOTICE

An improperly disposed of battery can damage the environment. Always confirm local regulations for battery disposal.

Replacement batteries are commercially available or at a dealer.

This symbol on the battery means that this product must not be treated as household waste.

Honda Jazz (2018) - NOTICE - 1

Keyless Remote\*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Remote\* - 1

natural_image 3D illustration of a car door handle with black arrows indicating direction (no text or symbols)

Battery type: CR2032

  1. Remove the built-in key.

Battery

  1. Remove the upper half by carefully prying on the edge with a coin.

▶ Wrap a coin with a cloth to prevent scratching the keyless remote.

  1. Make sure to replace the battery with the correct polarity.

Heating and Cooling System\*/Climate Control System\* Maintenance

Air Conditioning

For proper and safe operation of the heating and cooling system /climate control system, the refrigerant system should only be served by a qualified technician.

Never repair or replace the air conditioning evaporator (cooling coil) with one removed from a used or salvaged vehicle.

Air Conditioning

NOTICE

Vented refrigerant is harmful to the environment. To avoid refrigerant from venting, never replace the evaporator with one removed from a used or salvaged vehicle.

Refrigerant in your vehicle's air conditioning system is flammable and can be ignited during servicing if proper procedures are not followed.

The air conditioner label is found under the bonnet:

Honda Jazz (2018) - NOTICE - 1

Honda Jazz (2018) - NOTICE - 2
: Air Conditioning System

* Not available on all models

Dust and Pollen Filter

When to Replace the Dust and Pollen Filter

Replace the dust and pollen filter according to your vehicle's recommended maintenance schedule. It is recommended to replace the filter even sooner if the vehicle has been driven in a dusty environment.

→Maintenance Schedule * P. 484
Service Reminder System P. 479

How to Replace the Dust and Pollen Filter

Handle Pull

  1. Open the glove box.

Dust and Pollen Filter

If the airflow from the heating and cooling system ^ /climate control system ^ deteriorates noticeably, and the windows fog up easily, the filter may need to be replaced.

The dust and pollen filter collects pollen, dust, and other debris in the air.

Tabs

  1. Disengage the two tabs by pushing on each side panel.
  2. Pivot the glove box out of the way.

Cover Push Push Tabs

  1. Push in the tabs on the corners of the filter case cover, and remove it.

AIR FLOW Dust and Pollen Filter

  1. Remove the filter from the case.
  2. Install a new filter in the case.

▶ Put the AIR FLOW arrow directed side down.

Dust and Pollen Filter

If you are not sure how to replace the dust and pollen filter, have it replaced by a dealer.

Cleaning

Interior Care

Use a vacuum cleaner to remove dust before using a cloth.

Use a damp cloth with a mixture of mild detergent and warm water to remove dirt. Use a clean cloth to remove detergent residue.

Cleaning Seat Belts

Use a soft brush with a mixture of mild soap and warm water to clean the seat belts. Let the belts air dry. Wipe the loops of the seat belt anchors using a clean cloth.

Loop

Cleaning the Window

Wipe using a glass cleaner.

»Interior Care

Do not spill liquids inside the vehicle. Electrical devices and systems may malfunction if liquids are splashed on them.

Do not use silicone based sprays on electrical devices such as audio devices and switches.

Doing so may cause the items to malfunction or cause a fire inside the vehicle.

If a silicone based spray is inadvertently used on electrical devices, consult a dealer.

Depending on their composition, chemicals and liquid aromatics may cause discolouration, wrinkles, and cracking to resin-based parts and textiles.

Do not use alkali solvents or organic solvents such as benzene or petrol.

After using chemicals, make sure to gently wipe them away using a dry cloth.

Do not place used cloths on top of resin based parts or textiles for long periods of time without washing.

Be careful not to spill a liquid type air freshener.

>>Cleaning the Window

Wires are mounted to the inside of the rear window. Wipe along the same direction as the wires with a soft cloth so as not to damage them.

Floor Mats\*

The driver's floor mat hooks over the floor anchors, which keep the mat from sliding forward. To remove a mat for cleaning, turn the anchor knobs to the unlock position. When reinstalling the mat after cleaning, turn the knobs to the lock position.

Do not put additional floor mats on top of the anchored mat.

Maintaining Genuine Leather\*

To properly clean leather:

  1. Use a vacuum or soft dry cloth first to remove any dirt or dust.
  2. Clean the leather with a soft cloth dampened with a solution comprised of 90% water and 10% neutral soap.
  3. Wipe away any soap residue with a clean damp cloth.
  4. Wipe away residual water and allow leather to air dry in the shade.

»Floor Mats \*

If you use any floor mats that were not originally provided with your vehicle, make sure they are designed for your specific vehicle, fit correctly, and are securely anchored by the floor anchors. Position the rear seat floor mats properly. If they are not properly positioned, the floor mats can interfere with the front seat functions.

Maintaining Genuine Leather \*

It is important to clean or wipe away dirt or dust as soon as possible. Spills can soak into leather resulting in stains. Dirt or dust can cause abrasions in the leather. In addition, please note that some dark coloured clothing can rub onto the leather seats resulting in discoloration or stains.

Exterior Care

Dust off the vehicle body after you drive.

Regularly inspect your vehicle for scratches on painted surfaces. A scratch on a painted surface can result in body rust. If you find a scratch, promptly repair it.

Washing the Vehicle

Wash the vehicle regularly. Wash more frequently when driving in the following conditions:

  • If driving on roads with road salt.
  • If driving in coastal areas.
  • If tar, soot, bird droppings, insects, or tree sap are stuck to painted surfaces.

Using an Automated Car Wash

  • Make sure to follow the instructions indicated on the automated car wash.
  • Remove or store the audio antenna
    Audio Antenna P. 224
  • Fold in the door mirrors.
  • Turn off the automatic intermittent wipers.

Using High Pressure Cleaners

  • Keep sufficient distance between the cleaning nozzle and the vehicle body.
    • Take particular care around the windows. Standing too close may cause water to enter the vehicle interior.
  • Do not spray high pressure water directly into the engine compartment. Instead, use low pressure water and a mild detergent.

Washing the Vehicle

Do not spray water into the air intake vents. It can cause a malfunction.

Air Intake Vents

Applying Wax

A good coat of automotive body wax helps to protect your vehicle's paint from the elements. Wax will wear off over time and expose your vehicle's paint to the elements, so reapply as necessary.

Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts

If you get petrol, oil, engine coolant, or battery fluid on resin coated parts, they may be stained or the coating may peel. Promptly wipe it away using a soft cloth and clean water.

Cleaning the Window

Wipe using a glass cleaner.

Maintaining Aluminium Wheels\*

Aluminium is susceptible to deterioration caused by salt and other road contaminants. When necessary, as early as possible use a sponge and mild detergent to wipe away these contaminants. Do not use a stiff brush or harsh chemicals (including some commercial wheel cleaners). These can damage the protective finish on aluminium alloy wheels, resulting in corrosion. Depending on the type of finish, the wheels also may lose their luster or appear burnished. To avoid water stains, wipe the wheels dry with a cloth while they are still wet.

* Not available on all models

Continued

>> Applying Wax

NOTICE

Chemical solvents and strong cleaners can damage the paint, metal, and plastic on your vehicle. Wipe away spills immediately.

Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts

Ask a dealer about the correct coating material when you want to repair the painted surface of the parts made of resin.

Fogged Exterior Light Lenses

The inside lenses of exterior lights (headlights, brake lights, etc.) may fog temporarily if you have driven in the rain, or after the vehicle has been run through a car wash. Dew condensation also may build up inside the lenses when there is a significant enough difference between the ambient and inside lens temperatures (similar to vehicle windows fogging up in rainy conditions). These conditions are natural processes, not structural design problems in the exterior lights.

Lens design characteristics may result in moisture developing on the light lens frame surfaces. This also is not a malfunction.

However, if you see large amounts of water accumulation, or large water drops building up inside the lenses, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.

Accessories and Modifications

Accessories

When installing accessories, check the following:

  • Do not install accessories on the windscreen. They can obstruct your view and delay your reaction to driving conditions.
  • Do not install any accessories over areas marked SRS Airbag, on the sides or backs of the front seats, on front or side pillars, or near the side windows. Accessories installed in these areas may interfere with proper operation of the vehicle's airbags or may be propelled into you or another occupant if the airbags deploy.
  • Be sure electronic accessories do not overload electrical circuits or interfere with proper operation of your vehicle.
    Fuses P. 573
  • Before installing any electronic accessory, have the installer contact a dealer for assistance. If possible, have a dealer inspect the final installation.

Modifications

Do not modify your vehicle in a manner that may affect its handling, stability, or reliability, or install non-genuine Honda parts or accessories that may have a similar effect.

Even minor modifications to vehicle systems can affect overall vehicle performance. Always make sure all equipment is properly installed and maintained, and do not make any modification to your vehicle or its systems that might cause your vehicle to no longer meet your country's and local regulations.

The on-board diagnostic port (OBD-II/SAE J1962 connector) installed on this vehicle is intended to be used with automobile system diagnostic devices or with other devices that Honda has approved. Use of any other type of device may adversely affect the vehicle's electronic systems or allow them to be compromised, possibly resulting in a system malfunction, drained battery, or other unexpected problems.

Do not modify or attempt to repair any of the electrical components.

Accessories and Modifications

WARNING

Improper accessories or modifications can affect your vehicle's handling, stability, and performance, and cause a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or killed.

Follow all instructions in this owner's manual regarding accessories and modifications.

When properly installed, mobile phones, alarms, two-way radios, radio antenna, and low-powered audio systems should not interfere with your vehicle's computer controlled systems, such as your airbags and anti-lock brakes.

Honda Genuine accessories are recommended to ensure proper operation on your vehicle.

Handling the Unexpected

This chapter explains how to handle unexpected troubles.

Tools

Types of Tools.... 540

If a Tyre Goes Flat

Changing a Flat Tyre ^* 541

Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre..... 549

Engine Does Not Start

Checking the Engine.... 559

If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak ....560

Emergency Engine Stop 561

Jump Starting 562

Shift Lever Does Not Move.... 565

Overheating

How to Handle Overheating...... 566

Indicator, Coming On/Blinking

If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On 568

If the Charging System Indicator Comes On 568

If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks 569

If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On.... 569

If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator Comes On....570

If the Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning System Indicator Comes On or Blinks... 571

If the Low Oil Level Symbol Appears .....572

Fuses

Fuse Locations 573

Inspecting and Changing Fuses..... 583

Emergency Towing.... 584

When You Cannot Open the Tailgate ....587

Tools

Types of Tools

Models with a compact spare tyre
Tool Case Jack Jack Wheel Nut Wrench/ Jack Handle Jack Handle Bar Detachable Towing Hook

Models with temporary tyre repair kit

Temporary Tyre Repair Kit Tool Case Jack Handle Bar Detachable Towing Hook

Types of Tools

The tools are stored in the luggage area.

If a Tyre Goes Flat

Changing a Flat Tyre\*

If a tyre goes flat while driving, grasp the steering wheel firmly, and brake gradually to reduce speed. Then, stop in a safe place. Replace the flat tyre with a compact spare tyre. Go to a dealer as soon as possible to have the full-size tyre repaired or replaced.

  1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, and non-slippery surface and apply the parking brake.

Continuously variable transmission models

  1. Move the shift lever to P.

Manual transmission models

  1. Move the shift lever to R.

All models

  1. Turn on the hazard warning lights and turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0*1.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

* Not available on all models

Continued

Changing a Flat Tyre \*

Follow compact spare precautions: Periodically check the tyre pressure of the compact spare. It should be set to the specified pressure. Specified Pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 kgf/cm ^2 , 60 psi)

When driving with the compact spare tyre, keep the vehicle speed under 80 km/h (50 mph). Replace with a full-size tyre as soon as possible.

The compact spare tyre and wheel in your vehicle are specifically for this model. Do not use them with another vehicle. Do not use another type of compact spare tyre or wheel with your vehicle.

Do not mount tyre chains on a compact spare tyre. If a chain-mounted front tyre goes flat, remove one of the full-size rear tyres and replace it with the compact spare tyre. Remove the flat front tyre and replace it with the full-size tyre that was removed from the rear. Mount the tyre chains on the front tyre.

A compact spare tyre gives a harsher ride and less traction on some road surfaces. Use greater caution while driving.

Do not use more than one compact spare tyre at the same time.

The compact spare tyre is smaller than the regular tyre. Your vehicle's ground clearance reduces when the compact spare tyre is installed. Driving over road debris or bumps could possibly damage the underside of your vehicle.

Getting Ready to Replace the Flat Tyre

Floor Lid

Spare Tyre Jack Tool Case

The tyre to be replaced. Wheel Blocks

  1. Open the luggage area floor lid.

  2. Take the tool case out of the luggage area.

  3. Take the wheel nut wrench, jack handle bar and jack out of the tool case.
  4. Unscrew the wing bolt, and remove the spacer cone. Then, remove the spare tyre.
  5. Place a wheel block or rock in front and rear of the wheel diagonal to the flat tyre.

Changing a Flat Tyre \*

WARNING: The jack can only be used for helping an emergency vehicle breakdown, not for changing the regular seasonal tyre or any other normal maintenance or repair operation.

NOTICE

Do not use the jack if it doesn't work properly. Call your dealer or a professional towing service.

Honda Jazz (2018) - NOTICE - 1

natural_image Side view of a silver minivan with visible rear suspension and side-mounted sensors (no text or symbols)
  1. Place the compact spare tyre (wheel side up) under the vehicle body, near the tyre that needs to be replaced.

Getting Ready to Replace the Flat Tyre

Be careful not to hurt yourself when removing or storing the spare tyre.

Jack Handle Bar Wheel Nut Wheel Cover

Models with wheel cover

  1. Put the flat tip of the jack handle bar into the edge of the wheel cover. Carefully pry the edge and remove the cover.

▶Wrap a cloth around the flat tip of the jack handle bar to prevent scratches on the cover.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Models with wheel cover - 1

natural_image Person in white uniform applying a tire to a car wheel (no text or symbols visible)

All models

  1. Loosen each wheel nut about one turn using the wheel nut wrench.

Continued

How to Set Up the Jack

Honda Jazz (2018) - How to Set Up the Jack - 1

natural_image Side profile of a modern compact car with two close-up insets showing interior views (no text or symbols visible)

Honda Jazz (2018) - How to Set Up the Jack - 2

natural_image Hand holding a car tire, no visible text or symbols
  1. Place the jack under the jacking point closest to the tyre to be changed.

  2. Turn the end bracket clockwise as shown in the image until the top of the jack contacts the jacking point.

▶ Make sure that the jacking point tab is resting in the jack notch.

How to Set Up the Jack

WARNING

The vehicle can easily roll off the jack, seriously injuring anyone underneath.

Follow the directions for changing a tyre exactly, and no person should place any portion of their body under a vehicle that is supported by a jack.

WARNING: The jack shall be placed on a flat and stable surface on the same level as the vehicle is parked.

The jack that came with your vehicle has the following label.

1. 2. 3. ! i

  1. See Owner's Manual.
  2. Never get under vehicle when supported by jack.
  3. Place jack underneath reinforced area.

Jack Handle Bar Wheel Nut Wrench as Jack Handle

  1. Raise the vehicle, using the jack handle bar and the jack handle, until the tyre is off the ground.

>>How to Set Up the Jack

Do not use the jack with people or luggage in the vehicle.

Use the jack provided in your vehicle.

Other jacks may not support the weight ("load") or may not fit the jacking point.

The following instructions must be followed to use the jack safely:

  • Do not use while the engine is running.
  • Use only where the ground is firm and level.
  • Use only at the jacking points.
  • Do not get in the vehicle while using the jack.
  • Do not put anything on top of or underneath the jack.

Loose items can fly around the interior in a crash and can seriously injure the occupants.

Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely before driving.

Continued

Replacing the Flat Tyre

Wheel Nut

Honda Jazz (2018) - Replacing the Flat Tyre - 2

natural_image Two hands performing maintenance on a car tire and wheel (no text or symbols visible)

Honda Jazz (2018) - Replacing the Flat Tyre - 3

natural_image Mechanic inspecting a tire on a car, with an inset diagram showing a molecular structure (no text or symbols)
  1. Remove the wheel nuts and flat tyre.

  2. Wipe the mounting surfaces of the wheel with a clean cloth.

  3. Mount the compact spare tyre.

  4. Screw the wheel nuts until they touch the lips around the mounting holes, and stop rotating.

  5. Lower the vehicle and remove the jack. Tighten the wheel nuts in the order indicated in the image. Go around, tightening the nuts, two to three times in this order.

Wheel nut torque:

108 N·m (11 kgf·m, 80 lbf·ft)

>>Replacing the Flat Tyre

Do not over tighten the wheel nuts by applying extra torque using your foot or a pipe.

Models with wheel cover

Make sure the wire support ring is hooked into the clips around the edge of the wheel cover.

Clips Clips

Align the valve mark on the wheel cover to the tyre valve on the wheel, then install the wheel cover.

Wheel cover Valve Mark

Storing the Flat Tyre

Centre Cap M

Wing Bolt Spacer Cone For full-size tyre For compact spare tyre

Models with aluminium wheels

  1. Remove the centre cap.

Models with a compact spare tyre

  1. Remove the spacer cone from the wing bolt, flip it over, and insert it back on the bolt.

All models

  1. Place the flat tyre face down in the spare tyre well.
  2. Secure the flat tyre with the wing bolt.
  3. Securely put the jack and wheel nut wrench back in the tool case.
  4. Store the case in the luggage area.

Storing the Flat Tyre

WARNING

Loose items can fly around the interior in a crash and can seriously injure the occupants.

Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely before driving.

Models with wheel cover

Make sure the wire support ring is on the outer side of the tyre valve as shown.

Tyre Valve Wire Support Ring

Continued

Deflation Warning System and the Spare Tyre

If you replace a flat tyre with the spare tyre, 1 indicator comes on while you are driving. After driving for a few kilometres (miles), the indicator will start blinking for a short time and then stay on, but this is normal.

Calibrate the deflation warning system when you replace the tyre with a specified regular tyre.

→ Deflation Warning System Calibration P. 449

Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre

If the tyre has a large cut or is otherwise severely damaged, you will need to have the vehicle towed. If the tyre only has a small puncture, from a nail for instance, you can use the temporary tyre repair kit so that you can drive to the nearest service station for a permanent repair.

If a tyre goes flat while driving, grasp the steering wheel firmly, and brake gradually to reduce speed. Then stop in a safe place.

  1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, and non-slippery ground and apply the parking brake.

Continuously variable transmission models

  1. Move the shift lever to P.

Manual transmission models

  1. Move the shift lever to R.

All models

  1. Turn on the hazard warning lights and turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0*1.

▶When towing a trailer, unhitch the trailer.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Continued

»Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre

The kit should not be used in the following situations. Instead, contact a dealer or a roadside assistant to have the vehicle towed.

• The tyre sealant has expired.
- More than one tyre is punctured.
- The puncture or cut is greater than 4 mm (3/16 inch).
- The tyre side wall is damaged or the puncture is outside the tyre area.

Contact Area When the puncture is: Kit Use Smaller than 4 mm (3/16 inch) Yes Larger than 4 mm (3/16 inch) No

  • Damage has been caused by driving with the tyres extremely under inflated.
    • The tyre bead is no longer seated.
  • The rim is damaged.

Do not remove a nail or screw that punctured the tyre. If you remove it from the tyre, you may not be able to repair the puncture using the kit.

Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair the Flat Tyre

Air Compressor
The "Tyre Sealant in the Tyre" Sticker Sealant Bottle Handling Manual HONDA 80 RPM MAX 50 MPH ContiMobilityKit Expiration Date The "Maximum Speed" Sticker

Floor Lid Tyre Repair Kit

  1. Open the luggage area floor lid, then take the kit out of the tool box.
  2. Place the kit, face up, on flat ground near the flat tyre, away from traffic. Do not place the kit on its side.

>>Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair the Flat Tyre

When making a temporary repair, carefully read the instruction manual provided with the kit.

Injecting the Sealant and Air in the Tyre

Plug Cord Air Compressor Hose

  1. Take the air compressor hose and plug cord out of the back of the air compressor.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Injecting the Sealant and Air in the Tyre - 2

natural_image 3D rendering of a mechanical device with a central knob and wiring (no visible text or symbols)
  1. Remove the cap from the air compressor.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Injecting the Sealant and Air in the Tyre - 3

natural_image Illustration of a hand holding a bottle with an upward arrow indicating motion (no text or symbols)
  1. Shake the bottle well.

Injecting the Sealant and Air in the Tyre

WARNING

Tyre sealant contains substances that are harmful and can be fatal if swallowed.

If accidentally swallowed, do not induce vomiting. Drink plenty of water and get medical attention immediately.

For skin or eye contact, flush with cool water and get medical attention if necessary.

Keep the sealant bottle out of the reach of children.

In cold temperatures, the sealant may not flow easily. In this situation, warm it by keeping the bottle in the passenger compartment before using.

The sealant can permanently stain clothing and other materials. Be careful during handling and wipe away any spills immediately.

Continued

▶▶ If a Tyre Goes Flat▶ Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre

Bottle Cap Not Removed

Honda Jazz (2018) - WARNING - 2

natural_image 3D rendering of a mechanical device with rotating components and directional arrows (no text or symbols)

Valve Cap Valve

  1. Remove the bottle cap.

▶ Do not remove the sealed cover.

  1. Screw the sealed bottle onto the air compressor.

▶Screw the bottle tightly so that it does not become loose.

  1. Unscrew the valve cap.

Injecting the Sealant and Air in the Tyre

Do not remove the empty bottle after injecting the sealant.

See a Honda dealer for a replacement of sealant bottle and proper disposal of the empty bottle.

Air Compressor Hose Air Valve Valve

Plug Accessory Power Socket

  1. Screw the air compressor hose onto the tyre valve.

▶ Make sure the air valve is closed and the air compressor is turned off.

  1. Plug in the compressor to the accessory power socket.

→ Accessory Power Socket(s) P. 205

  1. Start the engine.

Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 82

Injecting the Sealant and Air in the Tyre

WARNING

Running the engine with the vehicle in an enclosed or even partly enclosed area can cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon monoxide.

Breathing this colourless, odourless gas can cause unconsciousness and even death. Only run the engine to power the air compressor with the vehicle outdoors.

Turn the air compressor off when connecting the air compressor hose.

You hear a motor sound coming from the activated air compressor. This is normal.

If the specified air pressure is not reached within 10 minutes, the tyre may be too severely damaged for the kit to provide the necessary seal and your vehicle will need to be towed.

If you want to measure the air pressure using a gauge, turn the air compressor off first.

Continued

Air Valve Switch OFF ON

Wheel Label

  1. Turn on the air compressor and inflate the tyre to the specified air pressure.

The compressor starts injecting sealant and air into the tyre.
▶Refer to the driver's doorjamb label for the specified pressure.

  1. After the air pressure reaches to specified pressure, turn off the compressor.

▶ Check the air pressure gauge on the air compressor.
▶ If overinflated, release the air by turning the air valve. Be careful not to spill any sealant.

  1. Unplug the plug from the accessory power socket.

  2. Unscrew the air compressor hose from the tyre valve. Install the hose cap.

▶ Be careful not to spill any sealant when the hose is disconnected. Wipe away any spills.

  1. Apply the wheel label to the flat surface of the wheel.
    The wheel surface must be clean to ensure the label adheres properly.
  2. Store the tyre repair kit in the luggage area.
    ▶ Do not remove the sealant bottle from the air compressor.

Injecting the Sealant and Air in the Tyre

Inform the use of tyre sealant when you ask a Honda dealer or the road assistant service for replacing or repairing the flat tyre.

This air compressor is designed for the automotive tyre. Check the following:

  • The power supply of the air compressor is limited to your vehicle's 12-volt DC accessory power socket.
  • Do not operate the temporary tyre repair kit compressor for more than 15 minutes. The compressor can overheat and become permanently damaged.

Make it cool down when using the compressor continuously.

Distributing the Sealant in the Tyre

HONDA 80 mph MAX 50 MPH 230 min 170 min Speed Limit Label

  1. Apply the speed limit label to the location as shown.
  2. Drive the vehicle for about 10 minutes or three to ten kilometres (two to six miles).
    ▶Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph).
  3. Stop the vehicle in a safe place.
  4. Recheck the air pressure using the gauge on the air compressor.
    ▶ Do not turn the air compressor on to check the pressure.

Distributing the Sealant in the Tyre

WARNING

Running the engine with the vehicle in an enclosed or even partly enclosed area can cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon monoxide.

Breathing this colourless, odourless gas can cause unconsciousness and even death. Only run the engine to power the air compressor with the vehicle outdoors.

Refer to the driver's doorjamb label for the specified pressure.

Air Compressor OFF ON

  1. If the air pressure is

- Less than 130 kPa (19 psi): Do not add air and continue driving. The leak is too severe. Call for help and have your vehicle towed.

Emergency Towing P. 584

- Specified air pressure (See the label on driver's doorjamb.) or more: Continue driving until you reach the nearest service station. Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph).

- Greater than 130 kPa (19 psi), but less than specified air pressure (See the label on driver's doorjamb.): Inflate the tyre to the specified air pressure.

Inflating an Under-inflated Tyre P. 557

And repeat steps 2 to 4 until you reach the nearest service station. Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph).

The distance to the nearest service station has to be within about 200 kilometres (120 miles).

  1. Repackage and properly stow the kit.

Distributing the Sealant in the Tyre

Make sure to store the air compressor with the empty bottle in the luggage area.

Inflating an Under-inflated Tyre

You can use the kit to inflate a non-punctured under-inflated tyre.

Air Valve Hose

Plug Accessory Power Socket

  1. Take the air compressor out of the luggage area.
  2. Place the kit, face up, on flat ground near the tyre to inflate, away from traffic. Do not place the kit on its side.
  3. Remove the valve cap.
  4. Attach the hose onto the tyre valve. Screw it until it is tight.
    ▶ Make sure the air valve is closed.
  5. Plug in the compressor to the accessory power socket.
    ▶ Be careful not to pinch the cord in a door or window.
    → Accessory Power Socket(s) P. 205
  6. Start the engine.
    Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 82

Inflating an Under-inflated Tyre

WARNING

Running the engine with the vehicle in an enclosed or even partly enclosed area can cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon monoxide.

Breathing this colourless, odourless gas can cause unconsciousness and even death. Only run the engine to power the air compressor with the vehicle outdoors.

You hear a motor sound coming from the activated air compressor. This is normal.

Air Valve Switch OFF ON

  1. Turn on the air compressor and inflate the tyre to the specified air pressure (See the label on driver's doorjamb.)
  2. Turn off the air compressor.

▶ Check the air pressure gauge on the air compressor.

▶If overinflated, turn the air valve to deflate.

  1. Turn off the engine, then unplug the air compressor from the accessory power socket.
  2. Unscrew the air compressor hose from the tyre valve. Reinstall the valve cap.
  3. Store the air compressor in the luggage area.

Inflating an Under-inflated Tyre

This air compressor is designed for the automotive tyre. Check the following:

  • The power supply of the air compressor is limited to your vehicle's 12-volt DC accessory power socket.
  • Do not operate the temporary tyre repair kit compressor for more than 15 minutes. The compressor can overheat and become permanently damaged.

Make it cool down when using the compressor continuously.

If you want to measure the air pressure using a gauge, turn the air compressor off first.

Engine Does Not Start

Checking the Engine

If the engine does not start, check the starter.

→Checking the Engine

If you must start the vehicle immediately, use an assisting vehicle or booster battery to jump start it. ▶ Jump Starting P. 562

Models with keyless access system

Do not hold the ENGINE START/STOP button for more than 15 seconds.

Starter condition Checklist

Starter doesn’t turn or turns over slowly.The battery may be dead. Check each of the items on the right and respond accordingly.Models with keyless access systemCheck for an indication on the multi-information display.Ifappears.If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak P. 560Make sure the keyless remote is in its operating range.ENGINE START/STOP Button Operating Range P. 165
Check the brightness of the interior lights.Turn on the interior lights and check the brightness.If the interior lights are dim or do not come on at allBatteryP. 522If the interior lights come on normallyFusesP. 573
The starter turns over normally but the engine doesn’t start.There may be a problem with the fuse. Check each of the items on the right and respond accordingly.Review the engine start procedure.Follow its instructions, and try to start the engine again.Starting the Engine P. 392, 395
Check the immobilizer system indicator.When the immobilizer system indicator is blinking, the engine cannot be started.Immobilizer System P. 159
Check the fuel level.There should be enough fuel in the tank.Fuel Gauge P. 128
Check the fuses.Check all fuses, or have your vehicle checked by a dealer.Inspecting and Changing Fuses P. 583
If the problem continues:Emergency Towing P. 584

▶▶ Engine Does Not Start▶ If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak

Models with keyless access system

If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak

If the beeper sounds, 📄pears on the multi-information display, and the ENGINE START/STOP button flashes, and the engine does not start.

Start the engine as follows.

ENGINE START STOP

ENGINE START STOP

  1. Touch the centre of the ENGINE START/STOP button with the H logo on the keyless remote while the ENGINE START/STOP button is flashing. The buttons on the keyless remote should be facing you.

The ENGINE START/STOP button flashes for about 30 seconds.

  1. Depress the brake pedal and the clutch pedal (manual transmission) and press the ENGINE START/STOP button within 10 seconds after the beeper sounds and the ENGINE START/STOP button changes from flashing to on.

▶If you do not depress the pedal, the mode will change to ACCESSORY.

Models with keyless access system

Emergency Engine Stop

The ENGINE START/STOP button may be used to stop the engine due to an emergency situation even while driving. If you must stop the engine, do either of the following operations:

  • Press and hold the ENGINE START/STOP button for about two seconds.
  • Firmly press the ENGINE START/STOP button three times.

The steering wheel will not lock.

Continuously variable transmission models

The power mode is in ACCESSORY when the engine is stopped.

To change the mode to VEHICLE OFF, move the shift lever to P after the vehicle comes to a complete stop. Then press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice without depressing the brake pedal.

Manual transmission models

The power mode changes to VEHICLE OFF.

Emergency Engine Stop

Do not press the button while driving unless it is absolutely necessary for the engine to be turned off.

Jump Starting

Jump Starting Procedure

Turn off the power to electric devices, such as audio and lights. Turn off the engine, then open the bonnet.

Booster Battery

  1. Connect the first jumper cable to the position shown in a Illustration.

Remove the cover from the under-bonnet fuse box.

Engine Compartment Fuse Box P. 573

  1. Connect the other end of the first jumper cable to the booster battery ⊕ terminal.

▶ Use a 12-volt booster battery only.

▶Connect when using the automotive battery charger to boost your 12-volt battery, select a lower charging voltage than 15-volt. Check the charger manual for the proper setting.

  1. Connect the second jumper cable to the booster battery ⊖ terminal.

Jump Starting

WARNING

A battery can explode if you do not follow the correct procedure, seriously injuring anyone nearby.

Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking materials away from the battery.

NOTICE

If a battery sits in extreme cold, the electrolyte inside can freeze. Attempting to jump start with a frozen battery can cause it to rupture.

Securely attach the jumper cables clips so that they do not come off when the engine vibrates. Also be careful not to tangle the jumper cables or allow the cable ends to touch each other while attaching or detaching the jumper cables.

Honda Jazz (2018) - NOTICE - 1

natural_image Mechanical assembly diagram showing a valve and clamping mechanism (no text or labels visible)
  1. Connect the other end of the second jumper cable to the stud bolt as shown. Do not connect this jumper cable to any other part.
  2. If your vehicle is connected to another vehicle, start the assisting vehicle's engine and increase its rpm slightly.
  3. Attempt to start your vehicle's engine. If it turns over slowly, check that the jumper cables have good metal-to-metal contact.

Jump Starting

Battery performance degrades in cold conditions and may prevent the engine from starting.

Continued

What to Do After the Engine Starts

Once your vehicle's engine has started, remove the jumper cables in the following order.

  1. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle's stud bolt.
  2. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery ⊖ terminal.
  3. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle's battery ⊕ terminal.
  4. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery terminal.

Have your vehicle inspected by a nearby service station or a dealer.

Shift Lever Does Not Move

Continuously variable transmission models

Follow the procedure below if you cannot move the shift lever out of the P position.

Releasing the Lock

Slot Cover

  1. Set the parking brake.

Models without keyless access system

  1. Remove the key from the ignition switch.

Models with keyless access system

  1. Remove the built-in key from the keyless remote.

All models

  1. Wrap a cloth around the tip of a small flat-tip screwdriver. Put it into the shift lock release slot as shown in the image, and remove the cover.

  2. Insert the key into the shift lock release slot.

  3. While pushing the key down, press the shift lever release button, and place the shift lever into N.

The lock is now released. Have the shift lever checked by a dealer as soon as possible.

Shift Lock Release Slot Release Button

Overheating

How to Handle Overheating

Overheating symptoms are as follows:

  • The high temperature indicator comes on or the engine suddenly loses power.
  • The message appears on the multi-information display.
  • Steam or spray comes out of the engine compartment.

■First thing to do

  1. Immediately park the vehicle in a safe place.
  2. Turn off all accessories and turn on the hazard warning lights.

▶ No steam or spray present: Keep the engine running and open the bonnet.
▶ Steam or spray is present: Turn off the engine and wait until it subsides.

Then open the bonnet.

How to Handle Overheating

WARNING

Steam and spray from an overheated engine can seriously scald you.

Do not open the bonnet if steam is coming out.

NOTICE

Continuing to drive with the high temperature indicator on may damage the engine.

■Next thing to do
MAX MIN Reserve Tank

  1. Check that the cooling fan is operating and stop the engine once the high temperature indicator goes off.

▶If the cooling fan is not operating, immediately stop the engine.

  1. Once the engine has cooled down, inspect the coolant level and check the cooling system components for leaks.

▶If the coolant level in the reserve tank is low, add coolant until it reaches the MAX mark.
If there is no coolant in the reserve tank, check that the radiator is cool. Cover the radiator cap with a heavy cloth and open the cap. If necessary, add coolant up to the base of the filler neck, and put the cap back on.

■Last thing to do

Once the engine has cooled sufficiently, restart it and check the high temperature indicator. If the high temperature indicator is off, resume driving. If it stays on, contact a dealer for repairs.

How to Handle Overheating

WARNING

Removing the radiator cap while the engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray out, seriously scalding you.

Always let the engine and radiator cool down before removing the radiator cap.

If the coolant is leaking, contact a dealer for repairs.

Use water as an emergency/temporary measure only. Have a dealer flush the system with proper antifreeze as soon as possible.

Indicator, Coming On/Blinking

If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On

Honda Jazz (2018) - If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On - 1

■Reasons for the indicator to come on

Comes on when the engine oil pressure is low.

■What to do as soon as the indicator comes on

  1. Immediately park the vehicle on level ground in a safe place.

  2. If necessary, turn the hazard warning lights on.

■What to do after parking the vehicle

  1. Stop the engine and let it sit for about three minutes.

  2. Open the bonnet and check the oil level.

Oil Check P. 492

  1. Start the engine and check the low oil pressure indicator.

The indicator goes off: Start driving again.

The indicator does not go off within 10 seconds: Stop the engine and contact a dealer for repairs immediately.

If the Charging System Indicator Comes On

Honda Jazz (2018) - If the Charging System Indicator Comes On - 1

■Reasons for the indicator to come on

Comes on when the battery is not being charged.

■What to do when the indicator comes on

Turn off the heating and cooling system*/climate control system*, rear demister, and other electrical systems, and immediately contact a dealer for repairs.

If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On

NOTICE

Running the engine with low oil pressure can cause serious mechanical damage almost immediately.

If the Charging System Indicator Comes On

If you need to stop temporarily, do not turn off the engine. Restarting the engine may rapidly discharge the battery.

Honda Jazz (2018) - If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks - 1

- Comes on when there is a problem with the engine emissions control system.

- Blinks when engine misfiring is detected.

■What to do when the indicator lamp comes on

Avoid high speeds and immediately get your vehicle inspected at a dealer.

Park the vehicle in a safe place with no flammable items and wait at least 10 minutes or more with the engine stopped until it cools.

If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On

Honda Jazz (2018) - If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On - 1

■Reasons for the indicator to come on

• The brake fluid is low.

• There is a malfunction in the brake system.

■ What to do when the indicator comes on while driving

Depress the brake pedal lightly to check pedal pressure.

- If normal, check the brake fluid level the next time you stop.

- If abnormal, take immediate action. If necessary, downshift the transmission to slow the vehicle using engine braking.

If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks

NOTICE

If you drive with the malfunction indicator lamp on, the emissions control system and the engine could be damaged.

If the malfunction indicator lamp blinks again when restarting the engine, drive to the nearest dealer at 50 km/h (30 mph) or less. Have your vehicle inspected.

If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On

Have your vehicle repaired immediately. It is dangerous to drive with low brake fluid. If there is no resistance from the brake pedal, stop immediately in a safe place. If necessary, downshift the gears.

If the brake system indicator and ABS indicator come on simultaneously, the electronic brake distribution system is not working. This can result in vehicle instability under sudden braking.

Have your vehicle inspected by a dealer immediately.

If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator Comes On

Honda Jazz (2018) - If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator Comes On - 1

■Reasons for the indicator to come on

  • Comes on when there is a problem with the EPS system.
  • If you depress the accelerator pedal repeatedly to increase the engine speed while the engine is idling, the indicator comes on, and sometimes the steering wheel becomes harder to operate.

■What to do when the indicator comes on

Stop the vehicle in a safe place and restart the engine. If the indicator comes on and stays on, immediately have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.

Honda Jazz (2018) - If the Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning System Indicator Comes On or Blinks - 1

A tyre pressure is significantly low, or the deflation warning system has not been calibrated. If there is a problem with the deflation warning system, the indicator blinks for about one minute, and then stays on. If the compact spare tyre* is installed, the indicator will either come on or it will first blink for about one minute, then stay on.

■What to do when the indicator comes on

Drive carefully and avoid abrupt cornering and hard braking. Stop your vehicle in a safe place. Check the tyre pressure and adjust the pressure to the specified level. The specified tyre pressure is on a label on the driver side doorjamb.

▶ Calibrate the deflation warning system after the tyre pressure is adjusted.

▶ Deflation Warning System Calibration P. 449

If the compact spare tyre* causes the indicator to come on, change the tyre to a full-size tyre. The indicator goes off after driving for a few kilometers (miles).

▶ Calibrate the deflation warning system after a full-size tyre is reinstalled.

→ Deflation Warning System Calibration P. 449

Have the tyre inspected by a dealer as soon as possible. If the compact spare tyre* causes the indicator to first blink, and then stay on, change the tyre to a full-size tyre.

The indicator goes off after driving for a few kilometres (miles).

▶ Calibrate the deflation warning system after a full-size tyre is reinstalled.

Deflation Warning System Calibration P. 449

* Not available on all models

If the Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning System Indicator Comes On or Blinks

NOTICE

Driving on an extremely underinflated tyre can cause it to overheat. An overheated tyre can fail. Always inflate your tyres to the prescribed level.

If the Low Oil Level Symbol Appears

Honda Jazz (2018) - If the Low Oil Level Symbol Appears - 1

■Reasons for the symbol to appear

Appears when the engine oil level is low.

■What to do as soon as the symbol appears

  1. Immediately park the vehicle on level ground in a safe place.

  2. If necessary, turn the hazard warning lights on.

■What to do after parking the vehicle

  1. Stop the engine and let it sit for about three minutes.

  2. Open the bonnet and check the oil level.

Oil Check P. 492

If the Low Oil Level Symbol Appears

NOTICE

Running the engine with low oil level can cause serious mechanical damage almost immediately.

This system activates after the engine warms up. If the outside temperature is extremely low, you may have to drive for a long time until the system senses the engine oil level.

If the symbol appears again, stop the engine and contact a dealer for repairs immediately.

Fuses

Fuse Locations

If any electrical devices are not working, turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0 *1 and check to see if any applicable fuse is blown.

Engine Compartment Fuse Box

Fuse Box A

Located near the brake fluid reserve tank. Push the tabs to open the box. Locate the fuse in question by the following image and table.

Tab

25 26 27 28 29 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 33 32 31 30

Honda Jazz (2018) - Fuse Box A - 3
Front

■Circuit protected and fuse rating

Circuit Protected Amps
1 Headlight Low Beam Main 20 A
2C * o(30 A)
3 Hazard 10 A
4 DBW 15 A
5 Wiper*(30 A)
6 Stop 10 A
7 IGP 15 A
8 IG Coil 15 A
9ECP*(10 A)
10INJ(20 A)
11DC/DC2*(30 A)
12Main Fan30 A
13Starter SW*(30 A)
14MG Clutch7.5 A
15Battery Sensor7.5 A
16--
17DRL 7.5 A
18 Horn10 A
19Front Fog Lights*(15 A)
20UB ECU7.5 A
Circuit Protected Amps
21*7Back Up110 A
21*3 tBackUp1c15 A
22Interior Light7.5 A
23Sub Fan*(30 A)
24DC/DC 1*30 A
25Starter*(7.5 A)
26CAM SNSR(7.5 A)
27--
28ST MG*(7.5 A)
29*2Back Up230 A
29*3Back Up210 A
30IGP LAF10 A
31 IGPS7.5 A
32 Right Headlight Low Beam10 A
33 Left Headlight Low Beam10 A

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

*2: Except SE and TREND models with continuously variable transmission.

*3: SE and TREND models with continuously variable transmission.

Fuse Box B
Tab a b c d

Pull up the cover on the ⊕ terminal, then remove it while pulling out the tab as shown.

Replacement of engine compartment fuses should be done by a dealer.

■Circuit protected and fuse rating

Circuit Protected Amps
a Batter Main 100 A
b RB Main 1 70 A
c RB Main 2 80 A
d CAP Main 80 A

Driver Side Interior Fuse Box

■Type A

Located behind the instrument panel.

Honda Jazz (2018) - ■Type A - 1

natural_image Interior view of a car showing steering wheel, dashboard, and gear assembly (no visible text or symbols)

Locate the fuse in question by the following image and table.

UP 1 8 15 22 29 36 2 9 16 23 30 37 3 10 17 24 31 38 4 11 18 25 32 39 5 12 19 26 33 40 6 13 20 27 34 41 7 14 21 28 35 42

■Circuit protected and fuse rating

Circuit Protected Amps
1 Door Lock 20 A
2 --
3 Keyless Access System * (10 A)
4 Left Side Door Unlock 15 A
5 Right Side Door Unlock 15 A
6 --
7 --
8 Driver's Power Window 20 A
9 Passenger's Power Window 20 A
10Rear Left Power Window20 A
11Rear Right Power Window20 A
12Left Side Door Lock15 A
13Right Side Door Lock15 A
14Rear Fog Light10 A
15Right Headlight High Beam10 A
16STS*(7.5 A)
17--
18--
19Heated Seat*(20 A)
20--
Circuit Protected Amps
21--
22Washer15 A
23Rear Wiper Main*(10 A)
24A/C7.5 A
25Daytime Running Lights7.5 A
26Starter*(7.5 A)
27 ABS/VSA7.5 A
28SRS110 A
29Left Headlight High Beam10 A
30ACG10 A
31Power Window10 A
32Fuel Pump15 A
33SRS27.5 A
34Meter7.5 A
35Mission SOL*(7.5 A)
36Front ACC Socket20 A
37ACC7.5 A
38ACC Key Lock(7.5 A)
39Option10 A
40Rear Wiper10 A
Circuit Protected Amps
41--
42--

Type B
Cover

Remove the cover by putting the flat-tip screwdriver into the side slot as shown. Locate the fuse in question by the following image and table.

3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 2 1 12 13 14 15 UP

■Circuit protected and fuse rating

Circuit Protected Amps
EPS70 A
IG Main 50 A^*130 A^*2
1Fuse Box Main 2 50 A
ABS/VSA Motor 40 A
Fuse Box Main 1 30 A
Fuse Box Main 3 40 A
2--
--
--
--
--
--
Circuit Protected Amps
3 Heater 30 A
4*2IG Main (30 A)
5 ABS/VSA FSR 30 A
6 ISA*(15 A)
7 --
8 Super Lock*(20 A)
9Small Light10 A
10Centre Accessory Socket *(20 A)
11Rear Demister30 A
12*1Key ACC Lock(7.5 A)
13Heated Door Mirror *(10 A)
14A/C Blower SW(7.5 A)
15*1Front Wiper (30 A)

*1: Models without the keyless access system

*2: Models with the keyless access system

Left-hand drive type

■Type C

Located near the steering column.

Fuse Label

Fuse locations are shown on the label. Locate the fuse in question by the fuse number and label number.

■Circuit protected and fuse rating

Circuit Protected Amps
1---
2IG 1-2i7.5 A
3Power Oil Pump (10 A)
4---
5Accessory 7.5 A
6IG 1-1i7.5 A
7iBack Up15 A

Right-hand drive type

Passenger Side Interior Fuse Box

Honda Jazz (2018) - Passenger Side Interior Fuse Box - 1

Located behind the glove box.

  1. Open the glove box.

  2. Disengage the two tabs by pushing on each side panel.

  3. Pivot the glove box out of the way.

Fuse Label

Fuse locations are shown on the label. Locate the fuse in question by the fuse number and label number.

■Circuit protected and fuse rating

Circuit Protected Amps
1---
2IG 1-2i7.5 A
3Power Oil Pump (10 A)
4---
5Accessory 7.5 A
6IG 1-1i7.5 A
7BackUp15 A

Inspecting and Changing Fuses

Blown Fuse Box on the Battery

Honda Jazz (2018) - Inspecting and Changing Fuses - 2

natural_image Technical line drawing of a mechanical component with internal channels and mounting holes (no text or symbols)

Combined Fuse Blown Fuse

  1. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK 0 ^*1 . Turn headlights and all accessories off.
  2. Remove the fuse box cover.
  3. Check the large fuses on the battery in the engine compartment.

▶If the fuse is blown, have it replaced by a dealer.

  1. Inspect the small fuses in the engine compartment and the vehicle interior.
    ▶If there is a blown fuse, remove it and replace it with a new one.
  2. Check the large fuse in the vehicle interior.
    ▶If the fuse is blown, use a phillips-head screwdriver to remove the screw and replace it with a new one.

Inspecting and Changing Fuses

NOTICE

Replacing a fuse with one that has a higher rating greatly increases the chances of damaging the electrical system.

Replace fuse with a spare fuse of the same specified amperage.

Use the charts to locate the fuse in question and confirm the specified amperage.

→Fuse Locations P. 573

Emergency Towing

Call a professional towing service if you need to tow your vehicle.

■Flat bed equipment

The operator loads your vehicle on the back of a truck. This is the best way to transport your vehicle.

■Wheel lift equipment

The tow truck uses two pivoting arms that go under the front tyres and lift them off the ground. The rear tyres remain on the ground. This is an acceptable way to tow your vehicle.

Emergency Towing

NOTICE

Trying to lift or tow your vehicle by the bumpers will cause serious damage. The bumpers are not designed to support the vehicle's weight.

Improper towing such as towing behind a motorhome or other motor vehicle can damage the transmission.

Never tow your vehicle with just a rope or chain. It is very dangerous, since ropes or chains may shift from side to side or break.

■ If your vehicle must be towed with the front wheels on the ground:

Cover Type A Type B Cover

  1. Check the ground underneath the vehicle around where the transmission housing is for a fluid leak.

▶If you find a leak, call a professional towing service and have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.

  1. Put cloth on the edge of the cover. Carefully pry with a small flat-tip screwdriver or a metal fingernail file to remove the cover.

The detachable towing hook mounts on the anchor in the front bumper.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.

Continued

If your vehicle must be towed with the front wheels on the ground:

Towing a vehicle is prohibited by law in some countries.

Check and follow the legal requirements of the country in which you are driving before towing your vehicle.

If you cannot follow the exact procedure, do not tow your vehicle with the front wheels on the ground.

If you cannot turn on the engine, you may experience the following while your vehicle is being towed.

- Braking may become difficult since the brake system's power assist is disabled.

- Steering wheel becomes heavy as the power steering system is disabled.

Manual transmission models

- Turning the ignition switch to LOCK 0*1 locks the steering wheel.

With the front wheels on the ground, it is best to tow the vehicle no farther than 80 km (50 miles), and keep the speed below 55 km/h (34 mph).

Going down a long slope heats up the brakes. This may prevent the brakes from working properly. If your vehicle needs to be towed on an incline, call a professional towing service.

Make sure to use the properly-designed and attached towing equipment.

Models with a compact spare tyre Wheel Nut Wrench Towing Hook Models with temporary tyre repair kit Jack Handle Bar Towing Hook

Models with a compact spare tyre

  1. Take the towing hook and the wheel nut wrench out of the luggage area.

Models with temporary tyre repair kit

  1. Take the towing hook and the jack handle bar out of the luggage area.

All models

  1. Screw the towing hook into the hole, and tighten it with the wheel nut wrench* or the jack handle bar* securely.
  2. Hook the towing device to the towing hook.
  3. Start the engine.

If it is difficult to turn on the engine, put the ignition switch in ACCESSORY I or ON II *1.

Manual transmission models

  1. Shift to N.

Continuously variable transmission models

  1. Depress the brake pedal.
  2. Shift to D and hold for five seconds, then to N.

All models

  1. Release the parking brake.

If your vehicle must be towed with the front wheels on the ground:

NOTICE

Continuously variable transmission models

If you cannot shift the transmission or turn on the engine, will damage the transmission. Your vehicle must be transported with the front wheels off the ground.

*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models

When You Cannot Open the Tailgate

What to Do When Unable to Open the Tailgate

If you cannot open the tailgate, use the following procedure.

Lid

  1. Wrap a cloth around the flat-tip screwdriver. Put it into the lid as shown in the image, and open the lid.

Lever

Models with keyless access system

  1. To open the tailgate, push the tailgate while sliding the lever to the right.

What to Do When Unable to Open the Tailgate

Following up: After taking these steps, contact a dealer to have your vehicle checked.

When you open the tailgate from inside, make sure there is enough space around the tailgate, and it does not hit anyone or any object.

Continued

Lever

Models without keyless access system

  1. Slide the lever to unlock the tailgate.
  2. Open the tailgate.

Information

This chapter includes your vehicle's specifications, locations of identification numbers, and other information required by regulation.

Specifications....590

Identification Numbers

Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine

Number and Transmission Number.....594

Devices that Emit Radio Waves* ..... 595

EC Declaration of Conformity Content

Outline ^* 607

Specifications

Vehicle Specifications

Model Jazz
Curb Weight11,073 – 1,116 kg (2,365 – 2,460 lbs)
Curb Weight21,093 – 1,136 kg (2,409 – 2,504 lbs)
Maximum permissible weight1,605 kg (3,538 lbs)
Maximum permissible axle weightFront 855 kg (1,885 lbs)
Rear 835 kg (1,841 lbs)

*1: Manual transmission models
*2: Continuously variable transmission models

Engine Specifications

TypeWater cooled 4-stroke DOHC I-VTEC in line, 4-cylinder petrol engine
Bore x Stroke73.0 x 78.7 mm (2.87 x 3.10 in)*1
73.0 x 89.5 mm (2.87 x 3.52 in)*2
Displacement1,318 cm ^3 (80.4 cu-in)*1
1,498 cm ^3 (91.4 cu-in)*2
Compression ratio13.5 : 1*1
11.5 : 1*2
Spark PlugsNGK DILZKAR7C11S
DENSO DXE22HCR11S

*1: 1.3 L engine models
*2: 1.5 L engine models

Fuel

Fuel: TypeUnleaded premium petrol, Research octane number of 95 (E10) or higher
Fuel Tank Capacity 40 L (8.8 Imp gal)

Battery

Capacity40AH(5)/50AH(20)*136AH(5)/47AH(20)*2
Type N-65*1

*1: Except SE and TREND models with continuously variable transmission
*2: SE and TREND models with continuously variable transmission

Idle Stop:

The battery installed in this vehicle is specifically designed for a model with Auto Idle Stop. If you need to replace the battery, make sure to select the specified type. Ask a dealer for more details.

Washer Fluid

Tank Capacity 2.5 L (2.2 Imp qt)

Light Bulbs

Headlights (High/Low Beam)*160/55W (H4LL/HB2LL*, H4 LL, H4)
Headlights (Low Beam)*2LED
Headlights (High Beam)*2LED
Position Lights*15W
Position Lights*3LED
Front Turn Signal Lights 21W (Amber)
Daytime Running Lights LED
Front Fog Lights *35W (H8)
Side Turn Signal Lights(on Door Mirrors)LED
Brake/Taillights LED
Rear Turn Signal Lights 21W (Amber)
Back-Up Lights 16W
Rear Fog Light 21W
Rear Licence Plate Lights 5W
High-Mount Brake Light LED
Interior Lights
Map lights 8W
Ceiling Light 8W
Luggage Area Light 5W

*1: Models with halogen type headlights
*2: Models with LED type headlights

Brake Fluid

Specified Brake Fluid with DOT 3 or DOT 4

Air Conditioning

Refrigerant Type R-1234yf
Charge Quantity 375 - 425 g

■Continuously Variable Transmission Fluid

Specified Honda HCF-2 Transmission Fluid
Capacity Change3.4 L (3.0 Imp qt)

■Manual Transmission Fluid

Specified Honda Manual Transmission Fluid
Capacity Change1.4 L (1.2 Imp qt)

Engine Oil

RecommendedEuropean modelsHonda Genuine Motor OilHonda ENG Oil #1.0Honda Green OilACEA A5/B5 or higher grade0W-20Except European modelsHonda Genuine Motor OilAPI service SM or higher grade0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-30,10W-30
Change3.4 L (3.0 Imp qt)
CapacityChangeincluding filter3.6 L (3.2 Imp qt)

Engine Coolant

Specified Honda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type2
Ratio50/50 with distilled water
Capacity^*3 3.48 L (0.766 Imp gal) ^1 3.35 L (0.737 Imp gal) ^2 (change including the remaining 0.4 L(0.09 Imp gal) in the reserve tank)
Capacity^*4 3.78 L (0.832 Imp gal)(change including the remaining 0.42 L(0.092 Imp gal) in the reserve tank)

*1: Continuously variable transmission models
*2: Manual transmission models
*3: With single fan
*4: With twin fans

Tyre

RegularSize185/60R15 84H185/55R16 83H
PressureSee the label on driver's doorjamb.
Compact Spare*SizeT135/80D15 99MT135/80D15 100M
Pressure kPa (kgf/cm2[psi])420 (4,2 [60')
Wheel SizeRegular15 x 6J ^1 116 x 6J ^2
Compact Spare *15 x 4T

For the tyre size and pressure information, see the label on driver's doorjamb.
*1: Modes with 185/60 R15 tyres
*2: Modes with 185/55 R16 tyres

Honda TRK Air Compressor

A weighted emission sound pressure level81 dB (A)
A weighted sound power level89 dB (A)

Brake

Type Power assisted
Front Ventilated disc
Rear Disc
Parking Hand brake

Vehicle Dimensions

Length 4,028 mm( 158.5 in) ^*1
4,051 mm( 159.4 in) ^*2
Width 1,694 mm (66.7 in)
Height 1,515 mm( 59.6 in) ^*5
1,541 mm( 60.7 in) ^*6
Wheelbase 2,530 mm (99.6 in)
TrackFront 1,483 mm( 58.4 in) ^*2
1,477 mm( 58.1 in) ^*4
Rear 1,472 mm( 58.0 in) ^*3
1,466 mm( 57.7 in) ^*4

*1: 1.3 L engine models
*2: 1.5 L engine models
*3: Modes with 185/60 R15 tyres
*4: Modes with 185/55 R16 tyres
*5: Body
*6: With shark fin antenna

■The mounting point/rear over hang of coupling device
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7)

NOTE:
- marks show towbar fixing points.
mark shows towbar coupling point.

No. Dimensions

(1)525 mm (20.6 in)
(2)485 mm (19.0 in)
(3)269 mm (10.5 in)
(4)128 mm (5.0 in)
(5)950 mm (37.4 in)
(6)1,061 mm (41.7 in)
(7)786 mm (30.9 in)

Max. Towing Weight

Trailer with brakes 1,000 kg (2,205 lbs)
Trailer without brakes450 kg (992 lbs)
The maximum permissible vertical load on the coupling device95 kg (209 lbs)

Identification Numbers

Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number and Transmission Number

Your vehicle has a 17-digit vehicle identification number (VIN) used to register your vehicle for warranty purposes, and for licensing and insuring your vehicle. The locations of your vehicle's VIN, engine number and transmission number are shown as follows.

Engine Number Vehicle Identification Number Manual Transmission Number Continuously Variable Transmission Number Certification Label/Vehicle Identification Number Vehicle Identification Number

Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number and Transmission Number

The interior vehicle identification number (VIN) is located under the cover.

Cover

Devices that Emit Radio Waves\*

The following products and systems on your vehicle emit radio waves when in operation.

Remote Transmitter*Immobilizer System
Honda Jazz (2018) - Devices that Emit Radio Waves\* - 1Honda Jazz (2018) - Devices that Emit Radio Waves\* - 2
Honda Jazz (2018) - Devices that Emit Radio Waves\* - 3Honda Jazz (2018) - Devices that Emit Radio Waves\* - 4
Honda Jazz (2018) - Devices that Emit Radio Waves\* - 5Honda Jazz (2018) - Devices that Emit Radio Waves\* - 6

* Not available on all models

Continued

»Devices that Emit Radio Waves *

European models

Models with remote transmitter

Models with keyless access system

EC Directives

Each of the items in the table complies with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of R & TTE (Radio equipment and

Telecommunications Terminal Equipment and the mutual recognition of their conformity) Directive 1999/5/EC.

See the following URLs for Declaration of conformity: http://www.techinfo.honda-eu.com

Models with remote transmitter

Valeo Security Systems:

www.valeoservice.com/certificates

Models with Keyless Access System

Honda Lock Mfg. Co., Ltd

www.hondalock.co.jp/eu_doc/HLBUS.pdf Panasonic Corporation

www.ptc.panasonic.de/ (To see the DoC for the product's each component, input these product search numbers: YEPOFX1515, YEPOFX1510, and YEPOFX1509.)

Israeli models

Immobilizer system Remote Transmitter

In the presentation of a report that was in 2014 and in 2015, we were also

L'oulairet person talofta/2018, gite obligat a n'aplicer macra naples and de conflavation 5M je proklasick specifizierte in gauwana

Remote Transmitter\*

ERC/REC 70-03 Annex 1

DECLARATION of CONFORMITY For

Honda Jazz (2018) - DECLARATION of CONFORMITY For - 1

Product: Immobiliser base station Model: TWK1A0028

Supplied by ALPS ELECTRIC CO., LTD. 6-3-36, Nakazato, Furukawa, Osaki-city, Miyagi-prof., JAPAN 989-6181

Technical Construction File held by ALPS ELECTRIC CO., LTD. 6-3-36, Nakarato, Furikawa, Osaki-city, Miyagi-prof., JAPAN 919-6181

R&TTE Directive (Article 3.1(a) Safety)

R&TTE Directive (Article 3.1(b) EMC)

RATTE Directive (Article 3.2 Spectrum)

Standard used for comply

EN 60065: 2002 + Amd.1: 2006 + Amd.11: 2008 + Amd.2: 2010 + Amd.12: 2011

EN 301 489-1 V1.9.2: 2011 EN 301 489-3 V1.6.1: 2013

EN 300 330-1 V1.7.1:2010 EN 300 330-2 V1.5.1:2010

Means of Conformity

We declare under our sole responsibility that the Product (a) is conformity with the essential requirements and other relevant requirements of the Radio and Telecommunication Terminal Equipment (R&TTE) Directive (1999/S/EC).

Date of issue: July 11, 2014

Signature of Responsible Person:

Joshie Ica#esli

Toshuya Ikarashi Group Leader GROUP1 ENGINEERING DEPT.M5

Hands-Free Telephone System\*

This device is designed to be used in Republic of Moldova.

2-28, Gosho-dori 1-chome, Hyogo-ku, Kobe, 652-8510, Japan

Honda Jazz (2018) - Hands-Free Telephone System\* - 1

Declaratie de conformitate

No. 65E-328213-0017

Director General de Proiect

Departamentul de management engineering

Immobilizer system Remote Transmitter

Honda Jazz (2018) - Immobilizer system Remote Transmitter - 1

Акционалко душко за исполните квалитета "КВАЛІТЕТ" №3 Анционарско друшто за исполните квалитета "КВАЛІТЕТ" Наколи-stock company for quality analyst "КВАЛІТЕТ" №3

Honda Jazz (2018) - Immobilizer system Remote Transmitter - 2

POTVRDA O USAGLASENOSTI - RITTo Brol: P1614118200 CONFIRMATION OF CONFORMITY - RATTE No.

Podnosťac zelteva:

Applicant:

DELTA AUTOMOTO D.O.D. 11079 NOVI BEOGRAD OMLADINSKH BRIGADA 33

EMGEMC U. Jones by SHON

32650044-5H-02点 15.09.2013 /

FATTAWATTE UL Japan, Inc. EXONAN EMC LLC

32EE044-SH02-C 15.01.2013.7

Na cunevo gore navodene dokumentacion uvideniu je do gore navodeno sistema zadavolava zahave "Prarinika o radio opermi i Telekomunikacione terminalj opermi" (GI. glasnik RS. 11/2012). On the basis of the above mentioned documentation it is found that above mentioned equipment fulti the requirements of the Rukcok on Radio Equipment and Telecommunications Terminal Equipment (Offical Cassite RS. 11/2012)

Nostale promere u specifikaci, fioimodilu, komponenta, elektróni karstatelekama opreme koji učtu na usuglafenost se noveden Piquinkem moraju se priaviti "Kvalier" u a d. No. Any charges occur in the specification, spadrodite, components of the design electrical conductivity which may influence on confluency to the stven motor Kvalier, stat be konstant to "Kvalier".

Mesto i datum indavanja:

Place and Site:

NEL, 08.11.2014

Važí dec

Vancure

06.11.2017

Honda Jazz (2018) - POTVRDA O USAGLASENOSTI - RITTo Brol: P1614118200 CONFIRMATION OF CONFORMITY - RATTE No. - 1

Bul Svetlog Cara Konstanina 82-86, N4 13000, Srbija, Tel: (018)550-766, 550-824, Fax: (018)550-636, 550-068 e-mail: office@kvaliat.co.rs. http://www.kvaliat.co.rs

Honda Jazz (2018) - POTVRDA O USAGLASENOSTI - RITTo Brol: P1614118200 CONFIRMATION OF CONFORMITY - RATTE No. - 2

Alicionarsko druško za išpitvane ivaliteta "KVALITET" NA Anjocnarko do druga za išpitvane kvaliteta "KVALITET" Nah Joint-stock company for quality dealing "KVALITET" No

Honda Jazz (2018) - POTVRDA O USAGLASENOSTI - RITTo Brol: P1614118200 CONFIRMATION OF CONFORMITY - RATTE No. - 3

POTVRDA O USAGLAŠENOSTI - RITTo CONFIRMATION OF CONFORMITY - BÄTTE Broj: P1614118300 No.

Podnosilac zahtevs:

Applicant:

DELTA AUTOMOTO D.O.D.

11070 NOVI BEDGRAD

CMLADINSKIH BRIGADA 33A

Vista opreme:

KLJUČ ZA DALJINSIĆ PRISTUP VOZILU

Equipment pricing

(二)本说明仅供参考。

Ostraka lapa/modela:

HLIKB-3T

Equipment types:

Robna maria:

Honda Lock

Auctional Reversals

Beckbedness Safety, U.S. Japan, Inc. Head Office EMC Lab

aptnl lveella)

10003194, 01.17.2013

Laboratory

10/06/2013, 24.05.2013.

Test report

100062365-8, 21.08.2013.

广力云

RITTORATTE UL Jigas (pc: SHONAN EMC Lab)

[Non-Text]

100082305-A, 21:00:2013.

Na osmova gore navedene dokumentacija ulvedljeno je da gore navedere oprema zadovoljana zuhleve "Pavniko o ristel

opsemi - telekomun/kazionoj/derminatoj operem? (5). glasink R3, 11/2012.

On the date of this above mentioned herein, we also need to above HR/HR 6009. Radio Equipment and Telecommunications Terminal Equipment (Official Bureau R.S. 11/2012).

Nastle promere u specifikaciji, spulmodisu, komponentama, elektrizum karakteristikama oprema levičitu na usgadornosti

ua navaderim Pravitriskom motaja po prijaviš "Kupitel" is a d. Né. Any charges occur in the specification, (general, components of the design, electrical construction which may influence on conformity to the above mention Facebook, shall be awarded to "Weather").

Mesto i datum izdavanje

Place and date: Ail: 05.12.2024

No. 01-12014

Važi del

Vaxton: 16 \$1,2012

06.11.2017

Honda Jazz (2018) - POTVRDA O USAGLAŠENOSTI - RITTo CONFIRMATION OF CONFORMITY - BÄTTE Broj: P1614118300 No. - 1

Bul. Svetog Cere Konstantine 82-96, N4 18000, Srbja, Tel: (018)550-706, 550-624, Fax: (018)550-636, 550-068

e-mail: office@kvaltel.co.in. http://www.kvaltel.co.in

Keyless Access System\*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Access System\* - 1

Aktionarsko društvo za ispitivanje kivitmeta "KVALITET" Nis Ankovačnpo dujušte za ispitivanje kivitmeta "KVALITET" Nis Joint-stock company for quality testing "KVALITET" Nis

Honda Jazz (2018) - Keyless Access System\* - 2

POTVRDA O USAGLAŠENOSTI - RITTO Broj. P1614053700 CONSUMMATION OF CONFORMUTY - RATTE

Podrosilac zahneva

zahleve: RTTE CONSULTING DOO Applicant: 11000 BEOGRAD MARIČKA 28/29

Vista opreme Equipment category

SISTEM ZA DALJINSKI PRISTUP VOZILU

Dzyska tipo/modela: Equipment type/model

40527612

Robna marka Equipment trademark Proizvodjač: Manufactur

Continental

Conventional Automotive GmbH Germany

Laboratorial inpatients leveling Laboratory Test report

Vrednovana dokumentacija Evaluated documentation

Bazbedness Safety, M.Dale Hochfrequency-Techik.

12008153, 14.12.2012

12008152, 14.12.2012/

12008151 14 17 2018

RITTENBETTE: M. Duckie Hochmierpertz-Teschlak, 12008150, 14.12.2012/

Na obove gore navodena dokumenta je ulvenjeno je de gom navodena opremi zadovlavao začetvo Provniklo z radio opremi i telakomunikacije terminaloj opremi (Bt. glornik RS. 11/2012). On the basis of the above meterized documentation it is found that above meterized equipment tutsi le repremenje of the "Rudbook on Radio Equipment and Telecommunications Terminal Equipment (Official Certificate) RTL 11/2012".

Nastala promene u specifikacii. Iquimodelu, komponentora, elektrilon karavenskana opreme koji ušću na utapalentost su kavanetimi Plavnikom remuju se prijeriti "Kerlič" u d. Na. Any changes occur in the apolization, beprodomi, componenti otra design, einkine penetration which may influence on conformity to the

Mesto i datum indovrzej: Place and date: Nis. 18.09.2014.

Vah do: Vald enti 16.08.2017.

Honda Jazz (2018) - POTVRDA O USAGLAŠENOSTI - RITTO Broj. P1614053700 CONSUMMATION OF CONFORMUTY - RATTE - 1

Honda Jazz (2018) - POTVRDA O USAGLAŠENOSTI - RITTO Broj. P1614053700 CONSUMMATION OF CONFORMUTY - RATTE - 2

Bul. Svetog Cara Kantsamina (52-80), NA 16300, Sroja, Tel: (018)850-766, 050-024, Fax: (018)850-638, 050-068 e-mail: office@kvstet.co.rs, http://www.kvstet.co.rs

Honda Jazz (2018) - POTVRDA O USAGLAŠENOSTI - RITTO Broj. P1614053700 CONSUMMATION OF CONFORMUTY - RATTE - 3

On the issue of the above mentioned documentation it is found that above mentioned equipment fulles the requirements of the "Routledge no Radio Equipment and Telecommunications Terminal Equipment (RUTLR) (Suite-RS 152072)

Nadate protemere u specifikacija, kivudmodelu, komponentiemo, elektržnim karaktonistikomo opramo koji utilizna usogatilosis

As handelsim, Phavitikore moved to the right. (Avalon: 4.2.5.10) Any changes occur in the specification; (Specrmodel; components of the concept electrical construction which may influence on conformity at the

Mesto i datum izdavanja: Place and site: Nil. 15.05.2014

Vazni do Vazni unile 10.05.2017.

Honda Jazz (2018) - POTVRDA O USAGLAŠENOSTI - RITTO Broj. P1614053700 CONSUMMATION OF CONFORMUTY - RATTE - 4

Honda Jazz (2018) - POTVRDA O USAGLAŠENOSTI - RITTO Broj. P1614053700 CONSUMMATION OF CONFORMUTY - RATTE - 5

Bul. Swing Cass Konsterkine 82-00, 198 10000, Urbia. Tpl. (018)650-768, 600-624, Fax: (018)650-630, 550-668 e-mail: office@kvystap.co.nz. http://www.kvalitel.co.nz

Keyless Access System\*

Hands-Free Telephone System\*

Honda Jazz (2018) - Hands-Free Telephone System\* - 1

ALPS ELECTRIC CO., LTD. Engineering Headquarters S-3-16, Nakano, Farakova, Oudiccity, Miyagi-poli, 189-6181, Japan Phone +81 120-23-5181. Fax +81 225-23-5129

DECLARATION of CONFORMITY For

Honda Jazz (2018) - DECLARATION of CONFORMITY For - 1

Product: Immobiliser base station Model: TWK1A0028

Supplied by ALPS ELECTRIC CO., LTD. 6-3-36, Nakazato, Furukawa, Osaki-city, Miyagi-pref., JAPAN 980-6181

Technical Construction File held by ALPS ELECTRIC CO., LTD. 6-3-36, Nalsazato, Furakawa, Osaka-city, Miyagi-pref., JAPAN 989-6181

Standard used for comply

R&TTE Directive (Article 3.1(a) Safety)

EN 60065: 2002 + Amd.1: 2006 + Amd.11: 2008 + Amd.2: 2010 + Amd.12: 2011

R&TTE Directive (Article 3.1(b) EMC)

EN 301 489-1 V1.9.2: 2011 EN 301 489-3 V1.6.1: 2013

R&TTE Directive (Article 3.2 Spectrum)

EN 300 330-1 V1.7.1: 2010 EN 300 330-2 V1.5.1: 2010

Means of Conformity

We declare under our sole responsibility that the Product (s) is conformity with the essential requirements and other relevant requirements of the Radio and Telecommunication Terminal Equipment (R&TTE) Directive (1999/5/EC).

Date of issue: July 11, 2014

Signature of Responsible Person:

Joshia Icaoshi

Toshiyu Ikarashi Group Leader GROUP1 ENGINEERING DEPT.M5

Honda Jazz (2018) - Means of Conformity - 1

Akcionarsko društvo za spitivanje kvaliteta "KVALITET" Naš Anakonarogo другво за испливавње квалитета "KVALITET" Naš Joint-stock company for quality rating "KVALITET" Naš

Honda Jazz (2018) - Means of Conformity - 2

POTVRDA 0 USAGLAŠENOSTI - RITTo CONFIRMATION OF CONFORMITY - R&TTE Brep No P1614126000

Podnosilac zaštava: RTTE CONSULTING DOO Applicant: 110/0 BEOGRAD MARČKA 28/29

Vrste oprames: AUDIO UREDJAJ ZA AUTOMOBIL SA BLUETOOTH, WLAN I GPS

Ozraka tipa/models: FT0X56A Equipment type/model:

Robra marks: FUJITSU TEN Equipment Vodemark Preizvodjeet: FUJITSU TEN LIMITED Manufacturer: Japan

Vreconovana dokumentacija - Evaluated documentation:

Laboratori/J Bezednost/Safety: UL Japan, Inc. Head Office EMC Lab

Iapitri Izvela: 1007550TH-H, 21.11.2013.

Laboratory EMKEMC: UL Japan, enl. Head Office EMC Lab. 1007585TH D, 08-11-2013

Test report: 100/250-HA, 08.11-2016.7 BETD-WATTE: 13 Japan Inc. (Next Office EMC) Lab

1037623846W, 02 10.2618

10376235H/V, 02.10.2014.

10075507H-C, 08.11.2013.

Na zanovu pore navodene documentacije utvirdjero je de grotre navodena oprema zaštovejava zaštava "Pravitrova o ladiu opremi i telekomunrăsionoj termirelno oprem" (Sl: glasnić RS, 11/2012).

Oh the basis of the above mentioned documentation it is found that above mentioned equipment fulits the requirements of the Handbook on Radio Equipment and Telecommunicatino Terminal Equipment (Official Gesells RD. 11/2012)

Nastale promene u specifikacil, Spulredalu, konsopendama, elektrimm zarkčljenstkane (zomme iši učitu na nastalana

sa nevedlerim Pravirskom motaju ve priaviti "Kvattar"-u a.d. N.B.

Any charges occur in the specification, team model, components of the design, mechanical construction which may influence on continuity to the above mention Ruasool, shall be forwarded to "Kvastal"

Mesto i datum izdavenja: Važi do: Plasor wird data: Važid unit: Nil. 25.11.2014. 25.11.2017.

Honda Jazz (2018) - Means of Conformity - 3

Bul. Svetog Cara Konstantina 82-86, Niš 16000, Srbiča, Tel: (018)550-766, 550-624, Fax: (018)550-639, 650-068 e-mail: office@kvalist.co.in. http://www.kvalist.co.in

EC Declaration of Conformity Content Outline\*

EC Declaration of Conformity

Honda Jazz (2018) - EC Declaration of Conformity - 1

  1. The undersigned, Mr. Ryoichi Hiraki, representing the manufacturers, hereby declares that the machinery described below fulfils all the relevant provisions of. • The EC-directive 2006/42/EC on machinery.

  2. Description of the machinery

a) Generic denomination: Pantograph jackb) Function lifting motor vehicle
c) Modeld) Type
SNBHonda Type-A
SJDHonda Type-B
S2AHonda Type-C
SAHHonda Type-D
TP6Honda Type-G
T5AHonda Type-I
T2VHonda Type-J
  1. Manufacturer (1): Honda Type-A/B/C/G/I RIKENKAKI CO., LTD. 5-6-12 Chiyoda Sakado-shi, Saitama 350-0214 JAPAN

4 Manufacturer (2): Honda Type-D/J CHANGZHOU RIKENSEIKO MACHINERY CO., LTD. No. 1903 Zhongwu Ave, Zhonglou Changzhou, Jiangsu CHINA

  1. Legal person authorised to compile the technical file : Honda Motor Europe Ltd Belgian Branch p/a Honda Motor Europe Ltd - Asist Office Wijngaardvold 1 (Noord V) B-9300 Asist (Belgium)
6. References to harmonized standards7. Other standards or specifications
EN1494:2000+A1:2008-
  1. Done at
  2. Date

Seitama, Japan 1 December 2009

Honda Jazz (2018) - EC Declaration of Conformity - 2

Ryoichi Hiraki President of RIKENKAKI CO.,LTD. President of CHANGZHOL RIKENSEIKO MACHINERY CO.,LTD.

Note: This declaration becomes invalid. If technical or operational modifications are introduced without the manufacturers consent.

Index

Numbers

7-Speed Manual Shift Mode 404

A

About Open Source Licences.... 312

ABS (Anti-lock Brake System).... 455

Accessories and Modifications 537

Accessory Power Socket.... 205

Adding

Coolant 494

Engine Oil 493

Washer 498

Additives, Engine Oil 490

Adjustable Speed Limiter 423

Adjusting

Clock 140

Front Seats.... 187

Headlight Distribution 451

Headlights 174

Mirrors.... 185

Rear Seats.... 190

Steering Wheel 184

Temperature 127

Adjusting Headlight Distribution ..... 451

Agile Handling Assist System 448

Air Conditioning System

(Climate Control System) 213

Changing the Mode.... 213, 214

Defrosting the Windscreen and

Windows 215

Dust and Pollen Filter 530

Maintenance 529

Recirculation/Fresh Air Mode 213, 214

Sensors.... 218

Using Automatic Climate Control 213

Air Conditioning System

(Heating and Cooling System) 209

Cooling 211

Defrosting the Windscreen and

Windows 212

Heating 210

Maintenance 529

Recirculation/Fresh Air Mode 209

Air Pressure 515, 591

Airbags 49

After a Collision.... 51

Airbag Care....61

Event Data Recorder 1

Front Airbags (SRS) 51

Indicator....59, 91

Sensors 49

Side Airbags 56

Side Curtain Airbags 58

AM/FM Radio 234, 277

Ambient Meter 123

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) 455

Indicator....91

Armrest 198

Audio Antenna 224

Audio Remote Controls.... 225

Audio System 220

Adjusting the Sound.... 232, 274

Auxiliary Input Jack.... 222

Error Messages.... 305

General Information 308

HDMI™ Port 222

iPod 248, 288

MP3/WMA/AAC 251, 285, 291

Recommended CDs.... 308

Recommended Devices.... 310

Remote Controls 225

USB Flash Drives.... 311

USB Port 221

Audio System Theft Protection 223

Auto High-Beam (High Beam Support

System).... 175

Auto Idle Stop 410, 415

Auto Idle Stop Function.... 11

Auxiliary Input Jack 222

Average Fuel Economy 126

Average Speed 127

B

Battery 522

Charging System Indicator.... 89, 568

Jump Starting 562

Maintenance (Checking the Battery)...... 522

Maintenance (Replacing) 524

Belts (Seat) 36

Beverage Holders 203

Bluetooth® Audio 254, 294

Booster Seats (For Children)....80

Brake System...... 453

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) 455

Brake Assist System 456

Fluid 497

Foot Brake 454

Indicator....86, 87, 569

Parking Brake 453

Brake System Indicator (Amber) 87

Brake System Indicator (Red) 86

Brightness Control (Instrument Panel) .... 182

Bulb Replacement.... 499

Back-Up Light.... 506

Brake/Taillight.... 507

Daytime Running Lights.... 505

Fog Lights.... 501

Front Turn Signal Lights 503

Headlights 499

High-Mount Brake Light 508

Interior Lights 509

Luggage Area Light 510

Position Light Bulbs.... 504

Rear Fog Light 506

Rear Licence Plate Light 508

Rear Turn Signal Light.... 506

Side Turn Signal Lights.... 505

Bulb Specifications.... 591

C

Carbon Monoxide Gas 82

Carrying Luggage.... 383, 385

CD Player 245, 285

Changing Bulbs 499

Charging System Indicator.... 89, 568

Child Restraint System 62

Booster Seats 80

Child Restraint System for Infants 66

Child Restraint System for Small Children 68

Installing a Child Restraint System with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt 75

Larger Children 79

Rearward Facing Child Restraint System .... 66

Selecting a Child Restraint System 69

Using a Tether.... 78

Child Safety 62

Childproof Door Locks.... 155

Childproof Door Locks 155

City-Brake Active system.... 457

Cleaning the Exterior 534

Cleaning the Interior.... 532

Climate Control System.... 213

Changing the Mode 213

Defrosting the Windscreen and Windows.... 215

Dust and Pollen Filter.... 530

Recirculation and Fresh Air Mode 214

Sensors 218

Using Automatic Climate Control 213

Clock 140

Coat Hook 206

Compact Spare Tyre.... 541, 591

Console Compartment.... 202

Continuously Variable Transmission..... 401

7-Speed Manual Shift Mode 404

Creeping.... 401

Fluid 496

Kickdown 401

Operating the Shift Lever 403

Shift Lever Does Not Move.... 565

Shifting.... 402

Controls 139

Coolant (Engine) 494

Adding to the Radiator 495

Adding to the Reserve Tank 494

Overheating.... 566

Creeping

(Continuously Variable Transmission)... 401

Cruise Control 420

Cup Holders 203

Customized Features 131, 313

D

DAB

(Digital Audio Broadcasting) ...... 241, 282

Daytime Running Lights.... 178

Dead Battery 562

Deflation Warning System 449

Indicator 96,571

Defrosting the Windscreen and Windows.... 212, 215
Devices that Emit Radio Waves.... 595
Digital Audio Broadcasting (DAB) 241, 282
Dimming Headlights 170
Dipstick (Engine Oil) 492
Directional Signals (Turn Signals) 169
Display Button 258
Door Mirrors.... 186
Doors 142 Door and Tailgate Open Indicator 35, 95
Keys.... 142
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside 153
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside 146
Lockout Prevention System 152
Driving 381 Braking 453
Continuously Variable Transmission ..... 401
Cruise Control 420
Shifting Gear 402, 407
Starting the Engine 392, 395
Dust and Pollen Filter 530

E EC Declaration of Conformity Content Outline .... 607
Elapsed Time.... 126
Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator....97, 570
Emergency Stop Signal 462
Emergency Towing 584
Engine Coolant 494 Jump Starting 562 Oil 490 Starting 392, 395 Switch Buzzer 164
Engine Coolant .... 494 Adding to the Radiator .... 495 Adding to the Reserve Tank.... 494 Overheating .... 566
Engine Oil 490
Adding 493
Checking 492
Low Oil Pressure Indicator 88, 568
Recommended Engine Oil 490
Engine Start/Stop Button 165 EPS (Electric Power Steering) System 97, 570
Exhaust Gas Hazard (Carbon Monoxide) 82
Exterior Care (Cleaning) 534
Exterior Mirrors 186

F Features 219
Filter Dust and Pollen.... 530
Flat Tyre 541 Floor Mats 533
Fluids Brake 497
Continuously Variable Transmission (CVT).... 496
Engine Coolant 494
Manual Transmission.... 496
Windscreen Washer 498
Folding Down the Rear Seats 191 Foot Brake 454
Forward Collision Warning.... 434 Front Airbags (SRS).... 51
Front Fog Light Indicator.... 98
Front Seats.... 187 Adjusting.... 187
Fuel....471 Economy....473
Gauge.... 128
Instant Fuel Economy 127
Low Fuel Indicator.... 91
Range 126
Recommendation.... 471
Refueling.... 471
Fuel Economy 473 Fuel Fill Cap 25,472
Fuel Fill Door 25,472

Fuses 573

Inspecting and Changing.... 583

Locations.... 573, 575, 576, 578

G

Gasoline (Fuel)

Instant Fuel Economy.... 127

Low Fuel Indicator 91

Gauges.... 123

Gear Shift Lever Positions

Continuously Variable

Transmission....402

Manual Transmission 407

Glass (care) 532, 535

Glove Box 202

H

Halogen Bulbs.... 499

Hands-Free Telephone (HFT)

System.... 339, 362

Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History 373

Automatic Import of Mobile Phonebook and Call History 354

Caller's ID Information.... 352

HFT Buttons.... 339, 362

HFT Menus 342, 365

HFT Status Display 341, 363

Limitations for Manual Operation .... 341, 364

Making a Call.... 357, 376

Options During a Call 361, 379

Phone Setup.... 346, 368

Receiving a Call 360, 379

Ring Tone.... 352, 372

Speed Dial.... 355, 374

To Clear the System 353

Hazard Warning Button 4,5

HDMI™ Port 222

Headlights.... 170

Adjuster 174

Aiming.... 499

Dimming.... 170

Operating.... 170

Heaters (Seat) 208

Heating and Cooling System 209

HFT (Hands-Free Telephone) 339, 362

High Beam Indicator 98

High Beam Support System

Indicator.... 102

Hill Start Assist System 394, 398

|

Identification Numbers 594

Vehicle Identification 594

Ignition Switch 164

Illumination Control.... 182

Knob.... 182

Immobilizer System 159

Indicator.... 99

Indicators 86

Adjustable Speed Limiter.... 101

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) 91

Auto Idle Stop.... 102

Auto Idle Stop System.... 103

Brake System (Amber) 87

Brake System (Red) 86

Charging System.... 89

City-Brake Active System (CTBA) 106

Cruise Control and Adjustable Speed Limiter Set Speed.... 101

Cruise Main 101

Door and Tailgate Open.... 35, 95

Electric Power Steering (EPS) System ..... 97

Forward Collision Warning.... 104

Front Fog Light 98

High Beam.... 98

High Beam Support System.... 102

High Temperature.... 94

Immobilizer System 99

Keyless Access System.... 100

Lane Departure Warning.... 105

Lights On 98

Low Fuel 91

Low Oil Pressure 88

Low Temperature.... 94

Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning System 96

M (7-speed manual shift mode) /Shift ..... 90

Malfunction Indicator Lamp 88

Parking Brake and Brake System 86

Passenger Front Airbag On/Off.... 92

Rear Fog Light.... 98

Seat Belt Reminder.... 90

Security System Alarm.... 100

Shift Down 101

Shift Lever Position.... 89

Shift Up 101

Supplemental Restraint System 91

System Message 97

Transmission 89

Turn Signal 98

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System...... 93

VSA OFF 93

Instant Fuel Economy 127

Instrument Panel 85

Brightness Control 182

Intelligent Speed Limiter 427

Interior Lights.... 199

Interior Rearview Mirror 185

iPod 248, 288

J

Jack (Wheel Nut Wrench).... 544

Jump Starting.... 562

K

Key Number Tag 144

Keyless Access System 146

Keyless Lockout Prevention.... 152

Keys 142

Lockout Prevention.... 152

Number Tag 144

Rear Door Won't Open.... 155

Remote Transmitter 149

Types and Functions 142

Won't Turn 28

Kickdown

(Continuously Variable Transmission) ... 401

L

Lane Departure Warning 438

Language (HFT) 320, 330

Light Switches.... 170

Lights.... 170, 499

Bulb Replacement.... 499

Fog Lights.... 172

High Beam Indicator 98

Interior 199

Lights On Indicator 98

Turn Signals.... 169

Load Limit 385

Locking/Unlocking 142

Childproof Door Locks.... 155

From Inside.... 153

From Outside.... 146

Keys 142

Using a Key 151

Lockout Prevention System.... 152

Low Battery Charge.... 568

Low Fuel Indicator.... 91

Low Keyless Remote Signal Strength..... 145

Low Oil Level Symbol 572

Low Oil Pressure Indicator 88, 568

Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning

System Indicator 96, 571

Lower Anchorages 72

Lubricant Specifications Chart.... 591

Luggage (Load Limit) 385

Luggage Area Cover 207

M

Maintenance 475

Air Conditioning.... 529

Battery 522

Brake Fluid 497

Cleaning 532

Climate Control.... 529

Coolant.... 494

Oil 492

Precautions 476

Radiator 495

Remote Transmitter.... 527

Replacing Light Bulbs 499

Safety.... 477

Transmission Fluid 496

Tyres 515

Under the Bonnet.... 488

Malfunction Indicator Lamp.... 88, 569

Manual Transmission 407

Map Lights 200

Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight ..... 385

Maximum Permissible Weight 385

Meters, Gauges.... 123

Mirrors.... 185

Adjusting.... 185

Door....186

Exterior.... 186

Interior Rearview.... 185

Modifications (and Accessories).... 537

MP3....245, 251, 285, 291

Multi-Information Display.... 124

Multi-View Rear Camera 469

N

Numbers (Identification) 594

0

Odometer 126

Oil (Engine) 490

Adding 493

Checking.... 492

Low Oil Pressure Indicator.... 88, 568

Recommended Engine Oil.... 490

Viscosity 490

On Board Apps.... 298

Opening/Closing

Bonnet 489

Power Windows 162

Tailgate 156

Outside Temperature Display.... 127

Overheating.... 566

P

Paddle Shifters

(7-Speed Manual Shift Mode).... 404

Parking Brake 453

Parking Brake and Brake System

Indicator.... 86, 569

Parking Sensor System 464

Passenger Front Airbag Off System 54

Passing Indicators 170

Petrol 25,471

Economy 473

Gauge.... 128

Information 471

Refueling.... 471

Power Windows 162

Precautions While Driving 399

Rain 399

Pregnant Women 46

Preset Memory 234, 241

Puncture (Tyre) 541

R

Radiator 495

Radio (AM/FM) 234, 277

Radio Data System (RDS) 235, 280

Range 126

RDS (Radio Data System) 235, 280

Rear Demister Button 183

Rear Fog Light Indicator.... 98

Rear Seats (Folding Down) 191

Rear Wiper 181

Rearview Mirror 185

Refueling 471

Fuel Gauge 128

Low Fuel Indicator.... 91

Petrol.... 471,590

Regulations 595,607

Remote Transmitter.... 149

Replacement

Battery.... 524, 527

Bulbs 499

Fuses 573, 576

Tyres 518

Wiper Blade Rubber 511

Resetting a Trip Meter.... 126

S

Safe Driving.... 31

Safety Labels 83

Safety Message 0

Seat Belts 36

Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor 44

Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners 41

Checking 47

Fastening 42

Installing a Child Restraint System with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt.... 75

Pregnant Women.... 46

Reminder 39

Warning Indicator 39, 90

Seat Heaters 208

Seats...... 187

Adjusting 187

Front Seats.... 187

Rear Seats.... 190

Seat Heaters 208

Security System 159

Immobilizer System Indicator.... 99

Security System Alarm Indicator 100

SEL/RESET Button 125

Select Lever 23,402,407

Selecting a Child Restraint System.... 69

Selector Knob (Audio) 227

Setting the Clock.... 140

Shift Down Indicator 101,408

Shift Lever 23,402,407

Operation 23,403,407

Releasing 565

Won't Move 565

Shift Lever Position Indicator 89,403

Shift Up Indicator.... 101, 406, 408

Shifting

Continuously Variable Transmission ..... 402

Manual Transmission 407

Shoulder Anchor 44

Side Airbags 56

Side Curtain Airbags....58

Spare Tyre 541, 591

Spark Plugs.... 590

Specifications 590

Specified Fuel 471,590

Speed Alarm Setting 129

Speedometer 123

SRS Airbags (Airbags) 51

Start/Stop Button.... 165

Starting the Engine 392, 395

Does Not Start.... 559

Engine Switch Buzzer 164

Jump Starting 562

Steering Wheel 184

Adjusting.... 184

Stopping 463

Supplemental Restraint System (SRS).... 51

Switches

(Around the Steering Wheel) ..... 4, 6, 164

System Message Indicator....97

T

Tachometer.... 123

Tailgate 156

Temperature

Outside Temperature Display 127

Temperature Sensor 127, 218

Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre ..... 549

Tie-down Anchors 206

Time (Setting) 140

Tools 540

Towing a Trailer 386

Equipment and Accessories 388

Load Limits.... 386

Towing Your Vehicle

Emergency 584

Traffic Sign Recognition System...... 442

Transmission 402, 407

7-Speed Manual Shift Mode.... 404

Continuously Variable 402

Fluid 496

Manual 407

Shift Lever Position Indicator.... 89, 403

Trip Meter 126

Troubleshooting.... 539

Blown Fuse.... 573, 576

Brake Pedal Vibrates.... 28

Buzzer Sounds When Opening Door...... 29

Emergency Towing.... 584

Engine Won't Start.... 559

Noise When Braking.... 30

Overheating 566

Puncture/Flat Tyre 541

Rear Door Won't Open.... 29

Shift Lever Won't Move 565

Warning Indicators 86

Turn Signals 169

Indicators (Instrument Panel) 98

Tyres.... 515

Air Pressure.... 515, 591

Checking and Maintaining 515

Inspection.... 515

Puncture (Flat Tyre) 541

Rotation 519

Spare Tyre 541, 591

Tyre Chains.... 520

Wear Indicators 517

Winter....520

U

Unlocking the Doors.... 146

Unlocking the Front Doors from the Inside....153

USB Flash Drives.... 311

USB Port 221

Using the Keyless Access System...... 146

V

Vanity Mirrors....9

Vehicle Identification Numbers 594

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA).... 446

Off Button 447

Off Indicator....93

System Indicator 93

Ventilation 209, 213, 214

Viscosity (Oil) 490, 591

VSA (Vehicle Stability Assist).... 446

W

Warning and Information

Messages 108

Warning Indicator On/Blinking 568

Warning Labels.... 83

Watts 591

Wear Indicators (Tyre).... 517

Wheel Nut Wrench (Jack Handle) 545

When You Cannot Open the Tailgate .... 587

Wi-Fi Connection 302

Window Washers 179

Adding/Refilling Fluid 498

Switch.... 179

Windows (Opening and Closing) ...... 162

Windscreen 179

Cleaning 532, 535

Defrosting/Defogging.... 212, 215

Washer Fluid 498

Wiper Blades 511

Wipers and Washers.... 179

Winter Tyres 520

Tyre Chains 520

Wipers and Washers.... 179

Checking and Replacing Wiper Blades ..... 511

WMA 245, 251, 285, 291

Worn Tyres 515

Table of contents Click a title to access it
Manual assistant
Powered by Anthropic
Waiting for your message
Product information

Brand : Honda

Model : Jazz (2018)

Category : Automobile